]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - bfd/elf64-ppc.c
Power10 stub selection
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf64-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC64-specific support for 64-bit ELF.
2 Copyright (C) 1999-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Linus Nordberg, Swox AB <info@swox.com>,
4 based on elf32-ppc.c by Ian Lance Taylor.
5 Largely rewritten by Alan Modra.
6
7 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
20 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
21 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23
24 /* The 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI may be found at
25 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/PPC-elf64abi.txt, and
26 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/spec/book1.html */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc64.h"
35 #include "elf64-ppc.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37
38 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
39 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
40
41 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_ha_reloc
42 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
43 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_branch_reloc
44 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
45 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc
46 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
47 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc
48 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc
54 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc
56 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
57 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc
58 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
59 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc
60 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
61 static bfd_vma opd_entry_value
62 (asection *, bfd_vma, asection **, bfd_vma *, bfd_boolean);
63
64 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf64_le_vec
65 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf64-powerpcle"
66 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_vec
67 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc"
68 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
69 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC64_ELF_DATA
70 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC64
71 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
72 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
73 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
74 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc64_elf_info_to_howto
75
76 #define elf_backend_want_got_sym 0
77 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
78 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment 3
79 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
80 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 8
81 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
82 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
83 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
84 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
85 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
86 #define elf_backend_default_execstack 0
87
88 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject ppc64_elf_mkobject
89 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup
90 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup
91 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
92 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_print_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data
93 #define bfd_elf64_new_section_hook ppc64_elf_new_section_hook
94 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create
95 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
96 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_just_syms ppc64_elf_link_just_syms
97 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_gc_sections ppc64_elf_gc_sections
98
99 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc64_elf_object_p
100 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus
101 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo
102 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc64_elf_write_core_note
103 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections
104 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
105 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook
106 #define elf_backend_check_directives ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs
107 #define elf_backend_notice_as_needed ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed
108 #define elf_backend_archive_symbol_lookup ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup
109 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc64_elf_check_relocs
110 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
111 #define elf_backend_gc_keep ppc64_elf_gc_keep
112 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_dynamic_ref ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref
113 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook
114 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
115 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol ppc64_elf_hide_symbol
116 #define elf_backend_maybe_function_sym ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym
117 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust
118 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
119 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc64_elf_hash_symbol
120 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
121 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc64_elf_action_discarded
122 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc64_elf_relocate_section
123 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
124 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class
125 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
126 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook
127 #define elf_backend_special_sections ppc64_elf_special_sections
128 #define elf_backend_section_flags ppc64_elf_section_flags
129 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol_attribute ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute
130 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol ppc64_elf_merge_symbol
131 #define elf_backend_get_reloc_section bfd_get_section_by_name
132
133 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
134 section. */
135 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
136
137 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table. */
138 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 8)
139 #define LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 16 : 8)
140
141 /* The initial size of the plt reserved for the dynamic linker. */
142 #define PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 16)
143
144 /* Offsets to some stack save slots. */
145 #define STK_LR 16
146 #define STK_TOC(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 40 : 24)
147 /* This one is dodgy. ELFv2 does not have a linker word, so use the
148 CR save slot. Used only by optimised __tls_get_addr call stub,
149 relying on __tls_get_addr_opt not saving CR.. */
150 #define STK_LINKER(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 32 : 8)
151
152 /* TOC base pointers offset from start of TOC. */
153 #define TOC_BASE_OFF 0x8000
154 /* TOC base alignment. */
155 #define TOC_BASE_ALIGN 256
156
157 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
158 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
159 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
160
161 /* .plt call stub instructions. The normal stub is like this, but
162 sometimes the .plt entry crosses a 64k boundary and we need to
163 insert an addi to adjust r11. */
164 #define STD_R2_0R1 0xf8410000 /* std %r2,0+40(%r1) */
165 #define ADDIS_R11_R2 0x3d620000 /* addis %r11,%r2,xxx@ha */
166 #define LD_R12_0R11 0xe98b0000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0@l(%r11) */
167 #define MTCTR_R12 0x7d8903a6 /* mtctr %r12 */
168 #define LD_R2_0R11 0xe84b0000 /* ld %r2,xxx+8@l(%r11) */
169 #define LD_R11_0R11 0xe96b0000 /* ld %r11,xxx+16@l(%r11) */
170 #define BCTR 0x4e800420 /* bctr */
171
172 #define ADDI_R11_R11 0x396b0000 /* addi %r11,%r11,off@l */
173 #define ADDI_R12_R11 0x398b0000 /* addi %r12,%r11,off@l */
174 #define ADDI_R12_R12 0x398c0000 /* addi %r12,%r12,off@l */
175 #define ADDIS_R2_R2 0x3c420000 /* addis %r2,%r2,off@ha */
176 #define ADDI_R2_R2 0x38420000 /* addi %r2,%r2,off@l */
177
178 #define XOR_R2_R12_R12 0x7d826278 /* xor %r2,%r12,%r12 */
179 #define ADD_R11_R11_R2 0x7d6b1214 /* add %r11,%r11,%r2 */
180 #define XOR_R11_R12_R12 0x7d8b6278 /* xor %r11,%r12,%r12 */
181 #define ADD_R2_R2_R11 0x7c425a14 /* add %r2,%r2,%r11 */
182 #define CMPLDI_R2_0 0x28220000 /* cmpldi %r2,0 */
183 #define BNECTR 0x4ca20420 /* bnectr+ */
184 #define BNECTR_P4 0x4ce20420 /* bnectr+ */
185
186 #define LD_R12_0R2 0xe9820000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0(%r2) */
187 #define LD_R11_0R2 0xe9620000 /* ld %r11,xxx+0(%r2) */
188 #define LD_R2_0R2 0xe8420000 /* ld %r2,xxx+0(%r2) */
189
190 #define LD_R2_0R1 0xe8410000 /* ld %r2,0(%r1) */
191 #define LD_R2_0R12 0xe84c0000 /* ld %r2,0(%r12) */
192 #define ADD_R2_R2_R12 0x7c426214 /* add %r2,%r2,%r12 */
193
194 #define LI_R11_0 0x39600000 /* li %r11,0 */
195 #define LIS_R2 0x3c400000 /* lis %r2,xxx@ha */
196 #define LIS_R11 0x3d600000 /* lis %r11,xxx@ha */
197 #define LIS_R12 0x3d800000 /* lis %r12,xxx@ha */
198 #define ADDIS_R2_R12 0x3c4c0000 /* addis %r2,%r12,xxx@ha */
199 #define ADDIS_R12_R2 0x3d820000 /* addis %r12,%r2,xxx@ha */
200 #define ADDIS_R12_R11 0x3d8b0000 /* addis %r12,%r11,xxx@ha */
201 #define ADDIS_R12_R12 0x3d8c0000 /* addis %r12,%r12,xxx@ha */
202 #define ORIS_R12_R12_0 0x658c0000 /* oris %r12,%r12,xxx@hi */
203 #define ORI_R11_R11_0 0x616b0000 /* ori %r11,%r11,xxx@l */
204 #define ORI_R12_R12_0 0x618c0000 /* ori %r12,%r12,xxx@l */
205 #define LD_R12_0R12 0xe98c0000 /* ld %r12,xxx@l(%r12) */
206 #define SLDI_R11_R11_34 0x796b1746 /* sldi %r11,%r11,34 */
207 #define SLDI_R12_R12_32 0x799c07c6 /* sldi %r12,%r12,32 */
208 #define LDX_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b602a /* ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
209 #define ADD_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b6214 /* add %r12,%r11,%r12 */
210 #define PADDI_R12_PC 0x0610000039800000ULL
211 #define PLD_R12_PC 0x04100000e5800000ULL
212 #define PNOP 0x0700000000000000ULL
213
214 /* __glink_PLTresolve stub instructions. We enter with the index in R0. */
215 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE(htab) \
216 (8u + (htab->opd_abi ? 11 * 4 : 14 * 4))
217 /* 0: */
218 /* .quad plt0-1f */
219 /* __glink: */
220 #define MFLR_R12 0x7d8802a6 /* mflr %12 */
221 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005 /* bcl 20,31,1f */
222 /* 1: */
223 #define MFLR_R11 0x7d6802a6 /* mflr %11 */
224 /* ld %2,(0b-1b)(%11) */
225 #define MTLR_R12 0x7d8803a6 /* mtlr %12 */
226 #define ADD_R11_R2_R11 0x7d625a14 /* add %11,%2,%11 */
227 /* ld %12,0(%11) */
228 /* ld %2,8(%11) */
229 /* mtctr %12 */
230 /* ld %11,16(%11) */
231 /* bctr */
232 #define MFLR_R0 0x7c0802a6 /* mflr %r0 */
233 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
234 #define SUB_R12_R12_R11 0x7d8b6050 /* subf %r12,%r11,%r12 */
235 #define ADDI_R0_R12 0x380c0000 /* addi %r0,%r12,0 */
236 #define SRDI_R0_R0_2 0x7800f082 /* rldicl %r0,%r0,62,2 */
237
238 /* Pad with this. */
239 #define NOP 0x60000000
240
241 /* Some other nops. */
242 #define CROR_151515 0x4def7b82
243 #define CROR_313131 0x4ffffb82
244
245 /* .glink entries for the first 32k functions are two instructions. */
246 #define LI_R0_0 0x38000000 /* li %r0,0 */
247 #define B_DOT 0x48000000 /* b . */
248
249 /* After that, we need two instructions to load the index, followed by
250 a branch. */
251 #define LIS_R0_0 0x3c000000 /* lis %r0,0 */
252 #define ORI_R0_R0_0 0x60000000 /* ori %r0,%r0,0 */
253
254 /* Instructions used by the save and restore reg functions. */
255 #define STD_R0_0R1 0xf8010000 /* std %r0,0(%r1) */
256 #define STD_R0_0R12 0xf80c0000 /* std %r0,0(%r12) */
257 #define LD_R0_0R1 0xe8010000 /* ld %r0,0(%r1) */
258 #define LD_R0_0R12 0xe80c0000 /* ld %r0,0(%r12) */
259 #define STFD_FR0_0R1 0xd8010000 /* stfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
260 #define LFD_FR0_0R1 0xc8010000 /* lfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
261 #define LI_R12_0 0x39800000 /* li %r12,0 */
262 #define STVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c01ce /* stvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
263 #define LVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c00ce /* lvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
264 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
265 #define BLR 0x4e800020 /* blr */
266
267 /* Since .opd is an array of descriptors and each entry will end up
268 with identical R_PPC64_RELATIVE relocs, there is really no need to
269 propagate .opd relocs; The dynamic linker should be taught to
270 relocate .opd without reloc entries. */
271 #ifndef NO_OPD_RELOCS
272 #define NO_OPD_RELOCS 0
273 #endif
274
275 #ifndef ARRAY_SIZE
276 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
277 #endif
278
279 static inline int
280 abiversion (bfd *abfd)
281 {
282 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI;
283 }
284
285 static inline void
286 set_abiversion (bfd *abfd, int ver)
287 {
288 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC64_ABI;
289 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= ver & EF_PPC64_ABI;
290 }
291 \f
292 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
293 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
294 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
295 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
296 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
297 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
298 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
299 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
300 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
301 complain, special_func) \
302 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
303 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
304 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
305
306 static reloc_howto_type *ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) R_PPC64_max];
307
308 static reloc_howto_type ppc64_elf_howto_raw[] =
309 {
310 /* This reloc does nothing. */
311 HOW (R_PPC64_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
312 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
313
314 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
315 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
316 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
317
318 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
319 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
320 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
321 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
322
323 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
324 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
328 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Bits 16-31 of an address. */
332 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* Bits 16-31 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low 16
336 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
337 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
338 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
339
340 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
341 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
342 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
343 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
344
345 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
346 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
347 bits must be zero. */
348 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
349 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
350
351 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
352 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
353 two bits must be zero. */
354 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
355 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
356
357 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
358 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
359 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
360
361 /* A variant of R_PPC64_REL24, used when r2 is not the toc pointer. */
362 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
363 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
364
365 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
366 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
367 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
368
369 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
370 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
371 zero. */
372 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
373 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
374
375 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
376 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
377 be zero. */
378 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
379 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
380
381 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
382 symbol. */
383 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
384 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
385
386 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
387 the symbol. */
388 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
389 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
390
391 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
392 the symbol. */
393 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
394 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
395
396 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
397 the symbol. */
398 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
399 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
400
401 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
402 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
403 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
404 shared library into the object, because the object being
405 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
406 HOW (R_PPC64_COPY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
407 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
408
409 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR64, but used when setting global offset table
410 entries. */
411 HOW (R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
412 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
413
414 /* Created by the link editor. Marks a procedure linkage table
415 entry for a symbol. */
416 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
417 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
418
419 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
420 doubleword64 is set to the load address of the object, plus the
421 addend. */
422 HOW (R_PPC64_RELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
423 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
424
425 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
426 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
427 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
428
429 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
430 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
431 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
432
433 /* 32-bit PC relative. */
434 HOW (R_PPC64_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
435 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
436
437 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
438 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
439 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440
441 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
442 FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL32 not supported. */
443 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
444 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
447 the symbol. */
448 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
449 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
450
451 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
452 the symbol. */
453 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
457 the symbol. */
458 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
459 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
460
461 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
462 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
463 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
464
465 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but no overflow warning. */
466 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
467 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
468
469 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
470 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
471 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
472
473 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
474 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
475 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc),
476
477 /* Like R_PPC64_REL24 without touching the two least significant bits. */
478 HOW (R_PPC64_REL30, 2, 30, 0xfffffffc, 2, TRUE, dont,
479 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
480
481 /* Relocs in the 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI, not in the 32-bit ABI. */
482
483 /* A standard 64-bit relocation. */
484 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
485 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
486
487 /* The bits 32-47 of an address. */
488 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
489 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
490
491 /* The bits 32-47 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
492 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
493 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
494 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
495
496 /* The bits 48-63 of an address. */
497 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
498 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
499
500 /* The bits 48-63 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
501 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
502 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
503 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
504
505 /* Like ADDR64, but may be unaligned. */
506 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
507 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
508
509 /* 64-bit relative relocation. */
510 HOW (R_PPC64_REL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
511 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
512
513 /* 64-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
514 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
515 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
516
517 /* 64-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage
518 table. */
519 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL64 not supported. */
520 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
521 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522
523 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation. */
524 /* R_PPC64_TOC16 47 half16* S + A - .TOC. */
525 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
526 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
527
528 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation without overflow. */
529 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_LO 48 half16 #lo (S + A - .TOC.) */
530 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
531 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
532
533 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits. */
534 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HI 49 half16 #hi (S + A - .TOC.) */
535 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
536 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
537
538 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits, plus 1 if the
539 contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is
540 negative. */
541 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HA 50 half16 #ha (S + A - .TOC.) */
542 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
543 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc),
544
545 /* 64-bit relocation; insert value of TOC base (.TOC.). */
546 /* R_PPC64_TOC 51 doubleword64 .TOC. */
547 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
548 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc),
549
550 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but also informs the link editor that the
551 value to relocate may (!) refer to a PLT entry which the link
552 editor (a) may replace with the symbol value. If the link editor
553 is unable to fully resolve the symbol, it may (b) create a PLT
554 entry and store the address to the new PLT entry in the GOT.
555 This permits lazy resolution of function symbols at run time.
556 The link editor may also skip all of this and just (c) emit a
557 R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT to tie the symbol to the GOT entry. */
558 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16 not implemented. */
559 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE,signed,
560 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but without overflow. */
563 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
564 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
565 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
566
567 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address. */
568 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI not implemented. */
569 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
570 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
571
572 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address, plus
573 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
574 is negative. */
575 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA not implemented. */
576 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
577 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
578
579 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
580 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
581 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
582
583 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
584 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
585 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
586
587 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
588 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
589 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
590
591 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
592 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
593 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
594
595 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
596 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
597 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
598
599 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but for instructions with a DS field. */
600 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
601 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
602
603 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
604 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
605 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
606
607 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
608 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
609 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
610
611 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
612 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
613 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
614
615 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
616 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS not implemented. */
617 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
618 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619
620 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
621 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
622 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
623 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
624
625 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
626 HOW (R_PPC64_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
627 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
628
629 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
630 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
631
632 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
634
635 /* Marker reloc for optimizing r2 save in prologue rather than on
636 each plt call stub. */
637 HOW (R_PPC64_TOCSAVE, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
638 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
639
640 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
641 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
642 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
643
644 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
645 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
646
647 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
648 definition of its TLS sym. */
649 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPMOD64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
650 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
651
652 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
653 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
654 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
655 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
659 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
660 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
661
662 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
664 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
665
666 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
667 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
668 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
669
670 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
671 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
672 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
673
674 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
675 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
676 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
677
678 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
679 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
680 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
681
682 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
683 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
684 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
685
686 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
687 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
688 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
689
690 /* Like DTPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
691 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
692 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
693
694 /* Like DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
695 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
696 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697
698 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
699 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
700 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
701 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
702
703 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
704 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
705 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
706
707 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
708 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
709 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
710
711 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
712 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
713 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
714
715 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
716 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
717 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
718
719 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
720 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
721 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
722
723 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
724 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
725 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
726
727 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
728 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
729 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
730
731 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
732 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
733 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
734
735 /* Like TPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
736 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
737 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
738
739 /* Like TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
740 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
741 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
742
743 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
744 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
745 to the first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
746 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
747 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
748
749 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
750 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
751 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
752
753 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
754 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
755 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
756
757 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
758 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
759 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
760
761 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
762 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
763 first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
764 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
765 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
766
767 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
768 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
769 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
770
771 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
772 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
773 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
774
775 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
776 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
777 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
778
779 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
780 the offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
781 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
782 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
783
784 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
785 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
786 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
787
788 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
789 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
790 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
791
792 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
793 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
794 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
795
796 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
797 offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
798 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
799 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
800
801 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
802 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
803 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
804
805 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
806 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
807 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
808
809 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
810 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
811 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
812
813 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_IREL, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
814 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
815
816 HOW (R_PPC64_IRELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
817 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
818
819 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
820 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
821 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
822
823 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
824 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
825 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
826
827 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
828 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
829 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
830
831 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
832 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
833 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
834 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
835
836 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
837 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
838
839 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
840 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
841
842 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
843 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
844
845 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
846 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
847
848 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
849 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
850
851 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
852 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
853
854 /* Like R_PPC64_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
855 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
856 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
857
858 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
859 HOW (R_PPC64_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
860 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
861
862 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but no overflow. */
863 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
864 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
865
866 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but no overflow. */
867 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
868 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
869
870 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
871 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
872 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
873
874 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
875 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
876 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
877
878 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
879 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
880 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
881
882 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
883 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
884 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
885
886 /* Marker reloc on ELFv2 large-model function entry. */
887 HOW (R_PPC64_ENTRY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
888 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
889
890 /* Like ADDR64, but use local entry point of function. */
891 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
892 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
893
894 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
895 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
896
897 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
898 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
899
900 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
901 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
902
903 HOW (R_PPC64_D34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
904 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
905
906 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_LO, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
907 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
908
909 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HI30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
910 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
911
912 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HA30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
913 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
914
915 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
916 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
917
918 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
919 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
920
921 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
922 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
923
924 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
925 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
926
927 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
928 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
929
930 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
931 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
932
933 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
934 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
935
936 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
937 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
938
939 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
940 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
941
942 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
943 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
944
945 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
946 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
947
948 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
949 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
950
951 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
952 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
953
954 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
955 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
956
957 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
958 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
959
960 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
961 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
962
963 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
964 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
965
966 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
967 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
968
969 HOW (R_PPC64_D28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
970 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
971
972 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
973 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
974
975 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
976 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
977 NULL),
978
979 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
980 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
981 NULL),
982 };
983
984 \f
985 /* Initialize the ppc64_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can
986 be done. */
987
988 static void
989 ppc_howto_init (void)
990 {
991 unsigned int i, type;
992
993 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
994 {
995 type = ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
996 BFD_ASSERT (type < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table));
997 ppc64_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
998 }
999 }
1000
1001 static reloc_howto_type *
1002 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd, bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
1003 {
1004 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1005
1006 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1007 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1008 ppc_howto_init ();
1009
1010 switch (code)
1011 {
1012 default:
1013 /* xgettext:c-format */
1014 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd,
1015 (int) code);
1016 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1017 return NULL;
1018
1019 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1020 break;
1021 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC64_ADDR32;
1022 break;
1023 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC64_ADDR24;
1024 break;
1025 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16;
1026 break;
1027 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO;
1028 break;
1029 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI;
1030 break;
1031 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH;
1032 break;
1033 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
1034 break;
1035 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA;
1036 break;
1037 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14;
1038 break;
1039 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;
1040 break;
1041 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;
1042 break;
1043 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC64_REL24;
1044 break;
1045 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC: r = R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
1046 break;
1047 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC64_REL14;
1048 break;
1049 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN;
1050 break;
1051 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN;
1052 break;
1053 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16;
1054 break;
1055 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO;
1056 break;
1057 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HI;
1058 break;
1059 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HA;
1060 break;
1061 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC64_COPY;
1062 break;
1063 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT;
1064 break;
1065 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL32;
1066 break;
1067 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT32;
1068 break;
1069 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL32;
1070 break;
1071 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO;
1072 break;
1073 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HI;
1074 break;
1075 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HA;
1076 break;
1077 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF;
1078 break;
1079 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO;
1080 break;
1081 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI;
1082 break;
1083 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA;
1084 break;
1085 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1086 break;
1087 case BFD_RELOC_64: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1088 break;
1089 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER;
1090 break;
1091 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA;
1092 break;
1093 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST;
1094 break;
1095 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA;
1096 break;
1097 case BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL64;
1098 break;
1099 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT64;
1100 break;
1101 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL64;
1102 break;
1103 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC64_TOC16;
1104 break;
1105 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
1106 break;
1107 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HI;
1108 break;
1109 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
1110 break;
1111 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC: r = R_PPC64_TOC;
1112 break;
1113 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16;
1114 break;
1115 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO;
1116 break;
1117 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI;
1118 break;
1119 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA;
1120 break;
1121 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS;
1122 break;
1123 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS;
1124 break;
1125 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_DS;
1126 break;
1127 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS;
1128 break;
1129 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS;
1130 break;
1131 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS;
1132 break;
1133 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS;
1134 break;
1135 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_DS;
1136 break;
1137 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS;
1138 break;
1139 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS;
1140 break;
1141 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS;
1142 break;
1143 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TLS_PCREL:
1144 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC64_TLS;
1145 break;
1146 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC64_TLSGD;
1147 break;
1148 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC64_TLSLD;
1149 break;
1150 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC64_DTPMOD64;
1151 break;
1152 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16;
1153 break;
1154 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
1155 break;
1156 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI;
1157 break;
1158 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH;
1159 break;
1160 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
1161 break;
1162 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA;
1163 break;
1164 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
1165 break;
1166 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16;
1167 break;
1168 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO;
1169 break;
1170 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI;
1171 break;
1172 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH;
1173 break;
1174 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA;
1175 break;
1176 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA;
1177 break;
1178 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL64;
1179 break;
1180 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16;
1181 break;
1182 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;
1183 break;
1184 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;
1185 break;
1186 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;
1187 break;
1188 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16;
1189 break;
1190 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;
1191 break;
1192 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;
1193 break;
1194 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;
1195 break;
1196 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS;
1197 break;
1198 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1199 break;
1200 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI;
1201 break;
1202 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA;
1203 break;
1204 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS;
1205 break;
1206 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1207 break;
1208 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;
1209 break;
1210 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;
1211 break;
1212 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS;
1213 break;
1214 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1215 break;
1216 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER;
1217 break;
1218 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA;
1219 break;
1220 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST;
1221 break;
1222 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1223 break;
1224 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS;
1225 break;
1226 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1227 break;
1228 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER;
1229 break;
1230 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA;
1231 break;
1232 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST;
1233 break;
1234 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1235 break;
1236 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16;
1237 break;
1238 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_LO;
1239 break;
1240 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HI;
1241 break;
1242 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HA;
1243 break;
1244 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH;
1245 break;
1246 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA;
1247 break;
1248 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER;
1249 break;
1250 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA;
1251 break;
1252 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST;
1253 break;
1254 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA;
1255 break;
1256 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_16DX_HA;
1257 break;
1258 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA;
1259 break;
1260 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_ENTRY;
1261 break;
1262 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL;
1263 break;
1264 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34: r = R_PPC64_D34;
1265 break;
1266 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_LO: r = R_PPC64_D34_LO;
1267 break;
1268 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HI30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HI30;
1269 break;
1270 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HA30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HA30;
1271 break;
1272 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
1273 break;
1274 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34;
1275 break;
1276 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34;
1277 break;
1278 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
1279 break;
1280 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL34;
1281 break;
1282 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34;
1283 break;
1284 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34;
1285 break;
1286 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34;
1287 break;
1288 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34;
1289 break;
1290 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34;
1291 break;
1292 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34;
1293 break;
1294 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34;
1295 break;
1296 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34;
1297 break;
1298 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34;
1299 break;
1300 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34;
1301 break;
1302 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34;
1303 break;
1304 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34;
1305 break;
1306 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D28: r = R_PPC64_D28;
1307 break;
1308 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL28: r = R_PPC64_PCREL28;
1309 break;
1310 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT;
1311 break;
1312 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY;
1313 break;
1314 }
1315
1316 return ppc64_elf_howto_table[r];
1317 };
1318
1319 static reloc_howto_type *
1320 ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd, const char *r_name)
1321 {
1322 unsigned int i;
1323 static char *compat_map[][2] = {
1324 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34" },
1325 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34" },
1326 { "R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34", "R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34" },
1327 { "R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34", "R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34" }
1328 };
1329
1330 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1331 if (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
1332 && strcasecmp (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
1333 return &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1334
1335 /* Handle old names of relocations in case they were used by
1336 .reloc directives.
1337 FIXME: Remove this soon. Mapping the reloc names is very likely
1338 completely unnecessary. */
1339 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (compat_map); i++)
1340 if (strcasecmp (compat_map[i][0], r_name) == 0)
1341 {
1342 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: %s should be used rather than %s"),
1343 compat_map[i][1], compat_map[i][0]);
1344 return ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (abfd, compat_map[i][1]);
1345 }
1346
1347 return NULL;
1348 }
1349
1350 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
1351
1352 static bfd_boolean
1353 ppc64_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, arelent *cache_ptr,
1354 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
1355 {
1356 unsigned int type;
1357
1358 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1359 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1360 ppc_howto_init ();
1361
1362 type = ELF64_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
1363 if (type >= ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table))
1364 {
1365 /* xgettext:c-format */
1366 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1367 abfd, type);
1368 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1369 return FALSE;
1370 }
1371 cache_ptr->howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[type];
1372 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL || cache_ptr->howto->name == NULL)
1373 {
1374 /* xgettext:c-format */
1375 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1376 abfd, type);
1377 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1378 return FALSE;
1379 }
1380
1381 return TRUE;
1382 }
1383
1384 /* Handle the R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA and similar relocs. */
1385
1386 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1387 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1388 void *data, asection *input_section,
1389 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1390 {
1391 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1392 long insn;
1393 bfd_size_type octets;
1394 bfd_vma value;
1395
1396 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1397 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1398 link time. */
1399 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1400 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1401 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1402
1403 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 (or 34) bits.
1404 We won't actually be using the low bits, so trashing them
1405 doesn't matter. */
1406 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1407 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34
1408 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34
1409 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34
1410 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34)
1411 reloc_entry->addend += 1ULL << 33;
1412 else
1413 reloc_entry->addend += 1U << 15;
1414 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
1415 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1416
1417 value = 0;
1418 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1419 value = symbol->value;
1420 value += (reloc_entry->addend
1421 + symbol->section->output_offset
1422 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
1423 value -= (reloc_entry->address
1424 + input_section->output_offset
1425 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1426 value = (bfd_signed_vma) value >> 16;
1427
1428 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1429 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1430 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
1431 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
1432 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1433 if (value + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
1434 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1435 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1436 }
1437
1438 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1439 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1440 void *data, asection *input_section,
1441 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1442 {
1443 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1444 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1445 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1446
1447 if (strcmp (symbol->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1448 && (symbol->section->owner->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1449 {
1450 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (symbol->section,
1451 symbol->value + reloc_entry->addend,
1452 NULL, NULL, FALSE);
1453 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
1454 reloc_entry->addend = dest - (symbol->value
1455 + symbol->section->output_section->vma
1456 + symbol->section->output_offset);
1457 }
1458 else
1459 {
1460 elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symbol;
1461
1462 if (symbol->section->owner != abfd
1463 && symbol->section->owner != NULL
1464 && abiversion (symbol->section->owner) >= 2)
1465 {
1466 unsigned int i;
1467
1468 for (i = 0; i < symbol->section->owner->symcount; ++i)
1469 {
1470 asymbol *symdef = symbol->section->owner->outsymbols[i];
1471
1472 if (strcmp (symdef->name, symbol->name) == 0)
1473 {
1474 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symdef;
1475 break;
1476 }
1477 }
1478 }
1479 reloc_entry->addend
1480 += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
1481 }
1482 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1483 }
1484
1485 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1486 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1487 void *data, asection *input_section,
1488 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1489 {
1490 long insn;
1491 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1492 bfd_size_type octets;
1493 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
1494 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
1495
1496 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1497 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1498 link time. */
1499 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1500 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1501 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1502
1503 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1504 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1505 insn &= ~(0x01 << 21);
1506 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1507 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
1508 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN)
1509 insn |= 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
1510
1511 if (is_isa_v2)
1512 {
1513 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
1514 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
1515 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
1516 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
1517 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
1518 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
1519 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
1520 else
1521 goto out;
1522 }
1523 else
1524 {
1525 bfd_vma target = 0;
1526 bfd_vma from;
1527
1528 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1529 target = symbol->value;
1530 target += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1531 target += symbol->section->output_offset;
1532 target += reloc_entry->addend;
1533
1534 from = (reloc_entry->address
1535 + input_section->output_offset
1536 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1537
1538 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
1539 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (target - from) < 0)
1540 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
1541 }
1542 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1543 out:
1544 return ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1545 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1546 }
1547
1548 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1549 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1550 void *data, asection *input_section,
1551 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1552 {
1553 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1554 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1555 link time. */
1556 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1557 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1558 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1559
1560 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1561 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1562 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1563 }
1564
1565 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1566 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1567 void *data, asection *input_section,
1568 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1569 {
1570 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1571 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1572 link time. */
1573 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1574 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1575 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1576
1577 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1578 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1579
1580 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1581 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1582 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1583 }
1584
1585 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1586 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1587 void *data, asection *input_section,
1588 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1589 {
1590 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1591
1592 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1593 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1594 link time. */
1595 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1596 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1597 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1598
1599 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1600 if (TOCstart == 0)
1601 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1602
1603 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1604 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1605 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1606 }
1607
1608 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1609 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1610 void *data, asection *input_section,
1611 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1612 {
1613 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1614
1615 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1616 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1617 link time. */
1618 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1619 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1620 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1621
1622 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1623 if (TOCstart == 0)
1624 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1625
1626 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1627 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1628
1629 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1630 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1631 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1632 }
1633
1634 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1635 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1636 void *data, asection *input_section,
1637 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1638 {
1639 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1640 bfd_size_type octets;
1641
1642 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1643 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1644 link time. */
1645 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1646 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1647 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1648
1649 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1650 if (TOCstart == 0)
1651 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1652
1653 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1654 bfd_put_64 (abfd, TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1655 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1656 }
1657
1658 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1659 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1660 void *data, asection *input_section,
1661 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1662 {
1663 uint64_t insn;
1664 bfd_vma targ;
1665
1666 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1667 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1668 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1669
1670 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1671 insn <<= 32;
1672 insn |= bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1673
1674 targ = (symbol->section->output_section->vma
1675 + symbol->section->output_offset
1676 + reloc_entry->addend);
1677 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1678 targ += symbol->value;
1679 if (reloc_entry->howto->type == R_PPC64_D34_HA30)
1680 targ += 1ULL << 33;
1681 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1682 {
1683 bfd_vma from = (reloc_entry->address
1684 + input_section->output_offset
1685 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1686 targ -=from;
1687 }
1688 targ >>= reloc_entry->howto->rightshift;
1689 insn &= ~reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1690 insn |= ((targ << 16) | (targ & 0xffff)) & reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1691 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1692 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1693 if (reloc_entry->howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
1694 && (targ + (1ULL << (reloc_entry->howto->bitsize - 1))
1695 >= 1ULL << reloc_entry->howto->bitsize))
1696 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1697 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1698 }
1699
1700 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1701 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1702 void *data, asection *input_section,
1703 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1704 {
1705 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1706 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1707 link time. */
1708 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1709 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1710 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1711
1712 if (error_message != NULL)
1713 {
1714 static char buf[60];
1715 sprintf (buf, "generic linker can't handle %s",
1716 reloc_entry->howto->name);
1717 *error_message = buf;
1718 }
1719 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1720 }
1721
1722 /* Track GOT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
1723 than one got entry per symbol. */
1724 struct got_entry
1725 {
1726 struct got_entry *next;
1727
1728 /* The symbol addend that we'll be placing in the GOT. */
1729 bfd_vma addend;
1730
1731 /* Unlike other ELF targets, we use separate GOT entries for the same
1732 symbol referenced from different input files. This is to support
1733 automatic multiple TOC/GOT sections, where the TOC base can vary
1734 from one input file to another. After partitioning into TOC groups
1735 we merge entries within the group.
1736
1737 Point to the BFD owning this GOT entry. */
1738 bfd *owner;
1739
1740 /* Zero for non-tls entries, or TLS_TLS and one of TLS_GD, TLS_LD,
1741 TLS_TPREL or TLS_DTPREL for tls entries. */
1742 unsigned char tls_type;
1743
1744 /* Non-zero if got.ent points to real entry. */
1745 unsigned char is_indirect;
1746
1747 /* Reference count until size_dynamic_sections, GOT offset thereafter. */
1748 union
1749 {
1750 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1751 bfd_vma offset;
1752 struct got_entry *ent;
1753 } got;
1754 };
1755
1756 /* The same for PLT. */
1757 struct plt_entry
1758 {
1759 struct plt_entry *next;
1760
1761 bfd_vma addend;
1762
1763 union
1764 {
1765 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1766 bfd_vma offset;
1767 } plt;
1768 };
1769
1770 struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata
1771 {
1772 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1773
1774 /* Shortcuts to dynamic linker sections. */
1775 asection *got;
1776 asection *relgot;
1777
1778 /* Used during garbage collection. We attach global symbols defined
1779 on removed .opd entries to this section so that the sym is removed. */
1780 asection *deleted_section;
1781
1782 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. Support for multiple GOT
1783 sections means we potentially need one of these for each input bfd. */
1784 struct got_entry tlsld_got;
1785
1786 union
1787 {
1788 /* A copy of relocs before they are modified for --emit-relocs. */
1789 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
1790
1791 /* Section contents. */
1792 bfd_byte *contents;
1793 } opd;
1794
1795 /* Nonzero if this bfd has small toc/got relocs, ie. that expect
1796 the reloc to be in the range -32768 to 32767. */
1797 unsigned int has_small_toc_reloc : 1;
1798
1799 /* Set if toc/got ha relocs detected not using r2, or lo reloc
1800 instruction not one we handle. */
1801 unsigned int unexpected_toc_insn : 1;
1802
1803 /* Set if PLT/GOT/TOC relocs that can be optimised are present in
1804 this file. */
1805 unsigned int has_optrel : 1;
1806 };
1807
1808 #define ppc64_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1809 ((struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1810
1811 #define ppc64_tlsld_got(bfd) \
1812 (&ppc64_elf_tdata (bfd)->tlsld_got)
1813
1814 #define is_ppc64_elf(bfd) \
1815 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1816 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC64_ELF_DATA)
1817
1818 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1819
1820 static bfd_boolean
1821 ppc64_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1822 {
1823 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata),
1824 PPC64_ELF_DATA);
1825 }
1826
1827 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 64 bit input bfd when the
1828 default is 32 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1829
1830 static bfd_boolean
1831 ppc64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1832 {
1833 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1834 return TRUE;
1835
1836 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
1837 {
1838 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1839
1840 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
1841 {
1842 /* Relies on arch after 32 bit default being 64 bit default. */
1843 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1844 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64);
1845 }
1846 }
1847 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1848 }
1849
1850 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1851
1852 static bfd_boolean
1853 ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1854 {
1855 size_t offset, size;
1856
1857 if (note->descsz != 504)
1858 return FALSE;
1859
1860 /* pr_cursig */
1861 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1862
1863 /* pr_pid */
1864 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
1865
1866 /* pr_reg */
1867 offset = 112;
1868 size = 384;
1869
1870 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1871 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1872 size, note->descpos + offset);
1873 }
1874
1875 static bfd_boolean
1876 ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1877 {
1878 if (note->descsz != 136)
1879 return FALSE;
1880
1881 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1882 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1883 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1884 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
1885 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1886 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
1887
1888 return TRUE;
1889 }
1890
1891 static char *
1892 ppc64_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type,
1893 ...)
1894 {
1895 switch (note_type)
1896 {
1897 default:
1898 return NULL;
1899
1900 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1901 {
1902 char data[136] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1903 va_list ap;
1904
1905 va_start (ap, note_type);
1906 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1907 strncpy (data + 40, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1908 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1909 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1910 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1911 -Wstringop-truncation:
1912 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1913 */
1914 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1915 #endif
1916 strncpy (data + 56, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1917 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1918 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1919 #endif
1920 va_end (ap);
1921 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1922 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1923 }
1924
1925 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1926 {
1927 char data[504];
1928 va_list ap;
1929 long pid;
1930 int cursig;
1931 const void *greg;
1932
1933 va_start (ap, note_type);
1934 memset (data, 0, 112);
1935 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1936 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 32);
1937 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1938 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1939 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1940 memcpy (data + 112, greg, 384);
1941 memset (data + 496, 0, 8);
1942 va_end (ap);
1943 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1944 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1945 }
1946 }
1947 }
1948
1949 /* Add extra PPC sections. */
1950
1951 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc64_elf_special_sections[] =
1952 {
1953 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, 0 },
1954 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1955 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1956 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1957 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1958 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tocbss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1959 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1960 };
1961
1962 enum _ppc64_sec_type {
1963 sec_normal = 0,
1964 sec_opd = 1,
1965 sec_toc = 2
1966 };
1967
1968 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data
1969 {
1970 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
1971
1972 union
1973 {
1974 /* An array with one entry for each opd function descriptor,
1975 and some spares since opd entries may be either 16 or 24 bytes. */
1976 #define OPD_NDX(OFF) ((OFF) >> 4)
1977 struct _opd_sec_data
1978 {
1979 /* Points to the function code section for local opd entries. */
1980 asection **func_sec;
1981
1982 /* After editing .opd, adjust references to opd local syms. */
1983 long *adjust;
1984 } opd;
1985
1986 /* An array for toc sections, indexed by offset/8. */
1987 struct _toc_sec_data
1988 {
1989 /* Specifies the relocation symbol index used at a given toc offset. */
1990 unsigned *symndx;
1991
1992 /* And the relocation addend. */
1993 bfd_vma *add;
1994 } toc;
1995 } u;
1996
1997 enum _ppc64_sec_type sec_type:2;
1998
1999 /* Flag set when small branches are detected. Used to
2000 select suitable defaults for the stub group size. */
2001 unsigned int has_14bit_branch:1;
2002
2003 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2004 unsigned int has_pltcall:1;
2005
2006 /* Flag set when section has PLT/GOT/TOC relocations that can be
2007 optimised. */
2008 unsigned int has_optrel:1;
2009 };
2010
2011 #define ppc64_elf_section_data(sec) \
2012 ((struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
2013
2014 static bfd_boolean
2015 ppc64_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2016 {
2017 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
2018 {
2019 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *sdata;
2020 size_t amt = sizeof (*sdata);
2021
2022 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2023 if (sdata == NULL)
2024 return FALSE;
2025 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2026 }
2027
2028 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2029 }
2030
2031 static bfd_boolean
2032 ppc64_elf_section_flags (const Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
2033 {
2034 const char *name = hdr->bfd_section->name;
2035
2036 if (strncmp (name, ".sbss", 5) == 0
2037 || strncmp (name, ".sdata", 6) == 0)
2038 hdr->bfd_section->flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
2039
2040 return TRUE;
2041 }
2042
2043 static struct _opd_sec_data *
2044 get_opd_info (asection * sec)
2045 {
2046 if (sec != NULL
2047 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) != NULL
2048 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd)
2049 return &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
2050 return NULL;
2051 }
2052 \f
2053 /* Parameters for the qsort hook. */
2054 static bfd_boolean synthetic_relocatable;
2055 static asection *synthetic_opd;
2056
2057 /* qsort comparison function for ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab. */
2058
2059 static int
2060 compare_symbols (const void *ap, const void *bp)
2061 {
2062 const asymbol *a = *(const asymbol **) ap;
2063 const asymbol *b = *(const asymbol **) bp;
2064
2065 /* Section symbols first. */
2066 if ((a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && !(b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2067 return -1;
2068 if (!(a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && (b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2069 return 1;
2070
2071 /* then .opd symbols. */
2072 if (synthetic_opd != NULL)
2073 {
2074 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") == 0
2075 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2076 return -1;
2077 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") != 0
2078 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2079 return 1;
2080 }
2081
2082 /* then other code symbols. */
2083 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2084 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2085 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2086 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2087 return -1;
2088
2089 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2090 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2091 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2092 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2093 return 1;
2094
2095 if (synthetic_relocatable)
2096 {
2097 if (a->section->id < b->section->id)
2098 return -1;
2099
2100 if (a->section->id > b->section->id)
2101 return 1;
2102 }
2103
2104 if (a->value + a->section->vma < b->value + b->section->vma)
2105 return -1;
2106
2107 if (a->value + a->section->vma > b->value + b->section->vma)
2108 return 1;
2109
2110 /* For syms with the same value, prefer strong dynamic global function
2111 syms over other syms. */
2112 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0)
2113 return -1;
2114
2115 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0)
2116 return 1;
2117
2118 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0)
2119 return -1;
2120
2121 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
2122 return 1;
2123
2124 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0)
2125 return -1;
2126
2127 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0)
2128 return 1;
2129
2130 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0)
2131 return -1;
2132
2133 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
2134 return 1;
2135
2136 /* Finally, sort on where the symbol is in memory. The symbols will
2137 be in at most two malloc'd blocks, one for static syms, one for
2138 dynamic syms, and we distinguish the two blocks above by testing
2139 BSF_DYNAMIC. Since we are sorting the symbol pointers which were
2140 originally in the same order as the symbols (and we're not
2141 sorting the symbols themselves), this ensures a stable sort. */
2142 if (a < b)
2143 return -1;
2144 if (a > b)
2145 return 1;
2146 return 0;
2147 }
2148
2149 /* Search SYMS for a symbol of the given VALUE. */
2150
2151 static asymbol *
2152 sym_exists_at (asymbol **syms, size_t lo, size_t hi, unsigned int id,
2153 bfd_vma value)
2154 {
2155 size_t mid;
2156
2157 if (id == (unsigned) -1)
2158 {
2159 while (lo < hi)
2160 {
2161 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2162 if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma < value)
2163 lo = mid + 1;
2164 else if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma > value)
2165 hi = mid;
2166 else
2167 return syms[mid];
2168 }
2169 }
2170 else
2171 {
2172 while (lo < hi)
2173 {
2174 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2175 if (syms[mid]->section->id < id)
2176 lo = mid + 1;
2177 else if (syms[mid]->section->id > id)
2178 hi = mid;
2179 else if (syms[mid]->value < value)
2180 lo = mid + 1;
2181 else if (syms[mid]->value > value)
2182 hi = mid;
2183 else
2184 return syms[mid];
2185 }
2186 }
2187 return NULL;
2188 }
2189
2190 static bfd_boolean
2191 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
2192 {
2193 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
2194 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2195 && section->vma <= vma
2196 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
2197 }
2198
2199 /* Create synthetic symbols, effectively restoring "dot-symbol" function
2200 entry syms. Also generate @plt symbols for the glink branch table.
2201 Returns count of synthetic symbols in RET or -1 on error. */
2202
2203 static long
2204 ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
2205 long static_count, asymbol **static_syms,
2206 long dyn_count, asymbol **dyn_syms,
2207 asymbol **ret)
2208 {
2209 asymbol *s;
2210 size_t i, j, count;
2211 char *names;
2212 size_t symcount, codesecsym, codesecsymend, secsymend, opdsymend;
2213 asection *opd = NULL;
2214 bfd_boolean relocatable = (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0;
2215 asymbol **syms;
2216 int abi = abiversion (abfd);
2217
2218 *ret = NULL;
2219
2220 if (abi < 2)
2221 {
2222 opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".opd");
2223 if (opd == NULL && abi == 1)
2224 return 0;
2225 }
2226
2227 syms = NULL;
2228 codesecsym = 0;
2229 codesecsymend = 0;
2230 secsymend = 0;
2231 opdsymend = 0;
2232 symcount = 0;
2233 if (opd != NULL)
2234 {
2235 symcount = static_count;
2236 if (!relocatable)
2237 symcount += dyn_count;
2238 if (symcount == 0)
2239 return 0;
2240
2241 syms = bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2242 if (syms == NULL)
2243 return -1;
2244
2245 if (!relocatable && static_count != 0 && dyn_count != 0)
2246 {
2247 /* Use both symbol tables. */
2248 memcpy (syms, static_syms, static_count * sizeof (*syms));
2249 memcpy (syms + static_count, dyn_syms,
2250 (dyn_count + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2251 }
2252 else if (!relocatable && static_count == 0)
2253 memcpy (syms, dyn_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2254 else
2255 memcpy (syms, static_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2256
2257 /* Trim uninteresting symbols. Interesting symbols are section,
2258 function, and notype symbols. */
2259 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < symcount; ++i)
2260 if ((syms[i]->flags & (BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
2261 | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) == 0)
2262 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2263 symcount = j;
2264
2265 synthetic_relocatable = relocatable;
2266 synthetic_opd = opd;
2267 qsort (syms, symcount, sizeof (*syms), compare_symbols);
2268
2269 if (!relocatable && symcount > 1)
2270 {
2271 /* Trim duplicate syms, since we may have merged the normal
2272 and dynamic symbols. Actually, we only care about syms
2273 that have different values, so trim any with the same
2274 value. Don't consider ifunc and ifunc resolver symbols
2275 duplicates however, because GDB wants to know whether a
2276 text symbol is an ifunc resolver. */
2277 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < symcount; ++i)
2278 {
2279 const asymbol *s0 = syms[i - 1];
2280 const asymbol *s1 = syms[i];
2281
2282 if ((s0->value + s0->section->vma
2283 != s1->value + s1->section->vma)
2284 || ((s0->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)
2285 != (s1->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)))
2286 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2287 }
2288 symcount = j;
2289 }
2290
2291 i = 0;
2292 /* Note that here and in compare_symbols we can't compare opd and
2293 sym->section directly. With separate debug info files, the
2294 symbols will be extracted from the debug file while abfd passed
2295 to this function is the real binary. */
2296 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2297 ++i;
2298 codesecsym = i;
2299
2300 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2301 if (((syms[i]->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC
2302 | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2303 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2304 || (syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2305 break;
2306 codesecsymend = i;
2307
2308 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2309 if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2310 break;
2311 secsymend = i;
2312
2313 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2314 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2315 break;
2316 opdsymend = i;
2317
2318 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2319 if (((syms[i]->section->flags
2320 & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
2321 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2322 break;
2323 symcount = i;
2324 }
2325 count = 0;
2326
2327 if (relocatable)
2328 {
2329 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2330 arelent *r;
2331 size_t size;
2332 size_t relcount;
2333
2334 if (opdsymend == secsymend)
2335 goto done;
2336
2337 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2338 relcount = (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) ? opd->reloc_count : 0;
2339 if (relcount == 0)
2340 goto done;
2341
2342 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, opd, static_syms, FALSE))
2343 {
2344 count = -1;
2345 goto done;
2346 }
2347
2348 size = 0;
2349 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2350 {
2351 asymbol *sym;
2352
2353 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2354 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2355 ++r;
2356
2357 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2358 break;
2359
2360 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2361 continue;
2362
2363 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2364 continue;
2365
2366 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2367 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2368 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2369 {
2370 ++count;
2371 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2372 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2373 }
2374 }
2375
2376 if (size == 0)
2377 goto done;
2378 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2379 if (s == NULL)
2380 {
2381 count = -1;
2382 goto done;
2383 }
2384
2385 names = (char *) (s + count);
2386
2387 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2388 {
2389 asymbol *sym;
2390
2391 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2392 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2393 ++r;
2394
2395 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2396 break;
2397
2398 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2399 continue;
2400
2401 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2402 continue;
2403
2404 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2405 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2406 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2407 {
2408 size_t len;
2409
2410 *s = *syms[i];
2411 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2412 s->section = sym->section;
2413 s->value = sym->value + r->addend;
2414 s->name = names;
2415 *names++ = '.';
2416 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2417 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2418 names += len + 1;
2419 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2420 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2421 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2422 s++;
2423 }
2424 }
2425 }
2426 else
2427 {
2428 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2429 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
2430 size_t size;
2431 size_t plt_count = 0;
2432 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0, resolv_vma = 0;
2433 asection *dynamic, *glink = NULL, *relplt = NULL;
2434 arelent *p;
2435
2436 if (opd != NULL && !bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, opd, &contents))
2437 {
2438 free_contents_and_exit_err:
2439 count = -1;
2440 free_contents_and_exit:
2441 free (contents);
2442 goto done;
2443 }
2444
2445 size = 0;
2446 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2447 {
2448 bfd_vma ent;
2449
2450 /* Ignore bogus symbols. */
2451 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2452 continue;
2453
2454 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2455 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2456 {
2457 ++count;
2458 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2459 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2460 }
2461 }
2462
2463 /* Get start of .glink stubs from DT_PPC64_GLINK. */
2464 if (dyn_count != 0
2465 && (dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")) != NULL)
2466 {
2467 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
2468 size_t extdynsize;
2469 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
2470
2471 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
2472 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2473
2474 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
2475 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
2476
2477 extdyn = dynbuf;
2478 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
2479 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
2480 {
2481 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
2482 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
2483
2484 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
2485 break;
2486
2487 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC64_GLINK)
2488 {
2489 /* The first glink stub starts at DT_PPC64_GLINK plus 32.
2490 See comment in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections. */
2491 glink_vma = dyn.d_un.d_val + 8 * 4;
2492 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
2493 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
2494 glink stubs now reside. */
2495 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma,
2496 &glink_vma);
2497 break;
2498 }
2499 }
2500
2501 free (dynbuf);
2502 }
2503
2504 if (glink != NULL)
2505 {
2506 /* Determine __glink trampoline by reading the relative branch
2507 from the first glink stub. */
2508 bfd_byte buf[4];
2509 unsigned int off = 0;
2510
2511 while (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
2512 glink_vma + off - glink->vma, 4))
2513 {
2514 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
2515 insn ^= B_DOT;
2516 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
2517 {
2518 resolv_vma
2519 = glink_vma + off + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
2520 break;
2521 }
2522 off += 4;
2523 if (off > 4)
2524 break;
2525 }
2526
2527 if (resolv_vma)
2528 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2529
2530 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
2531 if (relplt != NULL)
2532 {
2533 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2534 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dyn_syms, TRUE))
2535 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2536
2537 plt_count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
2538 size += plt_count * sizeof (asymbol);
2539
2540 p = relplt->relocation;
2541 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2542 {
2543 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
2544 if (p->addend != 0)
2545 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 16;
2546 }
2547 }
2548 }
2549
2550 if (size == 0)
2551 goto free_contents_and_exit;
2552 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2553 if (s == NULL)
2554 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2555
2556 names = (char *) (s + count + plt_count + (resolv_vma != 0));
2557
2558 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2559 {
2560 bfd_vma ent;
2561
2562 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2563 continue;
2564
2565 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2566 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2567 {
2568 size_t lo, hi;
2569 size_t len;
2570 asection *sec = abfd->sections;
2571
2572 *s = *syms[i];
2573 lo = codesecsym;
2574 hi = codesecsymend;
2575 while (lo < hi)
2576 {
2577 size_t mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2578 if (syms[mid]->section->vma < ent)
2579 lo = mid + 1;
2580 else if (syms[mid]->section->vma > ent)
2581 hi = mid;
2582 else
2583 {
2584 sec = syms[mid]->section;
2585 break;
2586 }
2587 }
2588
2589 if (lo >= hi && lo > codesecsym)
2590 sec = syms[lo - 1]->section;
2591
2592 for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2593 {
2594 if (sec->vma > ent)
2595 break;
2596 /* SEC_LOAD may not be set if SEC is from a separate debug
2597 info file. */
2598 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2599 break;
2600 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2601 s->section = sec;
2602 }
2603 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2604 s->value = ent - s->section->vma;
2605 s->name = names;
2606 *names++ = '.';
2607 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2608 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2609 names += len + 1;
2610 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2611 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2612 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2613 s++;
2614 }
2615 }
2616 free (contents);
2617
2618 if (glink != NULL && relplt != NULL)
2619 {
2620 if (resolv_vma)
2621 {
2622 /* Add a symbol for the main glink trampoline. */
2623 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2624 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2625 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2626 s->section = glink;
2627 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2628 s->name = names;
2629 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve",
2630 sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2631 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2632 s++;
2633 count++;
2634 }
2635
2636 /* FIXME: It would be very much nicer to put sym@plt on the
2637 stub rather than on the glink branch table entry. The
2638 objdump disassembler would then use a sensible symbol
2639 name on plt calls. The difficulty in doing so is
2640 a) finding the stubs, and,
2641 b) matching stubs against plt entries, and,
2642 c) there can be multiple stubs for a given plt entry.
2643
2644 Solving (a) could be done by code scanning, but older
2645 ppc64 binaries used different stubs to current code.
2646 (b) is the tricky one since you need to known the toc
2647 pointer for at least one function that uses a pic stub to
2648 be able to calculate the plt address referenced.
2649 (c) means gdb would need to set multiple breakpoints (or
2650 find the glink branch itself) when setting breakpoints
2651 for pending shared library loads. */
2652 p = relplt->relocation;
2653 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2654 {
2655 size_t len;
2656
2657 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
2658 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
2659 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
2660 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
2661 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
2662 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2663 s->section = glink;
2664 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2665 s->name = names;
2666 s->udata.p = NULL;
2667 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
2668 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
2669 names += len;
2670 if (p->addend != 0)
2671 {
2672 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
2673 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
2674 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
2675 names += strlen (names);
2676 }
2677 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
2678 names += sizeof ("@plt");
2679 s++;
2680 if (abi < 2)
2681 {
2682 glink_vma += 8;
2683 if (i >= 0x8000)
2684 glink_vma += 4;
2685 }
2686 else
2687 glink_vma += 4;
2688 }
2689 count += plt_count;
2690 }
2691 }
2692
2693 done:
2694 free (syms);
2695 return count;
2696 }
2697 \f
2698 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2699 functions above are used generally. Those named ppc64_elf_* are
2700 called by the main ELF linker code. They appear in this file more
2701 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2702 ppc64_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2703 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2704 called.
2705
2706 PowerPC64-ELF uses a similar scheme to PowerPC64-XCOFF in that
2707 functions have both a function code symbol and a function descriptor
2708 symbol. A call to foo in a relocatable object file looks like:
2709
2710 . .text
2711 . x:
2712 . bl .foo
2713 . nop
2714
2715 The function definition in another object file might be:
2716
2717 . .section .opd
2718 . foo: .quad .foo
2719 . .quad .TOC.@tocbase
2720 . .quad 0
2721 .
2722 . .text
2723 . .foo: blr
2724
2725 When the linker resolves the call during a static link, the branch
2726 unsurprisingly just goes to .foo and the .opd information is unused.
2727 If the function definition is in a shared library, things are a little
2728 different: The call goes via a plt call stub, the opd information gets
2729 copied to the plt, and the linker patches the nop.
2730
2731 . x:
2732 . bl .foo_stub
2733 . ld 2,40(1)
2734 .
2735 .
2736 . .foo_stub:
2737 . std 2,40(1) # in practice, the call stub
2738 . addis 11,2,Lfoo@toc@ha # is slightly optimized, but
2739 . addi 11,11,Lfoo@toc@l # this is the general idea
2740 . ld 12,0(11)
2741 . ld 2,8(11)
2742 . mtctr 12
2743 . ld 11,16(11)
2744 . bctr
2745 .
2746 . .section .plt
2747 . Lfoo: reloc (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, foo)
2748
2749 The "reloc ()" notation is supposed to indicate that the linker emits
2750 an R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT reloc against foo. The dynamic linker does the opd
2751 copying.
2752
2753 What are the difficulties here? Well, firstly, the relocations
2754 examined by the linker in check_relocs are against the function code
2755 sym .foo, while the dynamic relocation in the plt is emitted against
2756 the function descriptor symbol, foo. Somewhere along the line, we need
2757 to carefully copy dynamic link information from one symbol to the other.
2758 Secondly, the generic part of the elf linker will make .foo a dynamic
2759 symbol as is normal for most other backends. We need foo dynamic
2760 instead, at least for an application final link. However, when
2761 creating a shared library containing foo, we need to have both symbols
2762 dynamic so that references to .foo are satisfied during the early
2763 stages of linking. Otherwise the linker might decide to pull in a
2764 definition from some other object, eg. a static library.
2765
2766 Update: As of August 2004, we support a new convention. Function
2767 calls may use the function descriptor symbol, ie. "bl foo". This
2768 behaves exactly as "bl .foo". */
2769
2770 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2771 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2772 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2773
2774 static int
2775 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2776 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
2777 {
2778 switch (r_type)
2779 {
2780 default:
2781 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2782 address isn't fixed. DTPREL64 is excluded because the
2783 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2784 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC64_OPT_TLS is set. */
2785 return 1;
2786
2787 case R_PPC64_REL32:
2788 case R_PPC64_REL64:
2789 case R_PPC64_REL30:
2790 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
2791 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
2792 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
2793 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
2794 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
2795 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
2796 return 0;
2797
2798 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
2799 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
2800 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
2801 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
2802 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
2803 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
2804 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
2805 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
2806 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
2807 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
2808 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
2809 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
2810 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
2811 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
2812 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2813 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2814 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2815 }
2816 }
2817
2818 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2819 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's .dynbss
2820 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2821 shared lib. With code that gcc generates it is vital that this be
2822 enabled; In the PowerPC64 ELFv1 ABI the address of a function is
2823 actually the address of a function descriptor which resides in the
2824 .opd section. gcc uses the descriptor directly rather than going
2825 via the GOT as some other ABIs do, which means that initialized
2826 function pointers reference the descriptor. Thus, a function
2827 pointer initialized to the address of a function in a shared
2828 library will either require a .dynbss copy and a copy reloc, or a
2829 dynamic reloc. Using a .dynbss copy redefines the function
2830 descriptor symbol to point to the copy. This presents a problem as
2831 a PLT entry for that function is also initialized from the function
2832 descriptor symbol and the copy may not be initialized first. */
2833 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2834
2835 /* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
2836 string. */
2837 #define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
2838
2839 /* Linker stubs.
2840 ppc_stub_long_branch:
2841 Used when a 14 bit branch (or even a 24 bit branch) can't reach its
2842 destination, but a 24 bit branch in a stub section will reach.
2843 . b dest
2844
2845 ppc_stub_plt_branch:
2846 Similar to the above, but a 24 bit branch in the stub section won't
2847 reach its destination.
2848 . addis %r12,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2849 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r12)
2850 . mtctr %r12
2851 . bctr
2852
2853 ppc_stub_plt_call:
2854 Used to call a function in a shared library. If it so happens that
2855 the plt entry referenced crosses a 64k boundary, then an extra
2856 "addi %r11,%r11,xxx@toc@l" will be inserted before the "mtctr".
2857 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save starts with "std %r2,40(%r1)".
2858 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2859 . ld %r12,xxx+0@toc@l(%r11)
2860 . mtctr %r12
2861 . ld %r2,xxx+8@toc@l(%r11)
2862 . ld %r11,xxx+16@toc@l(%r11)
2863 . bctr
2864
2865 ppc_stub_long_branch and ppc_stub_plt_branch may also have additional
2866 code to adjust the value and save r2 to support multiple toc sections.
2867 A ppc_stub_long_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2868 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2869 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2870 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2871 . b dest
2872
2873 A ppc_stub_plt_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2874 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2875 . addis %r12,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2876 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r12)
2877 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2878 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2879 . mtctr %r12
2880 . bctr
2881
2882 All of the above stubs are shown as their ELFv1 variants. ELFv2
2883 variants exist too, simpler for plt calls since a new toc pointer
2884 and static chain are not loaded by the stub. In addition, ELFv2
2885 has some more complex stubs to handle calls marked with NOTOC
2886 relocs from functions where r2 is not a valid toc pointer. These
2887 come in two flavours, the ones shown below, and _both variants that
2888 start with "std %r2,24(%r1)" to save r2 in the unlikely event that
2889 one call is from a function where r2 is used as the toc pointer but
2890 needs a toc adjusting stub for small-model multi-toc, and another
2891 call is from a function where r2 is not valid.
2892 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2893 . mflr %r12
2894 . bcl 20,31,1f
2895 . 1:
2896 . mflr %r11
2897 . mtlr %r12
2898 . addis %r12,%r11,dest-1b@ha
2899 . addi %r12,%r12,dest-1b@l
2900 . b dest
2901
2902 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2903 . mflr %r12
2904 . bcl 20,31,1f
2905 . 1:
2906 . mflr %r11
2907 . mtlr %r12
2908 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2909 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2910 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2911 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2912 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2913 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2914 . mtctr %r12
2915 . bctr
2916
2917 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2918 . mflr %r12
2919 . bcl 20,31,1f
2920 . 1:
2921 . mflr %r11
2922 . mtlr %r12
2923 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2924 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2925 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2926 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2927 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2928 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2929 . mtctr %r12
2930 . bctr
2931
2932 There are also ELFv1 power10 variants of these stubs.
2933 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2934 . pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2935 . b dest
2936 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2937 . lis %r11,(dest-1f)@highesta34
2938 . ori %r11,%r11,(dest-1f)@highera34
2939 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2940 . 1: pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2941 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2942 . mtctr %r12
2943 . bctr
2944 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2945 . lis %r11,(xxx-1f)@highesta34
2946 . ori %r11,%r11,(xxx-1f)@highera34
2947 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2948 . 1: pla %r12,xxx@pcrel
2949 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2950 . mtctr %r12
2951 . bctr
2952
2953 In cases where the high instructions would add zero, they are
2954 omitted and following instructions modified in some cases.
2955 For example, a power10 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc might simplify down
2956 to
2957 . pld %r12,xxx@pcrel
2958 . mtctr %r12
2959 . bctr
2960
2961 For a given stub group (a set of sections all using the same toc
2962 pointer value) there will be just one stub type used for any
2963 particular function symbol. For example, if printf is called from
2964 code with the tocsave optimization (ie. r2 saved in function
2965 prologue) and therefore calls use a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub,
2966 and from other code without the tocsave optimization requiring a
2967 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save linkage stub, a single stub of the latter
2968 type will be created. Calls with the tocsave optimization will
2969 enter this stub after the instruction saving r2. A similar
2970 situation exists when calls are marked with R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
2971 relocations. These require a ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub
2972 to call an external function like printf. If other calls to printf
2973 require a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub then a single
2974 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub will be used for both types of
2975 call. If other calls to printf require a ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
2976 linkage stub then a single ppc_stub_plt_call_both linkage stub will
2977 be created and calls not requiring r2 to be saved will enter the
2978 stub after the r2 save instruction. There is an analogous
2979 hierarchy of long branch and plt branch stubs for local call
2980 linkage. */
2981
2982 enum ppc_stub_type
2983 {
2984 ppc_stub_none,
2985 ppc_stub_long_branch,
2986 ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off,
2987 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc,
2988 ppc_stub_long_branch_both, /* r2off and notoc variants both needed. */
2989 ppc_stub_plt_branch,
2990 ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off,
2991 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc,
2992 ppc_stub_plt_branch_both,
2993 ppc_stub_plt_call,
2994 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save,
2995 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc,
2996 ppc_stub_plt_call_both,
2997 ppc_stub_global_entry,
2998 ppc_stub_save_res
2999 };
3000
3001 /* Information on stub grouping. */
3002 struct map_stub
3003 {
3004 /* The stub section. */
3005 asection *stub_sec;
3006 /* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be attached. */
3007 asection *link_sec;
3008 /* Next group. */
3009 struct map_stub *next;
3010 /* Whether to emit a copy of register save/restore functions in this
3011 group. */
3012 int needs_save_res;
3013 /* Current offset within stubs after the insn restoring lr in a
3014 _notoc or _both stub using bcl for pc-relative addressing, or
3015 after the insn restoring lr in a __tls_get_addr_opt plt stub. */
3016 unsigned int lr_restore;
3017 /* Accumulated size of EH info emitted to describe return address
3018 if stubs modify lr. Does not include 17 byte FDE header. */
3019 unsigned int eh_size;
3020 /* Offset in glink_eh_frame to the start of EH info for this group. */
3021 unsigned int eh_base;
3022 };
3023
3024 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry
3025 {
3026 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3027 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3028
3029 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
3030
3031 /* Group information. */
3032 struct map_stub *group;
3033
3034 /* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub. */
3035 bfd_vma stub_offset;
3036
3037 /* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
3038 value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump. */
3039 bfd_vma target_value;
3040 asection *target_section;
3041
3042 /* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from. */
3043 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
3044 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
3045
3046 /* Symbol type. */
3047 unsigned char symtype;
3048
3049 /* Symbol st_other. */
3050 unsigned char other;
3051 };
3052
3053 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry
3054 {
3055 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3056 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3057
3058 /* Offset within branch lookup table. */
3059 unsigned int offset;
3060
3061 /* Generation marker. */
3062 unsigned int iter;
3063 };
3064
3065 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
3066 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
3067 {
3068 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
3069
3070 /* The input section of the reloc. */
3071 asection *sec;
3072
3073 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
3074 unsigned int count : 31;
3075
3076 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
3077 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
3078 };
3079
3080 struct ppc_link_hash_entry
3081 {
3082 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
3083
3084 union
3085 {
3086 /* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
3087 symbol. */
3088 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
3089
3090 /* A pointer to the next symbol starting with a '.' */
3091 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *next_dot_sym;
3092 } u;
3093
3094 /* Link between function code and descriptor symbols. */
3095 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *oh;
3096
3097 /* Flag function code and descriptor symbols. */
3098 unsigned int is_func:1;
3099 unsigned int is_func_descriptor:1;
3100 unsigned int fake:1;
3101
3102 /* Whether global opd/toc sym has been adjusted or not.
3103 After ppc64_elf_edit_opd/ppc64_elf_edit_toc has run, this flag
3104 should be set for all globals defined in any opd/toc section. */
3105 unsigned int adjust_done:1;
3106
3107 /* Set if this is an out-of-line register save/restore function,
3108 with non-standard calling convention. */
3109 unsigned int save_res:1;
3110
3111 /* Set if a duplicate symbol with non-zero localentry is detected,
3112 even when the duplicate symbol does not provide a definition. */
3113 unsigned int non_zero_localentry:1;
3114
3115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT (or TOC).
3116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
3117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
3118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
3119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
3120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
3121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
3122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
3123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
3124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
3125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
3126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
3127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
3128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
3129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
3130 #define TLS_EXPLICIT 256 /* TOC section TLS reloc, not stored. */
3131 unsigned char tls_mask;
3132
3133 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
3134 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
3135 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
3136 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
3137 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
3138 };
3139
3140 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3141 ppc_elf_hash_entry (struct elf_link_hash_entry *ent)
3142 {
3143 return (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) ent;
3144 }
3145
3146 /* ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3147
3148 struct ppc_link_hash_table
3149 {
3150 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
3151
3152 /* The stub hash table. */
3153 struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
3154
3155 /* Another hash table for plt_branch stubs. */
3156 struct bfd_hash_table branch_hash_table;
3157
3158 /* Hash table for function prologue tocsave. */
3159 htab_t tocsave_htab;
3160
3161 /* Various options and other info passed from the linker. */
3162 struct ppc64_elf_params *params;
3163
3164 /* The size of sec_info below. */
3165 unsigned int sec_info_arr_size;
3166
3167 /* Per-section array of extra section info. Done this way rather
3168 than as part of ppc64_elf_section_data so we have the info for
3169 non-ppc64 sections. */
3170 struct
3171 {
3172 /* Along with elf_gp, specifies the TOC pointer used by this section. */
3173 bfd_vma toc_off;
3174
3175 union
3176 {
3177 /* The section group that this section belongs to. */
3178 struct map_stub *group;
3179 /* A temp section list pointer. */
3180 asection *list;
3181 } u;
3182 } *sec_info;
3183
3184 /* Linked list of groups. */
3185 struct map_stub *group;
3186
3187 /* Temp used when calculating TOC pointers. */
3188 bfd_vma toc_curr;
3189 bfd *toc_bfd;
3190 asection *toc_first_sec;
3191
3192 /* Used when adding symbols. */
3193 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *dot_syms;
3194
3195 /* Shortcuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
3196 asection *glink;
3197 asection *global_entry;
3198 asection *sfpr;
3199 asection *pltlocal;
3200 asection *relpltlocal;
3201 asection *brlt;
3202 asection *relbrlt;
3203 asection *glink_eh_frame;
3204
3205 /* Shortcut to .__tls_get_addr and __tls_get_addr. */
3206 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
3207 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr_fd;
3208 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc;
3209 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc_fd;
3210 struct map_stub *tga_group;
3211
3212 /* The size of reliplt used by got entry relocs. */
3213 bfd_size_type got_reli_size;
3214
3215 /* Statistics. */
3216 unsigned long stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry];
3217
3218 /* Number of stubs against global syms. */
3219 unsigned long stub_globals;
3220
3221 /* Set if we're linking code with function descriptors. */
3222 unsigned int opd_abi:1;
3223
3224 /* Support for multiple toc sections. */
3225 unsigned int do_multi_toc:1;
3226 unsigned int multi_toc_needed:1;
3227 unsigned int second_toc_pass:1;
3228 unsigned int do_toc_opt:1;
3229
3230 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
3231 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
3232
3233 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
3234 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
3235
3236 /* Set on error. */
3237 unsigned int stub_error:1;
3238
3239 /* Whether func_desc_adjust needs to be run over symbols. */
3240 unsigned int need_func_desc_adj:1;
3241
3242 /* Whether plt calls for ELFv2 localentry:0 funcs have been optimized. */
3243 unsigned int has_plt_localentry0:1;
3244
3245 /* Whether calls are made via the PLT from NOTOC functions. */
3246 unsigned int notoc_plt:1;
3247
3248 /* Whether any code linked seems to be Power10. */
3249 unsigned int has_power10_relocs:1;
3250
3251 /* Incremented every time we size stubs. */
3252 unsigned int stub_iteration;
3253
3254 /* Small local sym cache. */
3255 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
3256 };
3257
3258 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
3259 are used here. */
3260
3261 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
3262 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
3263
3264 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
3265 relocations. */
3266 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
3267
3268 /* Nonzero if this section has any toc or got relocs. */
3269 #define has_toc_reloc sec_flg2
3270
3271 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to another section that uses
3272 the toc or got. */
3273 #define makes_toc_func_call sec_flg3
3274
3275 /* Recursion protection when determining above flag. */
3276 #define call_check_in_progress sec_flg4
3277 #define call_check_done sec_flg5
3278
3279 /* Get the ppc64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
3280
3281 #define ppc_hash_table(p) \
3282 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
3283 == PPC64_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
3284
3285 #define ppc_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3286 ((struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) \
3287 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3288
3289 #define ppc_branch_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3290 ((struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) \
3291 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3292
3293 /* Create an entry in the stub hash table. */
3294
3295 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3296 stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3297 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3298 const char *string)
3299 {
3300 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3301 subclass. */
3302 if (entry == NULL)
3303 {
3304 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry));
3305 if (entry == NULL)
3306 return entry;
3307 }
3308
3309 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3310 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3311 if (entry != NULL)
3312 {
3313 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *eh;
3314
3315 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3316 eh = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
3317 eh->stub_type = ppc_stub_none;
3318 eh->group = NULL;
3319 eh->stub_offset = 0;
3320 eh->target_value = 0;
3321 eh->target_section = NULL;
3322 eh->h = NULL;
3323 eh->plt_ent = NULL;
3324 eh->other = 0;
3325 }
3326
3327 return entry;
3328 }
3329
3330 /* Create an entry in the branch hash table. */
3331
3332 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3333 branch_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3334 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3335 const char *string)
3336 {
3337 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3338 subclass. */
3339 if (entry == NULL)
3340 {
3341 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry));
3342 if (entry == NULL)
3343 return entry;
3344 }
3345
3346 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3347 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3348 if (entry != NULL)
3349 {
3350 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *eh;
3351
3352 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3353 eh = (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) entry;
3354 eh->offset = 0;
3355 eh->iter = 0;
3356 }
3357
3358 return entry;
3359 }
3360
3361 /* Create an entry in a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3362
3363 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3364 link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3365 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3366 const char *string)
3367 {
3368 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3369 subclass. */
3370 if (entry == NULL)
3371 {
3372 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry));
3373 if (entry == NULL)
3374 return entry;
3375 }
3376
3377 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3378 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3379 if (entry != NULL)
3380 {
3381 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) entry;
3382
3383 memset (&eh->u.stub_cache, 0,
3384 (sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry)
3385 - offsetof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry, u.stub_cache)));
3386
3387 /* When making function calls, old ABI code references function entry
3388 points (dot symbols), while new ABI code references the function
3389 descriptor symbol. We need to make any combination of reference and
3390 definition work together, without breaking archive linking.
3391
3392 For a defined function "foo" and an undefined call to "bar":
3393 An old object defines "foo" and ".foo", references ".bar" (possibly
3394 "bar" too).
3395 A new object defines "foo" and references "bar".
3396
3397 A new object thus has no problem with its undefined symbols being
3398 satisfied by definitions in an old object. On the other hand, the
3399 old object won't have ".bar" satisfied by a new object.
3400
3401 Keep a list of newly added dot-symbols. */
3402
3403 if (string[0] == '.')
3404 {
3405 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3406
3407 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) table;
3408 eh->u.next_dot_sym = htab->dot_syms;
3409 htab->dot_syms = eh;
3410 }
3411 }
3412
3413 return entry;
3414 }
3415
3416 struct tocsave_entry
3417 {
3418 asection *sec;
3419 bfd_vma offset;
3420 };
3421
3422 static hashval_t
3423 tocsave_htab_hash (const void *p)
3424 {
3425 const struct tocsave_entry *e = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p;
3426 return ((bfd_vma) (intptr_t) e->sec ^ e->offset) >> 3;
3427 }
3428
3429 static int
3430 tocsave_htab_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3431 {
3432 const struct tocsave_entry *e1 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p1;
3433 const struct tocsave_entry *e2 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p2;
3434 return e1->sec == e2->sec && e1->offset == e2->offset;
3435 }
3436
3437 /* Destroy a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3438
3439 static void
3440 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
3441 {
3442 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3443
3444 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
3445 if (htab->tocsave_htab)
3446 htab_delete (htab->tocsave_htab);
3447 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->branch_hash_table);
3448 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3449 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
3450 }
3451
3452 /* Create a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3453
3454 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
3455 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
3456 {
3457 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3458 size_t amt = sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_table);
3459
3460 htab = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
3461 if (htab == NULL)
3462 return NULL;
3463
3464 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&htab->elf, abfd, link_hash_newfunc,
3465 sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry),
3466 PPC64_ELF_DATA))
3467 {
3468 free (htab);
3469 return NULL;
3470 }
3471
3472 /* Init the stub hash table too. */
3473 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
3474 sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry)))
3475 {
3476 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3477 return NULL;
3478 }
3479
3480 /* And the branch hash table. */
3481 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->branch_hash_table, branch_hash_newfunc,
3482 sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry)))
3483 {
3484 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3485 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3486 return NULL;
3487 }
3488
3489 htab->tocsave_htab = htab_try_create (1024,
3490 tocsave_htab_hash,
3491 tocsave_htab_eq,
3492 NULL);
3493 if (htab->tocsave_htab == NULL)
3494 {
3495 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3496 return NULL;
3497 }
3498 htab->elf.root.hash_table_free = ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free;
3499
3500 /* Initializing two fields of the union is just cosmetic. We really
3501 only care about glist, but when compiled on a 32-bit host the
3502 bfd_vma fields are larger. Setting the bfd_vma to zero makes
3503 debugger inspection of these fields look nicer. */
3504 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.refcount = 0;
3505 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.glist = NULL;
3506 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
3507 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
3508 htab->elf.init_got_offset.offset = 0;
3509 htab->elf.init_got_offset.glist = NULL;
3510 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
3511 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
3512
3513 return &htab->elf.root;
3514 }
3515
3516 /* Create sections for linker generated code. */
3517
3518 static bfd_boolean
3519 create_linkage_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3520 {
3521 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3522 flagword flags;
3523
3524 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3525
3526 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY
3527 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3528 if (htab->params->save_restore_funcs)
3529 {
3530 /* Create .sfpr for code to save and restore fp regs. */
3531 htab->sfpr = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".sfpr",
3532 flags);
3533 if (htab->sfpr == NULL
3534 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->sfpr, 2))
3535 return FALSE;
3536 }
3537
3538 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
3539 return TRUE;
3540
3541 /* Create .glink for lazy dynamic linking support. */
3542 htab->glink = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3543 flags);
3544 if (htab->glink == NULL
3545 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 3))
3546 return FALSE;
3547
3548 /* The part of .glink used by global entry stubs, separate so that
3549 it can be aligned appropriately without affecting htab->glink. */
3550 htab->global_entry = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3551 flags);
3552 if (htab->global_entry == NULL
3553 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->global_entry, 2))
3554 return FALSE;
3555
3556 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
3557 {
3558 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3559 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3560 htab->glink_eh_frame = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
3561 ".eh_frame",
3562 flags);
3563 if (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
3564 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink_eh_frame, 2))
3565 return FALSE;
3566 }
3567
3568 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
3569 htab->elf.iplt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt", flags);
3570 if (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3571 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.iplt, 3))
3572 return FALSE;
3573
3574 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3575 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3576 htab->elf.irelplt
3577 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.iplt", flags);
3578 if (htab->elf.irelplt == NULL
3579 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.irelplt, 3))
3580 return FALSE;
3581
3582 /* Create branch lookup table for plt_branch stubs. */
3583 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
3584 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3585 htab->brlt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3586 flags);
3587 if (htab->brlt == NULL
3588 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->brlt, 3))
3589 return FALSE;
3590
3591 /* Local plt entries, put in .branch_lt but a separate section for
3592 convenience. */
3593 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3594 flags);
3595 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
3596 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 3))
3597 return FALSE;
3598
3599 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3600 return TRUE;
3601
3602 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3603 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3604 htab->relbrlt
3605 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3606 if (htab->relbrlt == NULL
3607 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relbrlt, 3))
3608 return FALSE;
3609
3610 htab->relpltlocal
3611 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3612 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
3613 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 3))
3614 return FALSE;
3615
3616 return TRUE;
3617 }
3618
3619 /* Satisfy the ELF linker by filling in some fields in our fake bfd. */
3620
3621 bfd_boolean
3622 ppc64_elf_init_stub_bfd (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3623 struct ppc64_elf_params *params)
3624 {
3625 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3626
3627 elf_elfheader (params->stub_bfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = ELFCLASS64;
3628
3629 /* Always hook our dynamic sections into the first bfd, which is the
3630 linker created stub bfd. This ensures that the GOT header is at
3631 the start of the output TOC section. */
3632 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3633 htab->elf.dynobj = params->stub_bfd;
3634 htab->params = params;
3635
3636 return create_linkage_sections (htab->elf.dynobj, info);
3637 }
3638
3639 /* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table. */
3640
3641 static char *
3642 ppc_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
3643 const asection *sym_sec,
3644 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3645 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
3646 {
3647 char *stub_name;
3648 ssize_t len;
3649
3650 /* rel->r_addend is actually 64 bit, but who uses more than +/- 2^31
3651 offsets from a sym as a branch target? In fact, we could
3652 probably assume the addend is always zero. */
3653 BFD_ASSERT (((int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff) == rel->r_addend);
3654
3655 if (h)
3656 {
3657 len = 8 + 1 + strlen (h->elf.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1;
3658 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3659 if (stub_name == NULL)
3660 return stub_name;
3661
3662 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%s+%x",
3663 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3664 h->elf.root.root.string,
3665 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3666 }
3667 else
3668 {
3669 len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1;
3670 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3671 if (stub_name == NULL)
3672 return stub_name;
3673
3674 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%x:%x+%x",
3675 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3676 sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
3677 (int) ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
3678 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3679 }
3680 if (len > 2 && stub_name[len - 2] == '+' && stub_name[len - 1] == '0')
3681 stub_name[len - 2] = 0;
3682 return stub_name;
3683 }
3684
3685 /* If mixing power10 with non-power10 code and --power10-stubs is not
3686 specified (or is auto) then calls using @notoc relocations that
3687 need a stub will utilize power10 instructions in the stub, and
3688 calls without @notoc relocations will not use power10 instructions.
3689 The two classes of stubs are stored in separate stub_hash_table
3690 entries having the same key string. The two entries will always be
3691 adjacent on entry->root.next chain, even if hash table resizing
3692 occurs. This function selects the correct entry to use. */
3693
3694 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3695 select_alt_stub (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *entry, bfd_boolean notoc)
3696 {
3697 bfd_boolean have_notoc;
3698
3699 have_notoc = (entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
3700 || entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
3701 || entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
3702
3703 if (have_notoc != notoc)
3704 {
3705 const char *stub_name = entry->root.string;
3706
3707 entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry->root.next;
3708 if (entry != NULL
3709 && entry->root.string != stub_name)
3710 entry = NULL;
3711 }
3712
3713 return entry;
3714 }
3715
3716 /* Look up an entry in the stub hash. Stub entries are cached because
3717 creating the stub name takes a bit of time. */
3718
3719 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3720 ppc_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
3721 const asection *sym_sec,
3722 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3723 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3724 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3725 {
3726 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3727 struct map_stub *group;
3728
3729 /* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
3730 stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
3731 Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
3732 more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
3733 distinguish between them. */
3734 group = htab->sec_info[input_section->id].u.group;
3735 if (group == NULL)
3736 return NULL;
3737
3738 if (h != NULL && h->u.stub_cache != NULL
3739 && h->u.stub_cache->h == h
3740 && h->u.stub_cache->group == group)
3741 {
3742 stub_entry = h->u.stub_cache;
3743 }
3744 else
3745 {
3746 char *stub_name;
3747
3748 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (group->link_sec, sym_sec, h, rel);
3749 if (stub_name == NULL)
3750 return NULL;
3751
3752 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
3753 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
3754 if (h != NULL)
3755 h->u.stub_cache = stub_entry;
3756
3757 free (stub_name);
3758 }
3759
3760 if (stub_entry != NULL && htab->params->power10_stubs == -1)
3761 {
3762 bfd_boolean notoc = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
3763
3764 stub_entry = select_alt_stub (stub_entry, notoc);
3765 }
3766
3767 return stub_entry;
3768 }
3769
3770 /* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash. Not all fields of the new
3771 stub entry are initialised. */
3772
3773 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3774 ppc_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
3775 asection *section,
3776 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3777 {
3778 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3779 struct map_stub *group;
3780 asection *link_sec;
3781 asection *stub_sec;
3782 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3783
3784 group = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group;
3785 link_sec = group->link_sec;
3786 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
3787 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3788 {
3789 size_t namelen;
3790 bfd_size_type len;
3791 char *s_name;
3792
3793 namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
3794 len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
3795 s_name = bfd_alloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, len);
3796 if (s_name == NULL)
3797 return NULL;
3798
3799 memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
3800 memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
3801 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
3802 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3803 return NULL;
3804 group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
3805 }
3806
3807 /* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table. */
3808 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
3809 TRUE, FALSE);
3810 if (stub_entry == NULL)
3811 {
3812 /* xgettext:c-format */
3813 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
3814 section->owner, stub_name);
3815 return NULL;
3816 }
3817
3818 stub_entry->group = group;
3819 stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
3820 return stub_entry;
3821 }
3822
3823 /* Create .got and .rela.got sections in ABFD, and .got in dynobj if
3824 not already done. */
3825
3826 static bfd_boolean
3827 create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3828 {
3829 asection *got, *relgot;
3830 flagword flags;
3831 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3832
3833 if (!is_ppc64_elf (abfd))
3834 return FALSE;
3835 if (htab == NULL)
3836 return FALSE;
3837
3838 if (!htab->elf.sgot
3839 && !_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3840 return FALSE;
3841
3842 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3843 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3844
3845 got = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3846 if (!got
3847 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (got, 3))
3848 return FALSE;
3849
3850 relgot = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.got",
3851 flags | SEC_READONLY);
3852 if (!relgot
3853 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (relgot, 3))
3854 return FALSE;
3855
3856 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got = got;
3857 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->relgot = relgot;
3858 return TRUE;
3859 }
3860
3861 /* Follow indirect and warning symbol links. */
3862
3863 static inline struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
3864 follow_link (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h)
3865 {
3866 while (h->type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3867 || h->type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3868 h = h->u.i.link;
3869 return h;
3870 }
3871
3872 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3873 elf_follow_link (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3874 {
3875 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->root);
3876 }
3877
3878 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3879 ppc_follow_link (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h)
3880 {
3881 return ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_follow_link (&h->elf));
3882 }
3883
3884 /* Merge PLT info on FROM with that on TO. */
3885
3886 static void
3887 move_plt_plist (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *from,
3888 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *to)
3889 {
3890 if (from->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3891 {
3892 if (to->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3893 {
3894 struct plt_entry **entp;
3895 struct plt_entry *ent;
3896
3897 for (entp = &from->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3898 {
3899 struct plt_entry *dent;
3900
3901 for (dent = to->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3902 if (dent->addend == ent->addend)
3903 {
3904 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
3905 *entp = ent->next;
3906 break;
3907 }
3908 if (dent == NULL)
3909 entp = &ent->next;
3910 }
3911 *entp = to->elf.plt.plist;
3912 }
3913
3914 to->elf.plt.plist = from->elf.plt.plist;
3915 from->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
3916 }
3917 }
3918
3919 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
3920
3921 static void
3922 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3923 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
3924 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
3925 {
3926 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
3927
3928 edir = ppc_elf_hash_entry (dir);
3929 eind = ppc_elf_hash_entry (ind);
3930
3931 edir->is_func |= eind->is_func;
3932 edir->is_func_descriptor |= eind->is_func_descriptor;
3933 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
3934 if (eind->oh != NULL)
3935 edir->oh = ppc_follow_link (eind->oh);
3936
3937 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
3938 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
3939 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
3940 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3941 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
3942 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
3943 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
3944
3945 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, don't copy
3946 dyn_relocs, plt/got info, or dynindx. We used to copy dyn_relocs
3947 in order to simplify readonly_dynrelocs and save a field in the
3948 symbol hash entry, but that means dyn_relocs can't be used in any
3949 tests about a specific symbol, or affect other symbol flags which
3950 are then tested. */
3951 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3952 return;
3953
3954 /* Copy over any dynamic relocs we may have on the indirect sym. */
3955 if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3956 {
3957 if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3958 {
3959 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3960 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3961
3962 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
3963 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
3964 for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3965 {
3966 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
3967
3968 for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
3969 if (q->sec == p->sec)
3970 {
3971 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
3972 q->count += p->count;
3973 *pp = p->next;
3974 break;
3975 }
3976 if (q == NULL)
3977 pp = &p->next;
3978 }
3979 *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
3980 }
3981
3982 dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
3983 ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3984 }
3985
3986 /* Copy over got entries that we may have already seen to the
3987 symbol which just became indirect. */
3988 if (eind->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3989 {
3990 if (edir->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3991 {
3992 struct got_entry **entp;
3993 struct got_entry *ent;
3994
3995 for (entp = &eind->elf.got.glist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3996 {
3997 struct got_entry *dent;
3998
3999 for (dent = edir->elf.got.glist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
4000 if (dent->addend == ent->addend
4001 && dent->owner == ent->owner
4002 && dent->tls_type == ent->tls_type)
4003 {
4004 dent->got.refcount += ent->got.refcount;
4005 *entp = ent->next;
4006 break;
4007 }
4008 if (dent == NULL)
4009 entp = &ent->next;
4010 }
4011 *entp = edir->elf.got.glist;
4012 }
4013
4014 edir->elf.got.glist = eind->elf.got.glist;
4015 eind->elf.got.glist = NULL;
4016 }
4017
4018 /* And plt entries. */
4019 move_plt_plist (eind, edir);
4020
4021 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
4022 {
4023 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
4024 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4025 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
4026 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
4027 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
4028 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
4029 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
4030 }
4031 }
4032
4033 /* Find the function descriptor hash entry from the given function code
4034 hash entry FH. Link the entries via their OH fields. */
4035
4036 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
4037 lookup_fdh (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
4038 {
4039 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = fh->oh;
4040
4041 if (fdh == NULL)
4042 {
4043 const char *fd_name = fh->elf.root.root.string + 1;
4044
4045 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, fd_name,
4046 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE));
4047 if (fdh == NULL)
4048 return fdh;
4049
4050 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4051 fdh->oh = fh;
4052 fh->is_func = 1;
4053 fh->oh = fdh;
4054 }
4055
4056 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
4057 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4058 fdh->oh = fh;
4059 return fdh;
4060 }
4061
4062 /* Make a fake function descriptor sym for the undefined code sym FH. */
4063
4064 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
4065 make_fdh (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4066 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
4067 {
4068 bfd *abfd = fh->elf.root.u.undef.abfd;
4069 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
4070 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4071 flagword flags = (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4072 ? BSF_WEAK
4073 : BSF_GLOBAL);
4074
4075 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd,
4076 fh->elf.root.root.string + 1,
4077 flags, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
4078 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh))
4079 return NULL;
4080
4081 fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4082 fdh->elf.non_elf = 0;
4083 fdh->fake = 1;
4084 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4085 fdh->oh = fh;
4086 fh->is_func = 1;
4087 fh->oh = fdh;
4088 return fdh;
4089 }
4090
4091 /* Fix function descriptor symbols defined in .opd sections to be
4092 function type. */
4093
4094 static bfd_boolean
4095 ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *ibfd,
4096 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4097 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4098 const char **name,
4099 flagword *flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4100 asection **sec,
4101 bfd_vma *value)
4102 {
4103 if (*sec != NULL
4104 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".opd") == 0)
4105 {
4106 asection *code_sec;
4107
4108 if (!(ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4109 || ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC))
4110 isym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
4111
4112 /* If the symbol is a function defined in .opd, and the function
4113 code is in a discarded group, let it appear to be undefined. */
4114 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4115 && (*sec)->reloc_count != 0
4116 && opd_entry_value (*sec, *value, &code_sec, NULL,
4117 FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1
4118 && discarded_section (code_sec))
4119 {
4120 *sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4121 isym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
4122 }
4123 }
4124 else if (*sec != NULL
4125 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".toc") == 0
4126 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_OBJECT)
4127 {
4128 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4129 if (htab != NULL)
4130 htab->params->object_in_toc = 1;
4131 }
4132
4133 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4134 {
4135 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4136 set_abiversion (ibfd, 2);
4137 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 1)
4138 {
4139 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol '%s' has invalid st_other"
4140 " for ABI version 1"), *name);
4141 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4142 return FALSE;
4143 }
4144 }
4145
4146 return TRUE;
4147 }
4148
4149 /* Merge non-visibility st_other attributes: local entry point. */
4150
4151 static void
4152 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4153 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4154 bfd_boolean definition,
4155 bfd_boolean dynamic)
4156 {
4157 if (definition && (!dynamic || !h->def_regular))
4158 h->other = ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1))
4159 | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other));
4160 }
4161
4162 /* Hook called on merging a symbol. We use this to clear "fake" since
4163 we now have a real symbol. */
4164
4165 static bfd_boolean
4166 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4167 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4168 asection **psec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4169 bfd_boolean newdef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4170 bfd_boolean olddef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4171 bfd *oldbfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4172 const asection *oldsec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4173 {
4174 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->fake = 0;
4175 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4176 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry = 1;
4177 return TRUE;
4178 }
4179
4180 /* This function makes an old ABI object reference to ".bar" cause the
4181 inclusion of a new ABI object archive that defines "bar".
4182 NAME is a symbol defined in an archive. Return a symbol in the hash
4183 table that might be satisfied by the archive symbols. */
4184
4185 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4186 ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (bfd *abfd,
4187 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4188 const char *name)
4189 {
4190 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4191 char *dot_name;
4192 size_t len;
4193
4194 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, name);
4195 if (h != NULL
4196 /* Don't return this sym if it is a fake function descriptor
4197 created by add_symbol_adjust. */
4198 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->fake)
4199 return h;
4200
4201 if (name[0] == '.')
4202 return h;
4203
4204 len = strlen (name);
4205 dot_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
4206 if (dot_name == NULL)
4207 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) -1;
4208 dot_name[0] = '.';
4209 memcpy (dot_name + 1, name, len + 1);
4210 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, dot_name);
4211 bfd_release (abfd, dot_name);
4212 if (h != NULL)
4213 return h;
4214
4215 if (strcmp (name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
4216 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, "__tls_get_addr_desc");
4217 return h;
4218 }
4219
4220 /* This function satisfies all old ABI object references to ".bar" if a
4221 new ABI object defines "bar". Well, at least, undefined dot symbols
4222 are made weak. This stops later archive searches from including an
4223 object if we already have a function descriptor definition. It also
4224 prevents the linker complaining about undefined symbols.
4225 We also check and correct mismatched symbol visibility here. The
4226 most restrictive visibility of the function descriptor and the
4227 function entry symbol is used. */
4228
4229 static bfd_boolean
4230 add_symbol_adjust (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4231 {
4232 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4233 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4234
4235 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4236 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.root.u.i.link;
4237
4238 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
4239 return TRUE;
4240
4241 if (eh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.')
4242 abort ();
4243
4244 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4245 if (htab == NULL)
4246 return FALSE;
4247
4248 fdh = lookup_fdh (eh, htab);
4249 if (fdh == NULL
4250 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4251 && (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
4252 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4253 && eh->elf.ref_regular)
4254 {
4255 /* Make an undefined function descriptor sym, in order to
4256 pull in an --as-needed shared lib. Archives are handled
4257 elsewhere. */
4258 fdh = make_fdh (info, eh);
4259 if (fdh == NULL)
4260 return FALSE;
4261 }
4262
4263 if (fdh != NULL)
4264 {
4265 unsigned entry_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) - 1;
4266 unsigned descr_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (fdh->elf.other) - 1;
4267
4268 /* Make both descriptor and entry symbol have the most
4269 constraining visibility of either symbol. */
4270 if (entry_vis < descr_vis)
4271 fdh->elf.other += entry_vis - descr_vis;
4272 else if (entry_vis > descr_vis)
4273 eh->elf.other += descr_vis - entry_vis;
4274
4275 /* Propagate reference flags from entry symbol to function
4276 descriptor symbol. */
4277 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular;
4278 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic;
4279 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= eh->elf.ref_regular;
4280 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
4281
4282 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
4283 && fdh->elf.dynindx == -1
4284 && fdh->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden
4285 && (bfd_link_dll (info)
4286 || fdh->elf.def_dynamic
4287 || fdh->elf.ref_dynamic)
4288 && (eh->elf.ref_regular
4289 || eh->elf.def_regular))
4290 {
4291 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
4292 return FALSE;
4293 }
4294 }
4295
4296 return TRUE;
4297 }
4298
4299 /* Set up opd section info and abiversion for IBFD, and process list
4300 of dot-symbols we made in link_hash_newfunc. */
4301
4302 static bfd_boolean
4303 ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4304 {
4305 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4306 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **p, *eh;
4307 asection *opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
4308
4309 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0)
4310 {
4311 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type == sec_normal);
4312 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type = sec_opd;
4313
4314 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4315 set_abiversion (ibfd, 1);
4316 else if (abiversion (ibfd) >= 2)
4317 {
4318 /* xgettext:c-format */
4319 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB .opd not allowed in ABI version %d"),
4320 ibfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4321 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4322 return FALSE;
4323 }
4324 }
4325
4326 if (is_ppc64_elf (info->output_bfd))
4327 {
4328 /* For input files without an explicit abiversion in e_flags
4329 we should have flagged any with symbol st_other bits set
4330 as ELFv1 and above flagged those with .opd as ELFv2.
4331 Set the output abiversion if not yet set, and for any input
4332 still ambiguous, take its abiversion from the output.
4333 Differences in ABI are reported later. */
4334 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 0)
4335 set_abiversion (info->output_bfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4336 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4337 set_abiversion (ibfd, abiversion (info->output_bfd));
4338 }
4339
4340 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4341 if (htab == NULL)
4342 return TRUE;
4343
4344 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0
4345 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
4346 && (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
4347 && opd->reloc_count != 0
4348 && !bfd_is_abs_section (opd->output_section)
4349 && info->gc_sections)
4350 {
4351 /* Garbage collection needs some extra help with .opd sections.
4352 We don't want to necessarily keep everything referenced by
4353 relocs in .opd, as that would keep all functions. Instead,
4354 if we reference an .opd symbol (a function descriptor), we
4355 want to keep the function code symbol's section. This is
4356 easy for global symbols, but for local syms we need to keep
4357 information about the associated function section. */
4358 bfd_size_type amt;
4359 asection **opd_sym_map;
4360 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4361 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, *rel_end, *rel;
4362
4363 amt = OPD_NDX (opd->size) * sizeof (*opd_sym_map);
4364 opd_sym_map = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, amt);
4365 if (opd_sym_map == NULL)
4366 return FALSE;
4367 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->u.opd.func_sec = opd_sym_map;
4368 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, opd, NULL, NULL,
4369 info->keep_memory);
4370 if (relocs == NULL)
4371 return FALSE;
4372 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4373 rel_end = relocs + opd->reloc_count - 1;
4374 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4375 {
4376 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4377 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4378
4379 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
4380 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC
4381 && r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4382 {
4383 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4384 asection *s;
4385
4386 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ibfd, r_symndx);
4387 if (isym == NULL)
4388 {
4389 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4390 free (relocs);
4391 return FALSE;
4392 }
4393
4394 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, isym->st_shndx);
4395 if (s != NULL && s != opd)
4396 opd_sym_map[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = s;
4397 }
4398 }
4399 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4400 free (relocs);
4401 }
4402
4403 p = &htab->dot_syms;
4404 while ((eh = *p) != NULL)
4405 {
4406 *p = NULL;
4407 if (&eh->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
4408 ;
4409 else if (htab->elf.hgot == NULL
4410 && strcmp (eh->elf.root.root.string, ".TOC.") == 0)
4411 htab->elf.hgot = &eh->elf;
4412 else if (abiversion (ibfd) <= 1)
4413 {
4414 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 1;
4415 if (!add_symbol_adjust (eh, info))
4416 return FALSE;
4417 }
4418 p = &eh->u.next_dot_sym;
4419 }
4420 return TRUE;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Undo hash table changes when an --as-needed input file is determined
4424 not to be needed. */
4425
4426 static bfd_boolean
4427 ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed (bfd *ibfd,
4428 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4429 enum notice_asneeded_action act)
4430 {
4431 if (act == notice_not_needed)
4432 {
4433 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4434
4435 if (htab == NULL)
4436 return FALSE;
4437
4438 htab->dot_syms = NULL;
4439 }
4440 return _bfd_elf_notice_as_needed (ibfd, info, act);
4441 }
4442
4443 /* If --just-symbols against a final linked binary, then assume we need
4444 toc adjusting stubs when calling functions defined there. */
4445
4446 static void
4447 ppc64_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4448 {
4449 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
4450 && (sec->owner->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0
4451 && is_ppc64_elf (sec->owner))
4452 {
4453 if (abiversion (sec->owner) >= 2
4454 || bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".opd") != NULL)
4455 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4456 }
4457 _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (sec, info);
4458 }
4459
4460 static struct plt_entry **
4461 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
4462 unsigned long r_symndx, bfd_vma r_addend, int tls_type)
4463 {
4464 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (abfd);
4465 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4466 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
4467
4468 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4469 {
4470 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4471
4472 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_ents)
4473 + sizeof (*local_plt)
4474 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
4475 local_got_ents = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
4476 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4477 return NULL;
4478 elf_local_got_ents (abfd) = local_got_ents;
4479 }
4480
4481 if ((tls_type & (NON_GOT | TLS_EXPLICIT)) == 0)
4482 {
4483 struct got_entry *ent;
4484
4485 for (ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4486 if (ent->addend == r_addend
4487 && ent->owner == abfd
4488 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4489 break;
4490 if (ent == NULL)
4491 {
4492 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4493 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4494 if (ent == NULL)
4495 return FALSE;
4496 ent->next = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
4497 ent->addend = r_addend;
4498 ent->owner = abfd;
4499 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4500 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4501 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4502 local_got_ents[r_symndx] = ent;
4503 }
4504 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4505 }
4506
4507 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4508 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4509 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
4510
4511 return local_plt + r_symndx;
4512 }
4513
4514 static bfd_boolean
4515 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, bfd_vma addend)
4516 {
4517 struct plt_entry *ent;
4518
4519 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4520 if (ent->addend == addend)
4521 break;
4522 if (ent == NULL)
4523 {
4524 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4525 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4526 if (ent == NULL)
4527 return FALSE;
4528 ent->next = *plist;
4529 ent->addend = addend;
4530 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
4531 *plist = ent;
4532 }
4533 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
4534 return TRUE;
4535 }
4536
4537 static bfd_boolean
4538 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4539 {
4540 return (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
4541 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
4542 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
4543 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
4544 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
4545 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR24
4546 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14
4547 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
4548 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
4549 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
4550 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC);
4551 }
4552
4553 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
4554
4555 static bfd_boolean
4556 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4557 {
4558 return (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
4559 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
4560 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
4561 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS
4562 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
4563 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC
4564 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ
4565 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC);
4566 }
4567
4568 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
4569 calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
4570 linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections. */
4571
4572 static bfd_boolean
4573 ppc64_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4574 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
4575 {
4576 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4577 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4578 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4579 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4580 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
4581 asection *sreloc;
4582 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *dottga;
4583 bfd_boolean is_opd;
4584
4585 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4586 return TRUE;
4587
4588 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (abfd));
4589
4590 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4591 if (htab == NULL)
4592 return FALSE;
4593
4594 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4595 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4596 dottga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
4597 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4598 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4599 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
4600 sreloc = NULL;
4601 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd;
4602 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
4603 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4604 {
4605 unsigned long r_symndx;
4606 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4607 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
4608 int tls_type;
4609 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *ppc64_sec;
4610 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
4611
4612 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4613 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4614 h = NULL;
4615 else
4616 {
4617 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4618 h = elf_follow_link (h);
4619
4620 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
4621 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4622 }
4623
4624 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4625 switch (r_type)
4626 {
4627 case R_PPC64_D34:
4628 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
4629 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
4630 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
4631 case R_PPC64_D28:
4632 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
4633 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
4634 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
4635 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4636 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
4637 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
4638 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
4639 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
4640 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4641 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4642 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
4643 htab->has_power10_relocs = 1;
4644 break;
4645 default:
4646 break;
4647 }
4648
4649 switch (r_type)
4650 {
4651 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4652 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4653 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4654 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4655 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4656 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4657 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4658 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4659 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4660 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4661 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4662 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4663 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4664 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4665 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4666 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4667 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4668 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4669 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_optrel = 1;
4670 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel = 1;
4671 break;
4672 default:
4673 break;
4674 }
4675
4676 ifunc = NULL;
4677 if (h != NULL)
4678 {
4679 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4680 {
4681 h->needs_plt = 1;
4682 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
4683 }
4684 }
4685 else
4686 {
4687 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4688 abfd, r_symndx);
4689 if (isym == NULL)
4690 return FALSE;
4691
4692 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4693 {
4694 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4695 rel->r_addend,
4696 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
4697 if (ifunc == NULL)
4698 return FALSE;
4699 }
4700 }
4701
4702 tls_type = 0;
4703 switch (r_type)
4704 {
4705 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
4706 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
4707 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
4708 its parameter symbol. */
4709 if (h != NULL)
4710 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
4711 else
4712 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4713 rel->r_addend,
4714 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4715 return FALSE;
4716 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4717 break;
4718
4719 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
4720 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4721 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4722 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4723 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
4724 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4725 goto dogottls;
4726
4727 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
4728 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4729 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4730 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4731 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
4732 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4733 goto dogottls;
4734
4735 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
4736 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4737 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4738 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4739 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
4740 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4741 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4742 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4743 goto dogottls;
4744
4745 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
4746 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4747 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
4748 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4749 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
4750 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4751 dogottls:
4752 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4753 goto dogot;
4754
4755 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
4756 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4757 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
4758 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4759 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
4760 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4761 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4762 dogot:
4763 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
4764 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4765 if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16
4766 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16
4767 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS
4768 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS
4769 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16
4770 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_DS)
4771 {
4772 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4773 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4774 }
4775
4776 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got == NULL
4777 && !create_got_section (abfd, info))
4778 return FALSE;
4779
4780 if (h != NULL)
4781 {
4782 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4783 struct got_entry *ent;
4784
4785 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4786 for (ent = eh->elf.got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4787 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
4788 && ent->owner == abfd
4789 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4790 break;
4791 if (ent == NULL)
4792 {
4793 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
4794 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4795 if (ent == NULL)
4796 return FALSE;
4797 ent->next = eh->elf.got.glist;
4798 ent->addend = rel->r_addend;
4799 ent->owner = abfd;
4800 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4801 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4802 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4803 eh->elf.got.glist = ent;
4804 }
4805 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4806 eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4807 }
4808 else
4809 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
4810 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4811 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4812 return FALSE;
4813 break;
4814
4815 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4816 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
4817 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4818 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4819 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4820 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4821 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
4822 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
4823 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
4824 plt_list = ifunc;
4825 if (h != NULL)
4826 {
4827 h->needs_plt = 1;
4828 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4829 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4830 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
4831 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
4832 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4833 }
4834 if (plt_list == NULL)
4835 plt_list = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4836 rel->r_addend,
4837 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
4838 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4839 return FALSE;
4840 break;
4841
4842 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
4843 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
4844 section relative. */
4845 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
4846 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
4847 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
4848 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
4849 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
4850 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
4851 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
4852 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
4853 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
4854 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
4855 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
4856 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4857 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
4858 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
4859 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
4860 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
4861 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
4862 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4863 break;
4864
4865 /* Nor do these. */
4866 case R_PPC64_REL16:
4867 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
4868 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
4869 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
4870 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
4871 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
4872 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
4873 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
4874 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
4875 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
4876 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
4877 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
4878 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
4879 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
4880 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
4881 break;
4882
4883 /* Not supported as a dynamic relocation. */
4884 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
4885 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4886 {
4887 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
4888 ppc_howto_init ();
4889 /* xgettext:c-format */
4890 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%H: %s reloc unsupported "
4891 "in shared libraries and PIEs\n"),
4892 abfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
4893 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
4894 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4895 return FALSE;
4896 }
4897 break;
4898
4899 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
4900 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
4901 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4902 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4903 /* Fall through. */
4904 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4905 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
4906 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4907 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4908 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4909 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
4910 {
4911 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
4912 h->non_got_ref = 1;
4913 /* Strongly prefer a copy reloc over a dynamic reloc.
4914 glibc ld.so as of 2019-08 will error out if one of
4915 these relocations is emitted. */
4916 h->needs_copy = 1;
4917 goto dodyn;
4918 }
4919 break;
4920
4921 /* Marker reloc. */
4922 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
4923 break;
4924
4925 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
4926 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
4927 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4928 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
4929 return FALSE;
4930 break;
4931
4932 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
4933 used. Record for later use during GC. */
4934 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
4935 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
4936 return FALSE;
4937 break;
4938
4939 case R_PPC64_REL14:
4940 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
4941 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
4942 {
4943 asection *dest = NULL;
4944
4945 /* Heuristic: If jumping outside our section, chances are
4946 we are going to need a stub. */
4947 if (h != NULL)
4948 {
4949 /* If the sym is weak it may be overridden later, so
4950 don't assume we know where a weak sym lives. */
4951 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
4952 dest = h->root.u.def.section;
4953 }
4954 else
4955 {
4956 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4957
4958 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4959 abfd, r_symndx);
4960 if (isym == NULL)
4961 return FALSE;
4962
4963 dest = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4964 }
4965
4966 if (dest != sec)
4967 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_14bit_branch = 1;
4968 }
4969 goto rel24;
4970
4971 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
4972 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
4973 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall = 1;
4974 /* Fall through. */
4975
4976 case R_PPC64_REL24:
4977 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
4978 rel24:
4979 plt_list = ifunc;
4980 if (h != NULL)
4981 {
4982 h->needs_plt = 1;
4983 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4984 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4985 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
4986
4987 if (h == tga || h == dottga)
4988 {
4989 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4990 if (rel != relocs
4991 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSGD
4992 || ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
4993 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with
4994 a marker reloc. */
4995 ;
4996 else
4997 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
4998 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
4999 }
5000 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
5001 }
5002
5003 /* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
5004 refers to is in a shared lib. */
5005 if (plt_list
5006 && !update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
5007 return FALSE;
5008 break;
5009
5010 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
5011 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
5012 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
5013 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
5014 goto dodyn;
5015
5016 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
5017 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
5018 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5019 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5020 goto dotlstoc;
5021
5022 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
5023 if (rel + 1 < rel_end
5024 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
5025 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
5026 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
5027 else
5028 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
5029 goto dotlstoc;
5030
5031 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
5032 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
5033 if (rel != relocs
5034 && rel[-1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64)
5035 && rel[-1].r_offset == rel->r_offset - 8)
5036 /* This is the second reloc of a dtpmod, dtprel pair.
5037 Don't mark with TLS_DTPREL. */
5038 goto dodyn;
5039
5040 dotlstoc:
5041 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
5042 if (h != NULL)
5043 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type & 0xff;
5044 else
5045 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
5046 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
5047 return FALSE;
5048
5049 ppc64_sec = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec);
5050 if (ppc64_sec->sec_type != sec_toc)
5051 {
5052 bfd_size_type amt;
5053
5054 /* One extra to simplify get_tls_mask. */
5055 amt = sec->size * sizeof (unsigned) / 8 + sizeof (unsigned);
5056 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5057 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx == NULL)
5058 return FALSE;
5059 amt = sec->size * sizeof (bfd_vma) / 8;
5060 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5061 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.add == NULL)
5062 return FALSE;
5063 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_sec->sec_type == sec_normal);
5064 ppc64_sec->sec_type = sec_toc;
5065 }
5066 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset % 8 == 0);
5067 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8] = r_symndx;
5068 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add[rel->r_offset / 8] = rel->r_addend;
5069
5070 /* Mark the second slot of a GD or LD entry.
5071 -1 to indicate GD and -2 to indicate LD. */
5072 if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
5073 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -1;
5074 else if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5075 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -2;
5076 goto dodyn;
5077
5078 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
5079 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
5080 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
5081 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
5082 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
5083 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
5084 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
5085 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
5086 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
5087 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
5088 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
5089 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
5090 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
5091 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5092 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5093 goto dodyn;
5094
5095 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
5096 if (is_opd
5097 && rel + 1 < rel_end
5098 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5099 {
5100 if (h != NULL)
5101 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
5102 }
5103 /* Fall through. */
5104
5105 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
5106 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
5107 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
5108 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
5109 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
5110 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
5111 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
5112 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
5113 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
5114 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
5115 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
5116 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
5117 case R_PPC64_D34:
5118 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
5119 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
5120 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
5121 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
5122 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
5123 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
5124 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
5125 case R_PPC64_D28:
5126 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1
5127 && rel->r_addend == 0)
5128 {
5129 /* We may need a .plt entry if this reloc refers to a
5130 function in a shared lib. */
5131 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, 0))
5132 return FALSE;
5133 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
5134 }
5135 /* Fall through. */
5136
5137 case R_PPC64_REL30:
5138 case R_PPC64_REL32:
5139 case R_PPC64_REL64:
5140 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
5141 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
5142 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
5143 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
5144 case R_PPC64_TOC:
5145 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
5146 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
5147 h->non_got_ref = 1;
5148
5149 /* Don't propagate .opd relocs. */
5150 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
5151 break;
5152
5153 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
5154 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
5155 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
5156 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
5157 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
5158 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
5159 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
5160 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
5161 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
5162 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
5163 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
5164 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
5165 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
5166 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
5167 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
5168 symbol local.
5169
5170 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
5171 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
5172 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
5173 symbol. */
5174 dodyn:
5175 if ((h != NULL
5176 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
5177 || !h->def_regular))
5178 || (h != NULL
5179 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
5180 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
5181 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
5182 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5183 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5184 && ifunc != NULL))
5185 {
5186 /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
5187 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
5188 this reloc. */
5189 if (sreloc == NULL)
5190 {
5191 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
5192 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 3, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
5193
5194 if (sreloc == NULL)
5195 return FALSE;
5196 }
5197
5198 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
5199 relocations we need for this symbol. */
5200 if (h != NULL)
5201 {
5202 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5203 struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
5204
5205 head = &h->dyn_relocs;
5206 p = *head;
5207 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
5208 {
5209 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5210 if (p == NULL)
5211 return FALSE;
5212 p->next = *head;
5213 *head = p;
5214 p->sec = sec;
5215 p->count = 0;
5216 p->pc_count = 0;
5217 }
5218 p->count += 1;
5219 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5220 p->pc_count += 1;
5221 }
5222 else
5223 {
5224 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
5225 We really need local syms available to do this
5226 easily. Oh well. */
5227 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5228 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **head;
5229 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
5230 asection *s;
5231 void *vpp;
5232 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5233
5234 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
5235 abfd, r_symndx);
5236 if (isym == NULL)
5237 return FALSE;
5238
5239 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
5240 if (s == NULL)
5241 s = sec;
5242
5243 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
5244 head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
5245 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
5246 p = *head;
5247 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5248 p = p->next;
5249 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5250 {
5251 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5252 if (p == NULL)
5253 return FALSE;
5254 p->next = *head;
5255 *head = p;
5256 p->sec = sec;
5257 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
5258 p->count = 0;
5259 }
5260 p->count += 1;
5261 }
5262 }
5263 break;
5264
5265 default:
5266 break;
5267 }
5268 }
5269
5270 return TRUE;
5271 }
5272
5273 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
5274 object file when linking. */
5275
5276 static bfd_boolean
5277 ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5278 {
5279 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
5280 unsigned long iflags, oflags;
5281
5282 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
5283 return TRUE;
5284
5285 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc64_elf (obfd))
5286 return TRUE;
5287
5288 if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
5289 return FALSE;
5290
5291 iflags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
5292 oflags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
5293
5294 if (iflags & ~EF_PPC64_ABI)
5295 {
5296 _bfd_error_handler
5297 /* xgettext:c-format */
5298 (_("%pB uses unknown e_flags 0x%lx"), ibfd, iflags);
5299 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5300 return FALSE;
5301 }
5302 else if (iflags != oflags && iflags != 0)
5303 {
5304 _bfd_error_handler
5305 /* xgettext:c-format */
5306 (_("%pB: ABI version %ld is not compatible with ABI version %ld output"),
5307 ibfd, iflags, oflags);
5308 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5309 return FALSE;
5310 }
5311
5312 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
5313 return FALSE;
5314
5315 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
5316 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
5317 }
5318
5319 static bfd_boolean
5320 ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
5321 {
5322 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
5323 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
5324
5325 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != 0)
5326 {
5327 FILE *file = ptr;
5328
5329 fprintf (file, _("private flags = 0x%lx:"),
5330 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
5331
5332 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI) != 0)
5333 fprintf (file, _(" [abiv%ld]"),
5334 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI);
5335 fputc ('\n', file);
5336 }
5337
5338 return TRUE;
5339 }
5340
5341 /* OFFSET in OPD_SEC specifies a function descriptor. Return the address
5342 of the code entry point, and its section, which must be in the same
5343 object as OPD_SEC. Returns (bfd_vma) -1 on error. */
5344
5345 static bfd_vma
5346 opd_entry_value (asection *opd_sec,
5347 bfd_vma offset,
5348 asection **code_sec,
5349 bfd_vma *code_off,
5350 bfd_boolean in_code_sec)
5351 {
5352 bfd *opd_bfd = opd_sec->owner;
5353 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
5354 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi, *look;
5355 bfd_vma val;
5356
5357 /* No relocs implies we are linking a --just-symbols object, or looking
5358 at a final linked executable with addr2line or somesuch. */
5359 if (opd_sec->reloc_count == 0)
5360 {
5361 bfd_byte *contents = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents;
5362
5363 if (contents == NULL)
5364 {
5365 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (opd_bfd, opd_sec, &contents))
5366 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5367 ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents = contents;
5368 }
5369
5370 /* PR 17512: file: 64b9dfbb. */
5371 if (offset + 7 >= opd_sec->size || offset + 7 < offset)
5372 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5373
5374 val = bfd_get_64 (opd_bfd, contents + offset);
5375 if (code_sec != NULL)
5376 {
5377 asection *sec, *likely = NULL;
5378
5379 if (in_code_sec)
5380 {
5381 sec = *code_sec;
5382 if (sec->vma <= val
5383 && val < sec->vma + sec->size)
5384 likely = sec;
5385 else
5386 val = -1;
5387 }
5388 else
5389 for (sec = opd_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
5390 if (sec->vma <= val
5391 && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5392 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5393 likely = sec;
5394 if (likely != NULL)
5395 {
5396 *code_sec = likely;
5397 if (code_off != NULL)
5398 *code_off = val - likely->vma;
5399 }
5400 }
5401 return val;
5402 }
5403
5404 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (opd_bfd));
5405
5406 relocs = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.relocs;
5407 if (relocs == NULL)
5408 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (opd_bfd, opd_sec, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
5409 /* PR 17512: file: df8e1fd6. */
5410 if (relocs == NULL)
5411 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5412
5413 /* Go find the opd reloc at the sym address. */
5414 lo = relocs;
5415 hi = lo + opd_sec->reloc_count - 1; /* ignore last reloc */
5416 val = (bfd_vma) -1;
5417 while (lo < hi)
5418 {
5419 look = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
5420 if (look->r_offset < offset)
5421 lo = look + 1;
5422 else if (look->r_offset > offset)
5423 hi = look;
5424 else
5425 {
5426 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (opd_bfd);
5427
5428 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (look->r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
5429 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((look + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5430 {
5431 unsigned long symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (look->r_info);
5432 asection *sec = NULL;
5433
5434 if (symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info
5435 && elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd) != NULL)
5436 {
5437 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5438 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rh;
5439
5440 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd);
5441 rh = sym_hashes[symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
5442 if (rh != NULL)
5443 {
5444 rh = elf_follow_link (rh);
5445 if (rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5446 && rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5447 break;
5448 if (rh->root.u.def.section->owner == opd_bfd)
5449 {
5450 val = rh->root.u.def.value;
5451 sec = rh->root.u.def.section;
5452 }
5453 }
5454 }
5455
5456 if (sec == NULL)
5457 {
5458 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5459
5460 if (symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
5461 {
5462 sym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5463 if (sym == NULL)
5464 {
5465 size_t symcnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5466 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5467 symcnt, 0,
5468 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5469 if (sym == NULL)
5470 break;
5471 symtab_hdr->contents = (bfd_byte *) sym;
5472 }
5473 sym += symndx;
5474 }
5475 else
5476 {
5477 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5478 1, symndx,
5479 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5480 if (sym == NULL)
5481 break;
5482 }
5483 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (opd_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
5484 if (sec == NULL)
5485 break;
5486 BFD_ASSERT ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) == 0);
5487 val = sym->st_value;
5488 }
5489
5490 val += look->r_addend;
5491 if (code_off != NULL)
5492 *code_off = val;
5493 if (code_sec != NULL)
5494 {
5495 if (in_code_sec && *code_sec != sec)
5496 return -1;
5497 else
5498 *code_sec = sec;
5499 }
5500 if (sec->output_section != NULL)
5501 val += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5502 }
5503 break;
5504 }
5505 }
5506
5507 return val;
5508 }
5509
5510 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
5511 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
5512 otherwise return zero. */
5513
5514 static bfd_size_type
5515 ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
5516 bfd_vma *code_off)
5517 {
5518 bfd_size_type size;
5519
5520 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
5521 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0)
5522 return 0;
5523
5524 size = 0;
5525 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
5526 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5527
5528 if (strcmp (sym->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
5529 {
5530 struct _opd_sec_data *opd = get_opd_info (sym->section);
5531 bfd_vma symval = sym->value;
5532
5533 if (opd != NULL
5534 && opd->adjust != NULL
5535 && elf_section_data (sym->section)->relocs != NULL)
5536 {
5537 /* opd_entry_value will use cached relocs that have been
5538 adjusted, but with raw symbols. That means both local
5539 and global symbols need adjusting. */
5540 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (symval)];
5541 if (adjust == -1)
5542 return 0;
5543 symval += adjust;
5544 }
5545
5546 if (opd_entry_value (sym->section, symval,
5547 &sec, code_off, TRUE) == (bfd_vma) -1)
5548 return 0;
5549 /* An old ABI binary with dot-syms has a size of 24 on the .opd
5550 symbol. This size has nothing to do with the code size of the
5551 function, which is what we're supposed to return, but the
5552 code size isn't available without looking up the dot-sym.
5553 However, doing that would be a waste of time particularly
5554 since elf_find_function will look at the dot-sym anyway.
5555 Now, elf_find_function will keep the largest size of any
5556 function sym found at the code address of interest, so return
5557 1 here to avoid it incorrectly caching a larger function size
5558 for a small function. This does mean we return the wrong
5559 size for a new-ABI function of size 24, but all that does is
5560 disable caching for such functions. */
5561 if (size == 24)
5562 size = 1;
5563 }
5564 else
5565 {
5566 if (sym->section != sec)
5567 return 0;
5568 *code_off = sym->value;
5569 }
5570 if (size == 0)
5571 size = 1;
5572 return size;
5573 }
5574
5575 /* Return true if symbol is a strong function defined in an ELFv2
5576 object with st_other localentry bits of zero, ie. its local entry
5577 point coincides with its global entry point. */
5578
5579 static bfd_boolean
5580 is_elfv2_localentry0 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5581 {
5582 return (h != NULL
5583 && h->type == STT_FUNC
5584 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5585 && (STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & h->other) == 0
5586 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry
5587 && is_ppc64_elf (h->root.u.def.section->owner)
5588 && abiversion (h->root.u.def.section->owner) >= 2);
5589 }
5590
5591 /* Return true if symbol is defined in a regular object file. */
5592
5593 static bfd_boolean
5594 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5595 {
5596 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5597 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5598 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
5599 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
5600 }
5601
5602 /* If FDH is a function descriptor symbol, return the associated code
5603 entry symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5604
5605 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5606 defined_code_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh)
5607 {
5608 if (fdh->is_func_descriptor)
5609 {
5610 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (fdh->oh);
5611 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5612 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5613 return fh;
5614 }
5615 return NULL;
5616 }
5617
5618 /* If FH is a function code entry symbol, return the associated
5619 function descriptor symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5620
5621 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5622 defined_func_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
5623 {
5624 if (fh->oh != NULL
5625 && fh->oh->is_func_descriptor)
5626 {
5627 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = ppc_follow_link (fh->oh);
5628 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5629 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5630 return fdh;
5631 }
5632 return NULL;
5633 }
5634
5635 /* Given H is a symbol that satisfies is_static_defined, return the
5636 value in the output file. */
5637
5638 static bfd_vma
5639 defined_sym_val (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5640 {
5641 return (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5642 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
5643 + h->root.u.def.value);
5644 }
5645
5646 /* Return true if H matches __tls_get_addr or one of its variants. */
5647
5648 static bfd_boolean
5649 is_tls_get_addr (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5650 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
5651 {
5652 return (h == &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf || h == &htab->tga_desc_fd->elf
5653 || h == &htab->tls_get_addr->elf || h == &htab->tga_desc->elf);
5654 }
5655
5656 static bfd_boolean func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
5657
5658 /* Garbage collect sections, after first dealing with dot-symbols. */
5659
5660 static bfd_boolean
5661 ppc64_elf_gc_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5662 {
5663 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5664
5665 if (htab != NULL && htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5666 {
5667 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5668 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5669 }
5670 return bfd_elf_gc_sections (abfd, info);
5671 }
5672
5673 /* Mark all our entry sym sections, both opd and code section. */
5674
5675 static void
5676 ppc64_elf_gc_keep (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5677 {
5678 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5679 struct bfd_sym_chain *sym;
5680
5681 if (htab == NULL)
5682 return;
5683
5684 for (sym = info->gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next)
5685 {
5686 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh;
5687 asection *sec;
5688
5689 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym->name,
5690 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
5691 if (eh == NULL)
5692 continue;
5693 if (eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5694 && eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5695 continue;
5696
5697 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5698 if (fh != NULL)
5699 {
5700 sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5701 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5702 }
5703 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5704 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5705 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5706 &sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5707 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5708
5709 sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5710 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5711 }
5712 }
5713
5714 /* Mark sections containing dynamically referenced symbols. When
5715 building shared libraries, we must assume that any visible symbol is
5716 referenced. */
5717
5718 static bfd_boolean
5719 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5720 {
5721 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
5722 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5723 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5724 struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d = info->dynamic_list;
5725
5726 /* Dynamic linking info is on the func descriptor sym. */
5727 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5728 if (fdh != NULL)
5729 eh = fdh;
5730
5731 if ((eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5732 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5733 && ((eh->elf.ref_dynamic && !eh->elf.forced_local)
5734 || ((eh->elf.def_regular || ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (&eh->elf))
5735 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_INTERNAL
5736 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_HIDDEN
5737 && (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5738 || info->gc_keep_exported
5739 || info->export_dynamic
5740 || (eh->elf.dynamic
5741 && d != NULL
5742 && (*d->match) (&d->head, NULL,
5743 eh->elf.root.root.string)))
5744 && (eh->elf.versioned >= versioned
5745 || !bfd_hide_sym_by_version (info->version_info,
5746 eh->elf.root.root.string)))))
5747 {
5748 asection *code_sec;
5749 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5750
5751 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5752
5753 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5754 function code sym section to be marked. */
5755 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5756 if (fh != NULL)
5757 {
5758 code_sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5759 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5760 }
5761 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5762 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5763 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5764 &code_sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5765 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5766 }
5767
5768 return TRUE;
5769 }
5770
5771 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
5772 relocation. */
5773
5774 static asection *
5775 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
5776 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5777 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5778 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5779 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5780 {
5781 asection *rsec;
5782
5783 /* Syms return NULL if we're marking .opd, so we avoid marking all
5784 function sections, as all functions are referenced in .opd. */
5785 rsec = NULL;
5786 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
5787 return rsec;
5788
5789 if (h != NULL)
5790 {
5791 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
5792 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh, *fdh;
5793
5794 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
5795 switch (r_type)
5796 {
5797 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5798 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
5799 break;
5800
5801 default:
5802 switch (h->root.type)
5803 {
5804 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
5805 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
5806 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5807 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5808 if (fdh != NULL)
5809 {
5810 /* -mcall-aixdesc code references the dot-symbol on
5811 a call reloc. Mark the function descriptor too
5812 against garbage collection. */
5813 fdh->elf.mark = 1;
5814 if (fdh->elf.is_weakalias)
5815 weakdef (&fdh->elf)->mark = 1;
5816 eh = fdh;
5817 }
5818
5819 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5820 function code sym section to be marked. */
5821 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5822 if (fh != NULL)
5823 {
5824 /* They also mark their opd section. */
5825 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5826
5827 rsec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5828 }
5829 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5830 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5831 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5832 &rsec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5833 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5834 else
5835 rsec = h->root.u.def.section;
5836 break;
5837
5838 case bfd_link_hash_common:
5839 rsec = h->root.u.c.p->section;
5840 break;
5841
5842 default:
5843 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
5844 }
5845 }
5846 }
5847 else
5848 {
5849 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
5850
5851 rsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
5852 opd = get_opd_info (rsec);
5853 if (opd != NULL && opd->func_sec != NULL)
5854 {
5855 rsec->gc_mark = 1;
5856
5857 rsec = opd->func_sec[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value + rel->r_addend)];
5858 }
5859 }
5860
5861 return rsec;
5862 }
5863
5864 /* The maximum size of .sfpr. */
5865 #define SFPR_MAX (218*4)
5866
5867 struct sfpr_def_parms
5868 {
5869 const char name[12];
5870 unsigned char lo, hi;
5871 bfd_byte *(*write_ent) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5872 bfd_byte *(*write_tail) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5873 };
5874
5875 /* Auto-generate _save*, _rest* functions in .sfpr.
5876 If STUB_SEC is non-null, define alias symbols in STUB_SEC
5877 instead. */
5878
5879 static bfd_boolean
5880 sfpr_define (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5881 const struct sfpr_def_parms *parm,
5882 asection *stub_sec)
5883 {
5884 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5885 unsigned int i;
5886 size_t len = strlen (parm->name);
5887 bfd_boolean writing = FALSE;
5888 char sym[16];
5889
5890 if (htab == NULL)
5891 return FALSE;
5892
5893 memcpy (sym, parm->name, len);
5894 sym[len + 2] = 0;
5895
5896 for (i = parm->lo; i <= parm->hi; i++)
5897 {
5898 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
5899
5900 sym[len + 0] = i / 10 + '0';
5901 sym[len + 1] = i % 10 + '0';
5902 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym,
5903 writing, TRUE, TRUE));
5904 if (stub_sec != NULL)
5905 {
5906 if (h != NULL
5907 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5908 && h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
5909 {
5910 struct elf_link_hash_entry *s;
5911 char buf[32];
5912 sprintf (buf, "%08x.%s", stub_sec->id & 0xffffffff, sym);
5913 s = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, buf, TRUE, TRUE, FALSE);
5914 if (s == NULL)
5915 return FALSE;
5916 if (s->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5917 {
5918 s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5919 s->root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
5920 s->root.u.def.value = (stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
5921 + h->elf.root.u.def.value);
5922 s->ref_regular = 1;
5923 s->def_regular = 1;
5924 s->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5925 s->forced_local = 1;
5926 s->non_elf = 0;
5927 s->root.linker_def = 1;
5928 }
5929 }
5930 continue;
5931 }
5932 if (h != NULL)
5933 {
5934 h->save_res = 1;
5935 if (!h->elf.def_regular)
5936 {
5937 h->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5938 h->elf.root.u.def.section = htab->sfpr;
5939 h->elf.root.u.def.value = htab->sfpr->size;
5940 h->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
5941 h->elf.def_regular = 1;
5942 h->elf.non_elf = 0;
5943 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->elf, TRUE);
5944 writing = TRUE;
5945 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5946 {
5947 htab->sfpr->contents
5948 = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, SFPR_MAX);
5949 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5950 return FALSE;
5951 }
5952 }
5953 }
5954 if (writing)
5955 {
5956 bfd_byte *p = htab->sfpr->contents + htab->sfpr->size;
5957 if (i != parm->hi)
5958 p = (*parm->write_ent) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5959 else
5960 p = (*parm->write_tail) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5961 htab->sfpr->size = p - htab->sfpr->contents;
5962 }
5963 }
5964
5965 return TRUE;
5966 }
5967
5968 static bfd_byte *
5969 savegpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5970 {
5971 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5972 return p + 4;
5973 }
5974
5975 static bfd_byte *
5976 savegpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5977 {
5978 p = savegpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5979 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5980 p = p + 4;
5981 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5982 return p + 4;
5983 }
5984
5985 static bfd_byte *
5986 restgpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5987 {
5988 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5989 return p + 4;
5990 }
5991
5992 static bfd_byte *
5993 restgpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5994 {
5995 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5996 p = p + 4;
5997 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5998 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5999 p = p + 4;
6000 if (r == 29)
6001 {
6002 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 30);
6003 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 31);
6004 }
6005 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6006 return p + 4;
6007 }
6008
6009 static bfd_byte *
6010 savegpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6011 {
6012 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6013 return p + 4;
6014 }
6015
6016 static bfd_byte *
6017 savegpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6018 {
6019 p = savegpr1 (abfd, p, r);
6020 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6021 return p + 4;
6022 }
6023
6024 static bfd_byte *
6025 restgpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6026 {
6027 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6028 return p + 4;
6029 }
6030
6031 static bfd_byte *
6032 restgpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6033 {
6034 p = restgpr1 (abfd, p, r);
6035 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6036 return p + 4;
6037 }
6038
6039 static bfd_byte *
6040 savefpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6041 {
6042 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6043 return p + 4;
6044 }
6045
6046 static bfd_byte *
6047 savefpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6048 {
6049 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6050 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6051 p = p + 4;
6052 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6053 return p + 4;
6054 }
6055
6056 static bfd_byte *
6057 restfpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6058 {
6059 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6060 return p + 4;
6061 }
6062
6063 static bfd_byte *
6064 restfpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6065 {
6066 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6067 p = p + 4;
6068 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6069 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6070 p = p + 4;
6071 if (r == 29)
6072 {
6073 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 30);
6074 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 31);
6075 }
6076 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6077 return p + 4;
6078 }
6079
6080 static bfd_byte *
6081 savefpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6082 {
6083 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6084 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6085 return p + 4;
6086 }
6087
6088 static bfd_byte *
6089 restfpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6090 {
6091 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6092 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6093 return p + 4;
6094 }
6095
6096 static bfd_byte *
6097 savevr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6098 {
6099 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6100 p = p + 4;
6101 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6102 return p + 4;
6103 }
6104
6105 static bfd_byte *
6106 savevr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6107 {
6108 p = savevr (abfd, p, r);
6109 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6110 return p + 4;
6111 }
6112
6113 static bfd_byte *
6114 restvr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6115 {
6116 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6117 p = p + 4;
6118 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6119 return p + 4;
6120 }
6121
6122 static bfd_byte *
6123 restvr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6124 {
6125 p = restvr (abfd, p, r);
6126 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6127 return p + 4;
6128 }
6129
6130 #define STDU_R1_0R1 0xf8210001
6131 #define ADDI_R1_R1 0x38210000
6132
6133 /* Emit prologue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6134 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6135
6136 static bfd_byte *
6137 tls_get_addr_prologue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6138 {
6139 unsigned int i;
6140
6141 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
6142 p += 4;
6143 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + 16, p);
6144 p += 4;
6145
6146 if (htab->opd_abi)
6147 {
6148 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6149 {
6150 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6151 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(13 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6152 p += 4;
6153 }
6154 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-128 & 0xffff), p);
6155 p += 4;
6156 }
6157 else
6158 {
6159 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6160 {
6161 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6162 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(12 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6163 p += 4;
6164 }
6165 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-96 & 0xffff), p);
6166 p += 4;
6167 }
6168 return p;
6169 }
6170
6171 /* Emit epilogue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6172 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6173
6174 static bfd_byte *
6175 tls_get_addr_epilogue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6176 {
6177 unsigned int i;
6178
6179 if (htab->opd_abi)
6180 {
6181 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6182 {
6183 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (128 - (13 - i) * 8), p);
6184 p += 4;
6185 }
6186 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 128, p);
6187 p += 4;
6188 }
6189 else
6190 {
6191 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6192 {
6193 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (96 - (12 - i) * 8), p);
6194 p += 4;
6195 }
6196 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 96, p);
6197 p += 4;
6198 }
6199 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | 16, p);
6200 p += 4;
6201 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6202 p += 4;
6203 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
6204 p += 4;
6205 return p;
6206 }
6207
6208 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to transfer dynamic linking
6209 information on function code symbol entries to their corresponding
6210 function descriptor symbol entries. */
6211
6212 static bfd_boolean
6213 func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
6214 {
6215 struct bfd_link_info *info;
6216 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6217 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
6218 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
6219 bfd_boolean force_local;
6220
6221 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6222 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6223 return TRUE;
6224
6225 if (!fh->is_func)
6226 return TRUE;
6227
6228 if (fh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.'
6229 || fh->elf.root.root.string[1] == '\0')
6230 return TRUE;
6231
6232 info = inf;
6233 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6234 if (htab == NULL)
6235 return FALSE;
6236
6237 /* Find the corresponding function descriptor symbol. */
6238 fdh = lookup_fdh (fh, htab);
6239
6240 /* Resolve undefined references to dot-symbols as the value
6241 in the function descriptor, if we have one in a regular object.
6242 This is to satisfy cases like ".quad .foo". Calls to functions
6243 in dynamic objects are handled elsewhere. */
6244 if ((fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6245 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6246 && (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6247 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6248 && get_opd_info (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
6249 && opd_entry_value (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6250 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value,
6251 &fh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6252 &fh->elf.root.u.def.value, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
6253 {
6254 fh->elf.root.type = fdh->elf.root.type;
6255 fh->elf.forced_local = 1;
6256 fh->elf.def_regular = fdh->elf.def_regular;
6257 fh->elf.def_dynamic = fdh->elf.def_dynamic;
6258 }
6259
6260 if (!fh->elf.dynamic)
6261 {
6262 struct plt_entry *ent;
6263
6264 for (ent = fh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6265 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6266 break;
6267 if (ent == NULL)
6268 return TRUE;
6269 }
6270
6271 /* Create a descriptor as undefined if necessary. */
6272 if (fdh == NULL
6273 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
6274 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6275 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
6276 {
6277 fdh = make_fdh (info, fh);
6278 if (fdh == NULL)
6279 return FALSE;
6280 }
6281
6282 /* We can't support overriding of symbols on a fake descriptor. */
6283 if (fdh != NULL
6284 && fdh->fake
6285 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6286 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
6287 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fdh->elf, TRUE);
6288
6289 /* Transfer dynamic linking information to the function descriptor. */
6290 if (fdh != NULL)
6291 {
6292 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= fh->elf.ref_regular;
6293 fdh->elf.ref_dynamic |= fh->elf.ref_dynamic;
6294 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= fh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
6295 fdh->elf.non_got_ref |= fh->elf.non_got_ref;
6296 fdh->elf.dynamic |= fh->elf.dynamic;
6297 fdh->elf.needs_plt |= (fh->elf.needs_plt
6298 || fh->elf.type == STT_FUNC
6299 || fh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
6300 move_plt_plist (fh, fdh);
6301
6302 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
6303 && fh->elf.dynindx != -1)
6304 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
6305 return FALSE;
6306 }
6307
6308 /* Now that the info is on the function descriptor, clear the
6309 function code sym info. Any function code syms for which we
6310 don't have a definition in a regular file, we force local.
6311 This prevents a shared library from exporting syms that have
6312 been imported from another library. Function code syms that
6313 are really in the library we must leave global to prevent the
6314 linker dragging in a definition from a static library. */
6315 force_local = (!fh->elf.def_regular
6316 || fdh == NULL
6317 || !fdh->elf.def_regular
6318 || fdh->elf.forced_local);
6319 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6320
6321 return TRUE;
6322 }
6323
6324 static const struct sfpr_def_parms save_res_funcs[] =
6325 {
6326 { "_savegpr0_", 14, 31, savegpr0, savegpr0_tail },
6327 { "_restgpr0_", 14, 29, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6328 { "_restgpr0_", 30, 31, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6329 { "_savegpr1_", 14, 31, savegpr1, savegpr1_tail },
6330 { "_restgpr1_", 14, 31, restgpr1, restgpr1_tail },
6331 { "_savefpr_", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr0_tail },
6332 { "_restfpr_", 14, 29, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6333 { "_restfpr_", 30, 31, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6334 { "._savef", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr1_tail },
6335 { "._restf", 14, 31, restfpr, restfpr1_tail },
6336 { "_savevr_", 20, 31, savevr, savevr_tail },
6337 { "_restvr_", 20, 31, restvr, restvr_tail }
6338 };
6339
6340 /* Called near the start of bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections. We use
6341 this hook to a) provide some gcc support functions, and b) transfer
6342 dynamic linking information gathered so far on function code symbol
6343 entries, to their corresponding function descriptor symbol entries. */
6344
6345 static bfd_boolean
6346 ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6347 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6348 {
6349 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6350
6351 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6352 if (htab == NULL)
6353 return FALSE;
6354
6355 /* Provide any missing _save* and _rest* functions. */
6356 if (htab->sfpr != NULL)
6357 {
6358 unsigned int i;
6359
6360 htab->sfpr->size = 0;
6361 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
6362 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], NULL))
6363 return FALSE;
6364 if (htab->sfpr->size == 0)
6365 htab->sfpr->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6366 }
6367
6368 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
6369 return TRUE;
6370
6371 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6372 {
6373 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, htab->elf.hgot, TRUE);
6374 /* Make .TOC. defined so as to prevent it being made dynamic.
6375 The wrong value here is fixed later in ppc64_elf_set_toc. */
6376 if (!htab->elf.hgot->def_regular
6377 || htab->elf.hgot->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
6378 {
6379 htab->elf.hgot->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6380 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = 0;
6381 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6382 htab->elf.hgot->def_regular = 1;
6383 htab->elf.hgot->root.linker_def = 1;
6384 }
6385 htab->elf.hgot->type = STT_OBJECT;
6386 htab->elf.hgot->other
6387 = (htab->elf.hgot->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
6388 }
6389
6390 if (htab->need_func_desc_adj)
6391 {
6392 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
6393 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
6394 }
6395
6396 return TRUE;
6397 }
6398
6399 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
6400 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
6401 size_dynamic_sections. */
6402
6403 static bfd_boolean
6404 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6405 {
6406 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6407 do
6408 {
6409 if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
6410 return TRUE;
6411 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
6412 }
6413 while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
6414
6415 return FALSE;
6416 }
6417
6418 /* Return whether EH has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
6419
6420 static bfd_boolean
6421 pc_dynrelocs (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh)
6422 {
6423 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6424
6425 for (p = eh->elf.dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6426 if (p->pc_count != 0)
6427 return TRUE;
6428 return FALSE;
6429 }
6430
6431 /* Return true if a global entry stub will be created for H. Valid
6432 for ELFv2 before plt entries have been allocated. */
6433
6434 static bfd_boolean
6435 global_entry_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6436 {
6437 struct plt_entry *pent;
6438
6439 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6440 || h->def_regular)
6441 return FALSE;
6442
6443 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
6444 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0
6445 && pent->addend == 0)
6446 return TRUE;
6447
6448 return FALSE;
6449 }
6450
6451 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6452 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6453 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6454 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6455 understand. */
6456
6457 static bfd_boolean
6458 ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6459 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6460 {
6461 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6462 asection *s, *srel;
6463
6464 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6465 if (htab == NULL)
6466 return FALSE;
6467
6468 /* Deal with function syms. */
6469 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6470 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6471 || h->needs_plt)
6472 {
6473 bfd_boolean local = (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->save_res
6474 || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
6475 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
6476 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
6477 function symbol is local and not an ifunc. We keep dynamic
6478 relocs for ifuncs when local rather than always emitting a
6479 plt call stub for them and defining the symbol on the call
6480 stub. We can't do that for ELFv1 anyway (a function symbol
6481 is defined on a descriptor, not code) and it can be faster at
6482 run-time due to not needing to bounce through a stub. The
6483 dyn_relocs for ifuncs will be applied even in a static
6484 executable. */
6485 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6486 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6487 && local)
6488 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6489
6490 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
6491 won't need a .plt entry. */
6492 struct plt_entry *ent;
6493 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6494 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6495 break;
6496 if (ent == NULL
6497 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6498 && local
6499 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
6500 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
6501 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
6502 {
6503 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6504 h->needs_plt = 0;
6505 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6506 }
6507 else if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) >= 2)
6508 {
6509 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
6510 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
6511 executable on a global entry stub. A dynamic reloc can
6512 be used instead. The reason we prefer a few more dynamic
6513 relocs is that calling via a global entry stub costs a
6514 few more instructions, and pointer_equality_needed causes
6515 extra work in ld.so when resolving these symbols. */
6516 if (global_entry_stub (h))
6517 {
6518 if (!_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6519 {
6520 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6521 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
6522 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6523 if (!h->needs_plt)
6524 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6525 }
6526 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
6527 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
6528 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
6529 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6530 }
6531
6532 /* ELFv2 function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
6533 return TRUE;
6534 }
6535 else if (!h->needs_plt
6536 && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6537 {
6538 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol isn't an
6539 ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6540 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6541 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6542 return TRUE;
6543 }
6544 }
6545 else
6546 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6547
6548 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6549 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6550 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6551 if (h->is_weakalias)
6552 {
6553 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
6554 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6555 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
6556 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
6557 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
6558 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
6559 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6560 return TRUE;
6561 }
6562
6563 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
6564 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
6565 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
6566 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
6567 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
6568 return TRUE;
6569
6570 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
6571 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
6572 if (!h->non_got_ref)
6573 return TRUE;
6574
6575 /* Don't generate a copy reloc for symbols defined in the executable. */
6576 if (!h->def_dynamic || !h->ref_regular || h->def_regular
6577
6578 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, don't generate them either. */
6579 || info->nocopyreloc
6580
6581 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
6582 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc. */
6583 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
6584 && !h->needs_copy
6585 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6586
6587 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
6588 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
6589 definition for the variable. Text relocations are preferable
6590 to an incorrect program. */
6591 || h->protected_def)
6592 return TRUE;
6593
6594 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6595 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
6596 {
6597 /* .dynbss copies of function symbols only work if we have
6598 ELFv1 dot-symbols. ELFv1 compilers since 2004 default to not
6599 use dot-symbols and set the function symbol size to the text
6600 size of the function rather than the size of the descriptor.
6601 That's wrong for copying a descriptor. */
6602 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh == NULL
6603 || !(h->size == 24 || h->size == 16))
6604 return TRUE;
6605
6606 /* We should never get here, but unfortunately there are old
6607 versions of gcc (circa gcc-3.2) that improperly for the
6608 ELFv1 ABI put initialized function pointers, vtable refs and
6609 suchlike in read-only sections. Allow them to proceed, but
6610 warn that this might break at runtime. */
6611 info->callbacks->einfo
6612 (_("%P: copy reloc against `%pT' requires lazy plt linking; "
6613 "avoid setting LD_BIND_NOW=1 or upgrade gcc\n"),
6614 h->root.root.string);
6615 }
6616
6617 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6618 is not a function. */
6619
6620 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
6621 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
6622 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
6623 object will contain position independent code, so all references
6624 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
6625 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
6626 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
6627 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
6628 same memory location for the variable. */
6629 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6630 {
6631 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
6632 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
6633 }
6634 else
6635 {
6636 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
6637 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
6638 }
6639 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
6640 {
6641 /* We must generate a R_PPC64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
6642 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
6643 and into the runtime process image. */
6644 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
6645 h->needs_copy = 1;
6646 }
6647
6648 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
6649 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6650 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
6651 }
6652
6653 /* If given a function descriptor symbol, hide both the function code
6654 sym and the descriptor. */
6655 static void
6656 ppc64_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6657 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6658 bfd_boolean force_local)
6659 {
6660 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6661 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
6662
6663 if (ppc_hash_table (info) == NULL)
6664 return;
6665
6666 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6667 if (eh->is_func_descriptor)
6668 {
6669 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = eh->oh;
6670
6671 if (fh == NULL)
6672 {
6673 const char *p, *q;
6674 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
6675 char save;
6676
6677 /* We aren't supposed to use alloca in BFD because on
6678 systems which do not have alloca the version in libiberty
6679 calls xmalloc, which might cause the program to crash
6680 when it runs out of memory. This function doesn't have a
6681 return status, so there's no way to gracefully return an
6682 error. So cheat. We know that string[-1] can be safely
6683 accessed; It's either a string in an ELF string table,
6684 or allocated in an objalloc structure. */
6685
6686 p = eh->elf.root.root.string - 1;
6687 save = *p;
6688 *(char *) p = '.';
6689 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE,
6690 FALSE, FALSE));
6691 *(char *) p = save;
6692
6693 /* Unfortunately, if it so happens that the string we were
6694 looking for was allocated immediately before this string,
6695 then we overwrote the string terminator. That's the only
6696 reason the lookup should fail. */
6697 if (fh == NULL)
6698 {
6699 q = eh->elf.root.root.string + strlen (eh->elf.root.root.string);
6700 while (q >= eh->elf.root.root.string && *q == *p)
6701 --q, --p;
6702 if (q < eh->elf.root.root.string && *p == '.')
6703 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE,
6704 FALSE, FALSE));
6705 }
6706 if (fh != NULL)
6707 {
6708 eh->oh = fh;
6709 fh->oh = eh;
6710 }
6711 }
6712 if (fh != NULL)
6713 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6714 }
6715 }
6716
6717 static bfd_boolean
6718 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
6719 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
6720 asection **symsecp,
6721 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6722 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6723 unsigned long r_symndx,
6724 bfd *ibfd)
6725 {
6726 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6727
6728 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6729 {
6730 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
6731 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6732
6733 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6734 h = elf_follow_link (h);
6735
6736 if (hp != NULL)
6737 *hp = h;
6738
6739 if (symp != NULL)
6740 *symp = NULL;
6741
6742 if (symsecp != NULL)
6743 {
6744 asection *symsec = NULL;
6745 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6746 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6747 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
6748 *symsecp = symsec;
6749 }
6750
6751 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6752 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
6753 }
6754 else
6755 {
6756 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6757 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
6758
6759 if (locsyms == NULL)
6760 {
6761 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6762 if (locsyms == NULL)
6763 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
6764 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
6765 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
6766 if (locsyms == NULL)
6767 return FALSE;
6768 *locsymsp = locsyms;
6769 }
6770 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
6771
6772 if (hp != NULL)
6773 *hp = NULL;
6774
6775 if (symp != NULL)
6776 *symp = sym;
6777
6778 if (symsecp != NULL)
6779 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
6780
6781 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6782 {
6783 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
6784 unsigned char *tls_mask;
6785
6786 tls_mask = NULL;
6787 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
6788 if (lgot_ents != NULL)
6789 {
6790 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6791 (lgot_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6792 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
6793 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6794 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
6795 }
6796 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
6797 }
6798 }
6799 return TRUE;
6800 }
6801
6802 /* Returns TLS_MASKP for the given REL symbol. Function return is 0 on
6803 error, 2 on a toc GD type suitable for optimization, 3 on a toc LD
6804 type suitable for optimization, and 1 otherwise. */
6805
6806 static int
6807 get_tls_mask (unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6808 unsigned long *toc_symndx,
6809 bfd_vma *toc_addend,
6810 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6811 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6812 bfd *ibfd)
6813 {
6814 unsigned long r_symndx;
6815 int next_r;
6816 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6817 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6818 asection *sec;
6819 bfd_vma off;
6820
6821 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6822 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6823 return 0;
6824
6825 if ((*tls_maskp != NULL
6826 && (**tls_maskp & TLS_TLS) != 0
6827 && **tls_maskp != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
6828 || sec == NULL
6829 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) == NULL
6830 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type != sec_toc)
6831 return 1;
6832
6833 /* Look inside a TOC section too. */
6834 if (h != NULL)
6835 {
6836 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6837 off = h->root.u.def.value;
6838 }
6839 else
6840 off = sym->st_value;
6841 off += rel->r_addend;
6842 BFD_ASSERT (off % 8 == 0);
6843 r_symndx = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8];
6844 next_r = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8 + 1];
6845 if (toc_symndx != NULL)
6846 *toc_symndx = r_symndx;
6847 if (toc_addend != NULL)
6848 *toc_addend = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.add[off / 8];
6849 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6850 return 0;
6851 if ((h == NULL || is_static_defined (h))
6852 && (next_r == -1 || next_r == -2))
6853 return 1 - next_r;
6854 return 1;
6855 }
6856
6857 /* Find (or create) an entry in the tocsave hash table. */
6858
6859 static struct tocsave_entry *
6860 tocsave_find (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
6861 enum insert_option insert,
6862 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6863 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irela,
6864 bfd *ibfd)
6865 {
6866 unsigned long r_indx;
6867 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6868 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6869 struct tocsave_entry ent, *p;
6870 hashval_t hash;
6871 struct tocsave_entry **slot;
6872
6873 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
6874 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &ent.sec, NULL, local_syms, r_indx, ibfd))
6875 return NULL;
6876 if (ent.sec == NULL || ent.sec->output_section == NULL)
6877 {
6878 _bfd_error_handler
6879 (_("%pB: undefined symbol on R_PPC64_TOCSAVE relocation"), ibfd);
6880 return NULL;
6881 }
6882
6883 if (h != NULL)
6884 ent.offset = h->root.u.def.value;
6885 else
6886 ent.offset = sym->st_value;
6887 ent.offset += irela->r_addend;
6888
6889 hash = tocsave_htab_hash (&ent);
6890 slot = ((struct tocsave_entry **)
6891 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->tocsave_htab, &ent, hash, insert));
6892 if (slot == NULL)
6893 return NULL;
6894
6895 if (*slot == NULL)
6896 {
6897 p = (struct tocsave_entry *) bfd_alloc (ibfd, sizeof (*p));
6898 if (p == NULL)
6899 return NULL;
6900 *p = ent;
6901 *slot = p;
6902 }
6903 return *slot;
6904 }
6905
6906 /* Adjust all global syms defined in opd sections. In gcc generated
6907 code for the old ABI, these will already have been done. */
6908
6909 static bfd_boolean
6910 adjust_opd_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6911 {
6912 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6913 asection *sym_sec;
6914 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6915
6916 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6917 return TRUE;
6918
6919 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6920 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6921 return TRUE;
6922
6923 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6924 if (eh->adjust_done)
6925 return TRUE;
6926
6927 sym_sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
6928 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
6929 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
6930 {
6931 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (eh->elf.root.u.def.value)];
6932 if (adjust == -1)
6933 {
6934 /* This entry has been deleted. */
6935 asection *dsec = ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section;
6936 if (dsec == NULL)
6937 {
6938 for (dsec = sym_sec->owner->sections; dsec; dsec = dsec->next)
6939 if (discarded_section (dsec))
6940 {
6941 ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section = dsec;
6942 break;
6943 }
6944 }
6945 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6946 eh->elf.root.u.def.section = dsec;
6947 }
6948 else
6949 eh->elf.root.u.def.value += adjust;
6950 eh->adjust_done = 1;
6951 }
6952 return TRUE;
6953 }
6954
6955 /* Handles decrementing dynamic reloc counts for the reloc specified by
6956 R_INFO in section SEC. If LOCAL_SYMS is NULL, then H and SYM
6957 have already been determined. */
6958
6959 static bfd_boolean
6960 dec_dynrel_count (bfd_vma r_info,
6961 asection *sec,
6962 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6963 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6964 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6965 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6966 {
6967 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
6968 asection *sym_sec = NULL;
6969
6970 /* Can this reloc be dynamic? This switch, and later tests here
6971 should be kept in sync with the code in check_relocs. */
6972 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (r_info);
6973 switch (r_type)
6974 {
6975 default:
6976 return TRUE;
6977
6978 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
6979 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
6980 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
6981 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
6982 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
6983 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
6984 if (h == NULL)
6985 return TRUE;
6986 break;
6987
6988 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
6989 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
6990 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
6991 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
6992 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
6993 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
6994 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
6995 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
6996 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
6997 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
6998 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
6999 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
7000 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
7001 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
7002 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
7003 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
7004 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
7005 case R_PPC64_REL30:
7006 case R_PPC64_REL32:
7007 case R_PPC64_REL64:
7008 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
7009 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7010 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7011 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
7012 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
7013 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
7014 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
7015 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
7016 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
7017 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
7018 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
7019 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
7020 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
7021 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
7022 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
7023 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
7024 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
7025 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
7026 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
7027 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
7028 case R_PPC64_TOC:
7029 case R_PPC64_D34:
7030 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
7031 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
7032 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
7033 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
7034 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
7035 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
7036 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
7037 case R_PPC64_D28:
7038 break;
7039 }
7040
7041 if (local_syms != NULL)
7042 {
7043 unsigned long r_symndx;
7044 bfd *ibfd = sec->owner;
7045
7046 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (r_info);
7047 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, local_syms, r_symndx, ibfd))
7048 return FALSE;
7049 }
7050
7051 if ((h != NULL
7052 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
7053 || !h->def_regular))
7054 || (h != NULL
7055 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
7056 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
7057 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7058 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7059 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7060 && (h != NULL
7061 ? h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
7062 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)))
7063 ;
7064 else
7065 return TRUE;
7066
7067 if (h != NULL)
7068 {
7069 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
7070 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
7071 pp = &h->dyn_relocs;
7072
7073 /* elf_gc_sweep may have already removed all dyn relocs associated
7074 with local syms for a given section. Also, symbol flags are
7075 changed by elf_gc_sweep_symbol, confusing the test above. Don't
7076 report a dynreloc miscount. */
7077 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7078 return TRUE;
7079
7080 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7081 {
7082 if (p->sec == sec)
7083 {
7084 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7085 p->pc_count -= 1;
7086 p->count -= 1;
7087 if (p->count == 0)
7088 *pp = p->next;
7089 return TRUE;
7090 }
7091 pp = &p->next;
7092 }
7093 }
7094 else
7095 {
7096 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
7097 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **pp;
7098 void *vpp;
7099 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
7100
7101 if (local_syms == NULL)
7102 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
7103 if (sym_sec == NULL)
7104 sym_sec = sec;
7105
7106 vpp = &elf_section_data (sym_sec)->local_dynrel;
7107 pp = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
7108
7109 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7110 return TRUE;
7111
7112 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7113 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7114 {
7115 if (p->sec == sec && p->ifunc == is_ifunc)
7116 {
7117 p->count -= 1;
7118 if (p->count == 0)
7119 *pp = p->next;
7120 return TRUE;
7121 }
7122 pp = &p->next;
7123 }
7124 }
7125
7126 /* xgettext:c-format */
7127 _bfd_error_handler (_("dynreloc miscount for %pB, section %pA"),
7128 sec->owner, sec);
7129 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7130 return FALSE;
7131 }
7132
7133 /* Remove unused Official Procedure Descriptor entries. Currently we
7134 only remove those associated with functions in discarded link-once
7135 sections, or weakly defined functions that have been overridden. It
7136 would be possible to remove many more entries for statically linked
7137 applications. */
7138
7139 bfd_boolean
7140 ppc64_elf_edit_opd (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7141 {
7142 bfd *ibfd;
7143 bfd_boolean some_edited = FALSE;
7144 asection *need_pad = NULL;
7145 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7146
7147 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7148 if (htab == NULL)
7149 return FALSE;
7150
7151 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7152 {
7153 asection *sec;
7154 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7155 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7156 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7157 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
7158 bfd_boolean need_edit, add_aux_fields, broken;
7159 bfd_size_type cnt_16b = 0;
7160
7161 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7162 continue;
7163
7164 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
7165 if (sec == NULL || sec->size == 0)
7166 continue;
7167
7168 if (sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
7169 continue;
7170
7171 if (sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7172 continue;
7173
7174 /* Look through the section relocs. */
7175 if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
7176 continue;
7177
7178 local_syms = NULL;
7179 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7180
7181 /* Read the relocations. */
7182 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7183 info->keep_memory);
7184 if (relstart == NULL)
7185 return FALSE;
7186
7187 /* First run through the relocs to check they are sane, and to
7188 determine whether we need to edit this opd section. */
7189 need_edit = FALSE;
7190 broken = FALSE;
7191 need_pad = sec;
7192 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7193 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7194 {
7195 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7196 unsigned long r_symndx;
7197 asection *sym_sec;
7198 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7199 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7200 bfd_vma offset;
7201
7202 /* .opd contains an array of 16 or 24 byte entries. We're
7203 only interested in the reloc pointing to a function entry
7204 point. */
7205 offset = rel->r_offset;
7206 if (rel + 1 == relend
7207 || rel[1].r_offset != offset + 8)
7208 {
7209 /* If someone messes with .opd alignment then after a
7210 "ld -r" we might have padding in the middle of .opd.
7211 Also, there's nothing to prevent someone putting
7212 something silly in .opd with the assembler. No .opd
7213 optimization for them! */
7214 broken_opd:
7215 _bfd_error_handler
7216 (_("%pB: .opd is not a regular array of opd entries"), ibfd);
7217 broken = TRUE;
7218 break;
7219 }
7220
7221 if ((r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) != R_PPC64_ADDR64
7222 || (r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info)) != R_PPC64_TOC)
7223 {
7224 _bfd_error_handler
7225 /* xgettext:c-format */
7226 (_("%pB: unexpected reloc type %u in .opd section"),
7227 ibfd, r_type);
7228 broken = TRUE;
7229 break;
7230 }
7231
7232 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7233 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7234 r_symndx, ibfd))
7235 goto error_ret;
7236
7237 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec->owner == NULL)
7238 {
7239 const char *sym_name;
7240 if (h != NULL)
7241 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7242 else
7243 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
7244 sym_sec);
7245
7246 _bfd_error_handler
7247 /* xgettext:c-format */
7248 (_("%pB: undefined sym `%s' in .opd section"),
7249 ibfd, sym_name);
7250 broken = TRUE;
7251 break;
7252 }
7253
7254 /* opd entries are always for functions defined in the
7255 current input bfd. If the symbol isn't defined in the
7256 input bfd, then we won't be using the function in this
7257 bfd; It must be defined in a linkonce section in another
7258 bfd, or is weak. It's also possible that we are
7259 discarding the function due to a linker script /DISCARD/,
7260 which we test for via the output_section. */
7261 if (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7262 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7263 need_edit = TRUE;
7264
7265 rel += 2;
7266 if (rel + 1 == relend
7267 || (rel + 2 < relend
7268 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7269 ++rel;
7270
7271 if (rel == relend)
7272 {
7273 if (sec->size == offset + 24)
7274 {
7275 need_pad = NULL;
7276 break;
7277 }
7278 if (sec->size == offset + 16)
7279 {
7280 cnt_16b++;
7281 break;
7282 }
7283 goto broken_opd;
7284 }
7285 else if (rel + 1 < relend
7286 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[0].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
7287 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
7288 {
7289 if (rel[0].r_offset == offset + 16)
7290 cnt_16b++;
7291 else if (rel[0].r_offset != offset + 24)
7292 goto broken_opd;
7293 }
7294 else
7295 goto broken_opd;
7296 }
7297
7298 add_aux_fields = htab->params->non_overlapping_opd && cnt_16b > 0;
7299
7300 if (!broken && (need_edit || add_aux_fields))
7301 {
7302 Elf_Internal_Rela *write_rel;
7303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7304 bfd_byte *rptr, *wptr;
7305 bfd_byte *new_contents;
7306 bfd_size_type amt;
7307
7308 new_contents = NULL;
7309 amt = OPD_NDX (sec->size) * sizeof (long);
7310 opd = &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
7311 opd->adjust = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner, amt);
7312 if (opd->adjust == NULL)
7313 return FALSE;
7314
7315 /* This seems a waste of time as input .opd sections are all
7316 zeros as generated by gcc, but I suppose there's no reason
7317 this will always be so. We might start putting something in
7318 the third word of .opd entries. */
7319 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7320 {
7321 bfd_byte *loc;
7322 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, sec, &loc))
7323 {
7324 free (loc);
7325 error_ret:
7326 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7327 free (local_syms);
7328 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7329 free (relstart);
7330 return FALSE;
7331 }
7332 sec->contents = loc;
7333 sec->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7334 }
7335
7336 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
7337
7338 new_contents = sec->contents;
7339 if (add_aux_fields)
7340 {
7341 new_contents = bfd_malloc (sec->size + cnt_16b * 8);
7342 if (new_contents == NULL)
7343 return FALSE;
7344 need_pad = NULL;
7345 }
7346 wptr = new_contents;
7347 rptr = sec->contents;
7348 write_rel = relstart;
7349 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7350 {
7351 unsigned long r_symndx;
7352 asection *sym_sec;
7353 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7354 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = NULL;
7355 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7356 long opd_ent_size;
7357 Elf_Internal_Rela *next_rel;
7358 bfd_boolean skip;
7359
7360 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7361 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7362 r_symndx, ibfd))
7363 goto error_ret;
7364
7365 next_rel = rel + 2;
7366 if (next_rel + 1 == relend
7367 || (next_rel + 2 < relend
7368 && ELF64_R_TYPE (next_rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7369 ++next_rel;
7370
7371 /* See if the .opd entry is full 24 byte or
7372 16 byte (with fd_aux entry overlapped with next
7373 fd_func). */
7374 opd_ent_size = 24;
7375 if (next_rel == relend)
7376 {
7377 if (sec->size == rel->r_offset + 16)
7378 opd_ent_size = 16;
7379 }
7380 else if (next_rel->r_offset == rel->r_offset + 16)
7381 opd_ent_size = 16;
7382
7383 if (h != NULL
7384 && h->root.root.string[0] == '.')
7385 {
7386 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh;
7387 if (fdh != NULL)
7388 {
7389 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
7390 if (fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
7391 && fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7392 fdh = NULL;
7393 }
7394 }
7395
7396 skip = (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7397 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr);
7398 if (skip)
7399 {
7400 if (fdh != NULL && sym_sec->owner == ibfd)
7401 {
7402 /* Arrange for the function descriptor sym
7403 to be dropped. */
7404 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
7405 fdh->elf.root.u.def.section = sym_sec;
7406 }
7407 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = -1;
7408
7409 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS || bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7410 rel = next_rel;
7411 else
7412 while (1)
7413 {
7414 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
7415 NULL, h, sym))
7416 goto error_ret;
7417
7418 if (++rel == next_rel)
7419 break;
7420
7421 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7422 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7423 r_symndx, ibfd))
7424 goto error_ret;
7425 }
7426 }
7427 else
7428 {
7429 /* We'll be keeping this opd entry. */
7430 long adjust;
7431
7432 if (fdh != NULL)
7433 {
7434 /* Redefine the function descriptor symbol to
7435 this location in the opd section. It is
7436 necessary to update the value here rather
7437 than using an array of adjustments as we do
7438 for local symbols, because various places
7439 in the generic ELF code use the value
7440 stored in u.def.value. */
7441 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = wptr - new_contents;
7442 fdh->adjust_done = 1;
7443 }
7444
7445 /* Local syms are a bit tricky. We could
7446 tweak them as they can be cached, but
7447 we'd need to look through the local syms
7448 for the function descriptor sym which we
7449 don't have at the moment. So keep an
7450 array of adjustments. */
7451 adjust = (wptr - new_contents) - (rptr - sec->contents);
7452 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = adjust;
7453
7454 if (wptr != rptr)
7455 memcpy (wptr, rptr, opd_ent_size);
7456 wptr += opd_ent_size;
7457 if (add_aux_fields && opd_ent_size == 16)
7458 {
7459 memset (wptr, '\0', 8);
7460 wptr += 8;
7461 }
7462
7463 /* We need to adjust any reloc offsets to point to the
7464 new opd entries. */
7465 for ( ; rel != next_rel; ++rel)
7466 {
7467 rel->r_offset += adjust;
7468 if (write_rel != rel)
7469 memcpy (write_rel, rel, sizeof (*rel));
7470 ++write_rel;
7471 }
7472 }
7473
7474 rptr += opd_ent_size;
7475 }
7476
7477 sec->size = wptr - new_contents;
7478 sec->reloc_count = write_rel - relstart;
7479 if (add_aux_fields)
7480 {
7481 free (sec->contents);
7482 sec->contents = new_contents;
7483 }
7484
7485 /* Fudge the header size too, as this is used later in
7486 elf_bfd_final_link if we are emitting relocs. */
7487 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (sec);
7488 rel_hdr->sh_size = sec->reloc_count * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
7489 some_edited = TRUE;
7490 }
7491 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7492 free (relstart);
7493
7494 if (local_syms != NULL
7495 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7496 {
7497 if (!info->keep_memory)
7498 free (local_syms);
7499 else
7500 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7501 }
7502 }
7503
7504 if (some_edited)
7505 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_opd_syms, NULL);
7506
7507 /* If we are doing a final link and the last .opd entry is just 16 byte
7508 long, add a 8 byte padding after it. */
7509 if (need_pad != NULL && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7510 {
7511 bfd_byte *p;
7512
7513 if ((need_pad->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7514 {
7515 BFD_ASSERT (need_pad->size > 0);
7516
7517 p = bfd_malloc (need_pad->size + 8);
7518 if (p == NULL)
7519 return FALSE;
7520
7521 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (need_pad->owner, need_pad,
7522 p, 0, need_pad->size))
7523 return FALSE;
7524
7525 need_pad->contents = p;
7526 need_pad->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7527 }
7528 else
7529 {
7530 p = bfd_realloc (need_pad->contents, need_pad->size + 8);
7531 if (p == NULL)
7532 return FALSE;
7533
7534 need_pad->contents = p;
7535 }
7536
7537 memset (need_pad->contents + need_pad->size, 0, 8);
7538 need_pad->size += 8;
7539 }
7540
7541 return TRUE;
7542 }
7543
7544 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
7545 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
7546
7547 bfd_boolean
7548 ppc64_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7549 {
7550 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7551 bfd *ibfd;
7552 asection *sec;
7553 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
7554
7555 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7556 if (htab == NULL)
7557 return FALSE;
7558
7559 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
7560 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
7561 between the call and its destination. */
7562 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
7563 {
7564 limit = -htab->params->group_size;
7565 if (limit == 1)
7566 limit = 0x1e00000;
7567 }
7568 else
7569 {
7570 limit = htab->params->group_size;
7571 if (limit == 1)
7572 limit = 0x1c00000;
7573 }
7574
7575 low_vma = -1;
7576 high_vma = 0;
7577 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7578 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
7579 {
7580 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
7581 low_vma = sec->vma;
7582 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
7583 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
7584 }
7585
7586 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
7587 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
7588 is local. */
7589 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
7590 {
7591 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
7592 return TRUE;
7593 }
7594
7595 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
7596 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
7597 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
7598 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
7599 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
7600 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
7601 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
7602 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
7603 particular R_PPC64_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
7604 call, for each of the R_PPC64_PLTSEQ and R_PPC64_PLT16* insns in
7605 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
7606 together except their symbol. */
7607
7608 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7609 {
7610 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7611 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7612
7613 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7614 continue;
7615
7616 local_syms = NULL;
7617 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7618
7619 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7620 if (ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall
7621 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7622 {
7623 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7624
7625 /* Read the relocations. */
7626 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7627 info->keep_memory);
7628 if (relstart == NULL)
7629 return FALSE;
7630
7631 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7632 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7633 {
7634 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7635 unsigned long r_symndx;
7636 asection *sym_sec;
7637 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7638 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7639 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
7640
7641 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7642 if (r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
7643 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
7644 continue;
7645
7646 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7647 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
7648 r_symndx, ibfd))
7649 {
7650 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7651 free (relstart);
7652 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (bfd_byte *) local_syms)
7653 free (local_syms);
7654 return FALSE;
7655 }
7656
7657 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7658 {
7659 bfd_vma from, to;
7660 if (h != NULL)
7661 to = h->root.u.def.value;
7662 else
7663 to = sym->st_value;
7664 to += (rel->r_addend
7665 + sym_sec->output_offset
7666 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
7667 from = (rel->r_offset
7668 + sec->output_offset
7669 + sec->output_section->vma);
7670 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit
7671 && !(r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC
7672 && (((h ? h->other : sym->st_other)
7673 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
7674 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
7675 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
7676 }
7677 }
7678 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7679 free (relstart);
7680 }
7681
7682 if (local_syms != NULL
7683 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7684 {
7685 if (!info->keep_memory)
7686 free (local_syms);
7687 else
7688 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7689 }
7690 }
7691
7692 return TRUE;
7693 }
7694
7695 /* Set htab->tls_get_addr and call the generic ELF tls_setup function. */
7696
7697 asection *
7698 ppc64_elf_tls_setup (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7699 {
7700 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7701 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *tga_fd, *desc, *desc_fd;
7702
7703 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7704 if (htab == NULL)
7705 return NULL;
7706
7707 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 1)
7708 htab->opd_abi = 1;
7709
7710 if (htab->params->no_multi_toc)
7711 htab->do_multi_toc = 0;
7712 else if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
7713 htab->params->no_multi_toc = 1;
7714
7715 /* Default to --no-plt-localentry, as this option can cause problems
7716 with symbol interposition. For example, glibc libpthread.so and
7717 libc.so duplicate many pthread symbols, with a fallback
7718 implementation in libc.so. In some cases the fallback does more
7719 work than the pthread implementation. __pthread_condattr_destroy
7720 is one such symbol: the libpthread.so implementation is
7721 localentry:0 while the libc.so implementation is localentry:8.
7722 An app that "cleverly" uses dlopen to only load necessary
7723 libraries at runtime may omit loading libpthread.so when not
7724 running multi-threaded, which then results in the libc.so
7725 fallback symbols being used and ld.so complaining. Now there
7726 are workarounds in ld (see non_zero_localentry) to detect the
7727 pthread situation, but that may not be the only case where
7728 --plt-localentry can cause trouble. */
7729 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 < 0)
7730 htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7731 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0
7732 && elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "GLIBC_2.26",
7733 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE) == NULL)
7734 _bfd_error_handler
7735 (_("warning: --plt-localentry is especially dangerous without "
7736 "ld.so support to detect ABI violations"));
7737
7738 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
7739 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7740 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga);
7741
7742 /* Move dynamic linking info to the function descriptor sym. */
7743 if (tga != NULL)
7744 func_desc_adjust (tga, info);
7745 tga_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
7746 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7747 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga_fd);
7748
7749 desc = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_desc",
7750 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7751 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc);
7752 if (desc != NULL)
7753 func_desc_adjust (desc, info);
7754 desc_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_desc",
7755 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7756 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc_fd);
7757
7758 if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
7759 {
7760 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *opt_fd;
7761
7762 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_opt",
7763 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7764 if (opt != NULL)
7765 func_desc_adjust (opt, info);
7766 opt_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
7767 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7768 if (opt_fd != NULL
7769 && (opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7770 || opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
7771 {
7772 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
7773 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
7774 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
7775 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
7776 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7777 && tga_fd != NULL
7778 && (tga_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7779 || tga_fd->needs_plt)
7780 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga_fd)
7781 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga_fd))))
7782 tga_fd = NULL;
7783 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7784 && desc_fd != NULL
7785 && (desc_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7786 || desc_fd->needs_plt)
7787 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, desc_fd)
7788 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, desc_fd))))
7789 desc_fd = NULL;
7790
7791 if (tga_fd != NULL || desc_fd != NULL)
7792 {
7793 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7794
7795 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7796 for (ent = tga_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7797 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7798 break;
7799 if (ent == NULL && desc_fd != NULL)
7800 for (ent = desc_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7801 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7802 break;
7803 if (ent != NULL)
7804 {
7805 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7806 {
7807 tga_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7808 tga_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7809 tga_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7810 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, tga_fd);
7811 }
7812 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7813 {
7814 desc_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7815 desc_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7816 desc_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7817 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, desc_fd);
7818 }
7819 opt_fd->mark = 1;
7820 if (opt_fd->dynindx != -1)
7821 {
7822 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
7823 opt_fd->dynindx = -1;
7824 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
7825 opt_fd->dynstr_index);
7826 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt_fd))
7827 return NULL;
7828 }
7829 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7830 {
7831 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7832 tga = &htab->tls_get_addr->elf;
7833 if (opt != NULL && tga != NULL)
7834 {
7835 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7836 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7837 tga->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7838 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
7839 opt->mark = 1;
7840 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7841 tga->forced_local);
7842 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7843 }
7844 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->oh = htab->tls_get_addr;
7845 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7846 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7847 {
7848 htab->tls_get_addr->oh = htab->tls_get_addr_fd;
7849 htab->tls_get_addr->is_func = 1;
7850 }
7851 }
7852 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7853 {
7854 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7855 if (opt != NULL && desc != NULL)
7856 {
7857 desc->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7858 desc->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7859 desc->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7860 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, desc);
7861 opt->mark = 1;
7862 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7863 desc->forced_local);
7864 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7865 }
7866 htab->tga_desc_fd->oh = htab->tga_desc;
7867 htab->tga_desc_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7868 if (htab->tga_desc != NULL)
7869 {
7870 htab->tga_desc->oh = htab->tga_desc_fd;
7871 htab->tga_desc->is_func = 1;
7872 }
7873 }
7874 }
7875 }
7876 }
7877 else if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt < 0)
7878 htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt = 0;
7879 }
7880
7881 if (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
7882 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
7883 && htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave == -1)
7884 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave = 0;
7885
7886 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (info->output_bfd, info);
7887 }
7888
7889 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
7890 any of HASH1, HASH2, HASH3, or HASH4. */
7891
7892 static bfd_boolean
7893 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
7894 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7895 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash1,
7896 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash2,
7897 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash3,
7898 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash4)
7899 {
7900 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7901 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7902 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7903
7904 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7905 {
7906 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
7907 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7908
7909 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
7910 h = elf_follow_link (h);
7911 if (h == &hash1->elf || h == &hash2->elf
7912 || h == &hash3->elf || h == &hash4->elf)
7913 return TRUE;
7914 }
7915 return FALSE;
7916 }
7917
7918 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
7919 opportunities. The linker has been hacked (see ppc64elf.em) to do
7920 a preliminary section layout so that we know the TLS segment
7921 offsets. We can't optimize earlier because some optimizations need
7922 to know the tp offset, and we need to optimize before allocating
7923 dynamic relocations. */
7924
7925 bfd_boolean
7926 ppc64_elf_tls_optimize (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7927 {
7928 bfd *ibfd;
7929 asection *sec;
7930 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7931 unsigned char *toc_ref;
7932 int pass;
7933
7934 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
7935 return TRUE;
7936
7937 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7938 if (htab == NULL)
7939 return FALSE;
7940
7941 /* Make two passes over the relocs. On the first pass, mark toc
7942 entries involved with tls relocs, and check that tls relocs
7943 involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed followed by
7944 such a call. If they are not, we can't do any tls optimization.
7945 On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to notify
7946 relocate_section that optimization can be done, and adjust got
7947 and plt refcounts. */
7948 toc_ref = NULL;
7949 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
7950 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7951 {
7952 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = NULL;
7953 asection *toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
7954
7955 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7956 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7957 {
7958 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7959 bfd_boolean found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7960
7961 /* Read the relocations. */
7962 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7963 info->keep_memory);
7964 if (relstart == NULL)
7965 {
7966 free (toc_ref);
7967 return FALSE;
7968 }
7969
7970 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7971 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7972 {
7973 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7974 unsigned long r_symndx;
7975 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7976 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7977 asection *sym_sec;
7978 unsigned char *tls_mask;
7979 unsigned int tls_set, tls_clear, tls_type = 0;
7980 bfd_vma value;
7981 bfd_boolean ok_tprel, is_local;
7982 long toc_ref_index = 0;
7983 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
7984 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
7985
7986 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7987 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_mask, &locsyms,
7988 r_symndx, ibfd))
7989 {
7990 err_free_rel:
7991 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7992 free (relstart);
7993 free (toc_ref);
7994 if (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents
7995 != (unsigned char *) locsyms)
7996 free (locsyms);
7997 return ret;
7998 }
7999
8000 if (h != NULL)
8001 {
8002 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8003 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8004 value = h->root.u.def.value;
8005 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8006 value = 0;
8007 else
8008 {
8009 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8010 continue;
8011 }
8012 }
8013 else
8014 /* Symbols referenced by TLS relocs must be of type
8015 STT_TLS. So no need for .opd local sym adjust. */
8016 value = sym->st_value;
8017
8018 ok_tprel = FALSE;
8019 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
8020 if (is_local)
8021 {
8022 if (h != NULL
8023 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8024 ok_tprel = TRUE;
8025 else if (sym_sec != NULL
8026 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
8027 {
8028 value += sym_sec->output_offset;
8029 value += sym_sec->output_section->vma;
8030 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8031 /* Note that even though the prefix insns
8032 allow a 1<<33 offset we use the same test
8033 as for addis;addi. There may be a mix of
8034 pcrel and non-pcrel code and the decision
8035 to optimise is per symbol, not per TLS
8036 sequence. */
8037 ok_tprel = value + 0x80008000ULL < 1ULL << 32;
8038 }
8039 }
8040
8041 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8042 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8043 without marker relocs, then check that each
8044 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
8045 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
8046 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
8047 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
8048 if (pass == 0
8049 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8050 && h != NULL
8051 && is_tls_get_addr (h, htab)
8052 && !found_tls_get_addr_arg
8053 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
8054 {
8055 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
8056 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8057 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8058 ret = TRUE;
8059 goto err_free_rel;
8060 }
8061
8062 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8063 switch (r_type)
8064 {
8065 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
8066 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8067 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
8068 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8069 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8070 /* Fall through. */
8071
8072 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
8073 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8074 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
8075 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
8076 that turns out to be the case. */
8077 if (!is_local)
8078 continue;
8079
8080 /* LD -> LE */
8081 tls_set = 0;
8082 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8083 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
8084 break;
8085
8086 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
8087 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8088 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
8089 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8090 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8091 /* Fall through. */
8092
8093 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
8094 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8095 if (ok_tprel)
8096 /* GD -> LE */
8097 tls_set = 0;
8098 else
8099 /* GD -> IE */
8100 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
8101 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8102 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
8103 break;
8104
8105 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
8106 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
8107 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
8108 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
8109 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8110 if (ok_tprel)
8111 {
8112 /* IE -> LE */
8113 tls_set = 0;
8114 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8115 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
8116 break;
8117 }
8118 continue;
8119
8120 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
8121 if (!is_local)
8122 continue;
8123 /* Fall through. */
8124 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
8125 if (rel + 1 < relend
8126 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
8127 {
8128 if (pass != 0
8129 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8130 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ)
8131 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8132 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC))
8133 {
8134 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
8135 if (!get_sym_h (&h, NULL, NULL, NULL, &locsyms,
8136 r_symndx, ibfd))
8137 goto err_free_rel;
8138 if (h != NULL)
8139 {
8140 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8141
8142 for (ent = h->plt.plist;
8143 ent != NULL;
8144 ent = ent->next)
8145 if (ent->addend == rel[1].r_addend)
8146 break;
8147
8148 if (ent != NULL
8149 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8150 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8151 }
8152 }
8153 continue;
8154 }
8155 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8156 /* Fall through. */
8157
8158 case R_PPC64_TLS:
8159 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8160 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8161 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec != toc)
8162 continue;
8163
8164 /* Mark this toc entry as referenced by a TLS
8165 code sequence. We can do that now in the
8166 case of R_PPC64_TLS, and after checking for
8167 tls_get_addr for the TOC16 relocs. */
8168 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8169 toc_ref
8170 = bfd_zmalloc (toc->output_section->rawsize / 8);
8171 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8172 goto err_free_rel;
8173
8174 if (h != NULL)
8175 value = h->root.u.def.value;
8176 else
8177 value = sym->st_value;
8178 value += rel->r_addend;
8179 if (value % 8 != 0)
8180 continue;
8181 BFD_ASSERT (value < toc->size
8182 && toc->output_offset % 8 == 0);
8183 toc_ref_index = (value + toc->output_offset) / 8;
8184 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
8185 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
8186 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD)
8187 {
8188 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8189 continue;
8190 }
8191
8192 if (pass != 0 && toc_ref[toc_ref_index] == 0)
8193 continue;
8194
8195 tls_set = 0;
8196 tls_clear = 0;
8197 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
8198 break;
8199
8200 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
8201 if (pass == 0
8202 || sec != toc
8203 || toc_ref == NULL
8204 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8205 continue;
8206 if (ok_tprel)
8207 {
8208 /* IE -> LE */
8209 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8210 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8211 break;
8212 }
8213 continue;
8214
8215 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
8216 if (pass == 0
8217 || sec != toc
8218 || toc_ref == NULL
8219 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8220 continue;
8221 if (rel + 1 < relend
8222 && (rel[1].r_info
8223 == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64))
8224 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
8225 {
8226 if (ok_tprel)
8227 /* GD -> LE */
8228 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD;
8229 else
8230 /* GD -> IE */
8231 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD | TLS_GDIE;
8232 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8233 }
8234 else
8235 {
8236 if (!is_local)
8237 continue;
8238
8239 /* LD -> LE */
8240 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8241 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8242 }
8243 break;
8244
8245 default:
8246 continue;
8247 }
8248
8249 if (pass == 0)
8250 {
8251 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
8252 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8253 continue;
8254
8255 if (rel + 1 < relend
8256 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
8257 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
8258 htab->tga_desc_fd,
8259 htab->tls_get_addr,
8260 htab->tga_desc))
8261 {
8262 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
8263 {
8264 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
8265 unsigned char *toc_tls;
8266 int retval;
8267
8268 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, NULL, NULL,
8269 &locsyms,
8270 rel, ibfd);
8271 if (retval == 0)
8272 goto err_free_rel;
8273 if (toc_tls != NULL)
8274 {
8275 if ((*toc_tls & TLS_TLS) != 0
8276 && ((*toc_tls & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0))
8277 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8278 if (retval > 1)
8279 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8280 }
8281 }
8282 continue;
8283 }
8284
8285 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
8286 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
8287 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
8288 the entire optimization. */
8289 /* xgettext:c-format */
8290 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
8291 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8292 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8293 ret = TRUE;
8294 goto err_free_rel;
8295 }
8296
8297 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8298 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
8299 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
8300 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
8301 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
8302 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
8303 Disable optimization in this case. */
8304 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
8305 && (tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0
8306 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8307 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
8308 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
8309 continue;
8310
8311 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8312 {
8313 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8314
8315 if (htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL)
8316 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8317 ent != NULL;
8318 ent = ent->next)
8319 if (ent->addend == 0)
8320 break;
8321
8322 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL)
8323 for (ent = htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8324 ent != NULL;
8325 ent = ent->next)
8326 if (ent->addend == 0)
8327 break;
8328
8329 if (ent == NULL && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
8330 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr->elf.plt.plist;
8331 ent != NULL;
8332 ent = ent->next)
8333 if (ent->addend == 0)
8334 break;
8335
8336 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc != NULL)
8337 for (ent = htab->tga_desc->elf.plt.plist;
8338 ent != NULL;
8339 ent = ent->next)
8340 if (ent->addend == 0)
8341 break;
8342
8343 if (ent != NULL
8344 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8345 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8346 }
8347
8348 if (tls_clear == 0)
8349 continue;
8350
8351 if ((tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
8352 {
8353 struct got_entry *ent;
8354
8355 /* Adjust got entry for this reloc. */
8356 if (h != NULL)
8357 ent = h->got.glist;
8358 else
8359 ent = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd)[r_symndx];
8360
8361 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8362 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
8363 && ent->owner == ibfd
8364 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
8365 break;
8366 if (ent == NULL)
8367 abort ();
8368
8369 if (tls_set == 0)
8370 {
8371 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
8372 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
8373 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
8374 }
8375 }
8376 else
8377 {
8378 /* If we got rid of a DTPMOD/DTPREL reloc pair then
8379 we'll lose one or two dyn relocs. */
8380 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
8381 NULL, h, sym))
8382 return FALSE;
8383
8384 if (tls_set == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD))
8385 {
8386 if (!dec_dynrel_count ((rel + 1)->r_info, sec, info,
8387 NULL, h, sym))
8388 return FALSE;
8389 }
8390 }
8391
8392 *tls_mask |= tls_set & 0xff;
8393 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
8394 }
8395
8396 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8397 free (relstart);
8398 }
8399
8400 if (locsyms != NULL
8401 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
8402 {
8403 if (!info->keep_memory)
8404 free (locsyms);
8405 else
8406 elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents = (unsigned char *) locsyms;
8407 }
8408 }
8409
8410 free (toc_ref);
8411 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
8412 return TRUE;
8413 }
8414
8415 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_edit_toc to adjust
8416 the values of any global symbols in a toc section that has been
8417 edited. Globals in toc sections should be a rarity, so this function
8418 sets a flag if any are found in toc sections other than the one just
8419 edited, so that further hash table traversals can be avoided. */
8420
8421 struct adjust_toc_info
8422 {
8423 asection *toc;
8424 unsigned long *skip;
8425 bfd_boolean global_toc_syms;
8426 };
8427
8428 enum toc_skip_enum { ref_from_discarded = 1, can_optimize = 2 };
8429
8430 static bfd_boolean
8431 adjust_toc_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8432 {
8433 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
8434 struct adjust_toc_info *toc_inf = (struct adjust_toc_info *) inf;
8435 unsigned long i;
8436
8437 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
8438 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8439 return TRUE;
8440
8441 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
8442 if (eh->adjust_done)
8443 return TRUE;
8444
8445 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.section == toc_inf->toc)
8446 {
8447 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.value > toc_inf->toc->rawsize)
8448 i = toc_inf->toc->rawsize >> 3;
8449 else
8450 i = eh->elf.root.u.def.value >> 3;
8451
8452 if ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8453 {
8454 _bfd_error_handler
8455 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"), eh->elf.root.root.string);
8456 do
8457 ++i;
8458 while ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0);
8459 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8460 }
8461
8462 eh->elf.root.u.def.value -= toc_inf->skip[i];
8463 eh->adjust_done = 1;
8464 }
8465 else if (strcmp (eh->elf.root.u.def.section->name, ".toc") == 0)
8466 toc_inf->global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8467
8468 return TRUE;
8469 }
8470
8471 /* Return TRUE iff INSN with a relocation of R_TYPE is one we expect
8472 on a _LO variety toc/got reloc. */
8473
8474 static bfd_boolean
8475 ok_lo_toc_insn (unsigned int insn, enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
8476 {
8477 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */
8478 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
8479 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
8480 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
8481 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
8482 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
8483 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
8484 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
8485 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
8486 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
8487 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
8488 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
8489 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
8490 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
8491 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
8492 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq,lfq */
8493 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lxsd,lxssp,lfdp */
8494 /* Exclude lfqu by testing reloc. If relocs are ever
8495 defined for the reduced D field in psq_lu then those
8496 will need testing too. */
8497 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8498 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,lwa */
8499 && (insn & 1) == 0)
8500 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 60u << 26 /* stfq */
8501 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* lxv,stx{v,sd,ssp},stfdp */
8502 /* Exclude stfqu. psq_stu as above for psq_lu. */
8503 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8504 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stq */
8505 && (insn & 1) == 0));
8506 }
8507
8508 /* PCREL_OPT in one instance flags to the linker that a pair of insns:
8509 pld ra,symbol@got@pcrel
8510 load/store rt,off(ra)
8511 or
8512 pla ra,symbol@pcrel
8513 load/store rt,off(ra)
8514 may be translated to
8515 pload/pstore rt,symbol+off@pcrel
8516 nop.
8517 This function returns true if the optimization is possible, placing
8518 the prefix insn in *PINSN1, a NOP in *PINSN2 and the offset in *POFF.
8519
8520 On entry to this function, the linker has already determined that
8521 the pld can be replaced with pla: *PINSN1 is that pla insn,
8522 while *PINSN2 is the second instruction. */
8523
8524 static bfd_boolean
8525 xlate_pcrel_opt (uint64_t *pinsn1, uint64_t *pinsn2, bfd_signed_vma *poff)
8526 {
8527 uint64_t insn1 = *pinsn1;
8528 uint64_t insn2 = *pinsn2;
8529 bfd_signed_vma off;
8530
8531 if ((insn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
8532 {
8533 /* Check that regs match. */
8534 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8535 return FALSE;
8536
8537 /* P8LS or PMLS form, non-pcrel. */
8538 if ((insn2 & (-1ULL << 50) & ~(1ULL << 56)) != (1ULL << 58))
8539 return FALSE;
8540
8541 *pinsn1 = (insn2 & ~(31 << 16) & ~0x3ffff0000ffffULL) | (1ULL << 52);
8542 *pinsn2 = PNOP;
8543 off = ((insn2 >> 16) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) | (insn2 & 0xffff);
8544 *poff = (off ^ 0x200000000ULL) - 0x200000000ULL;
8545 return TRUE;
8546 }
8547
8548 insn2 >>= 32;
8549
8550 /* Check that regs match. */
8551 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8552 return FALSE;
8553
8554 switch ((insn2 >> 26) & 63)
8555 {
8556 default:
8557 return FALSE;
8558
8559 case 32: /* lwz */
8560 case 34: /* lbz */
8561 case 36: /* stw */
8562 case 38: /* stb */
8563 case 40: /* lhz */
8564 case 42: /* lha */
8565 case 44: /* sth */
8566 case 48: /* lfs */
8567 case 50: /* lfd */
8568 case 52: /* stfs */
8569 case 54: /* stfd */
8570 /* These are the PMLS cases, where we just need to tack a prefix
8571 on the insn. */
8572 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
8573 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8574 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8575 break;
8576
8577 case 58: /* lwa, ld */
8578 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8579 return FALSE;
8580 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8581 | (insn2 & 2 ? 41ULL << 26 : 57ULL << 26)
8582 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8583 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8584 break;
8585
8586 case 57: /* lxsd, lxssp */
8587 if ((insn2 & 3) < 2)
8588 return FALSE;
8589 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8590 | ((40ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8591 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8592 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8593 break;
8594
8595 case 61: /* stxsd, stxssp, lxv, stxv */
8596 if ((insn2 & 3) == 0)
8597 return FALSE;
8598 else if ((insn2 & 3) >= 2)
8599 {
8600 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8601 | ((44ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8602 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8603 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8604 }
8605 else
8606 {
8607 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8608 | ((50ULL | (insn2 & 4) | ((insn2 & 8) >> 3)) << 26)
8609 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8610 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8611 }
8612 break;
8613
8614 case 56: /* lq */
8615 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8616 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8617 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8618 break;
8619
8620 case 6: /* lxvp, stxvp */
8621 if ((insn2 & 0xe) != 0)
8622 return FALSE;
8623 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8624 | ((insn2 & 1) == 0 ? 58ULL << 26 : 62ULL << 26)
8625 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8626 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8627 break;
8628
8629 case 62: /* std, stq */
8630 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8631 return FALSE;
8632 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8633 | ((insn2 & 2) == 0 ? 61ULL << 26 : 60ULL << 26)
8634 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8635 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8636 break;
8637 }
8638
8639 *pinsn1 = insn1;
8640 *pinsn2 = (uint64_t) NOP << 32;
8641 *poff = (off ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8642 return TRUE;
8643 }
8644
8645 /* Examine all relocs referencing .toc sections in order to remove
8646 unused .toc entries. */
8647
8648 bfd_boolean
8649 ppc64_elf_edit_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
8650 {
8651 bfd *ibfd;
8652 struct adjust_toc_info toc_inf;
8653 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8654
8655 htab->do_toc_opt = 1;
8656 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8657 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
8658 {
8659 asection *toc, *sec;
8660 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8661 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
8662 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *toc_relocs;
8663 unsigned long *skip, *drop;
8664 unsigned char *used;
8665 unsigned char *keep, last, some_unused;
8666
8667 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
8668 continue;
8669
8670 toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
8671 if (toc == NULL
8672 || toc->size == 0
8673 || toc->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
8674 || discarded_section (toc))
8675 continue;
8676
8677 toc_relocs = NULL;
8678 local_syms = NULL;
8679 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
8680
8681 /* Look at sections dropped from the final link. */
8682 skip = NULL;
8683 relstart = NULL;
8684 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8685 {
8686 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8687 || !discarded_section (sec)
8688 || get_opd_info (sec)
8689 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8690 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8691 continue;
8692
8693 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
8694 if (relstart == NULL)
8695 goto error_ret;
8696
8697 /* Run through the relocs to see which toc entries might be
8698 unused. */
8699 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8700 {
8701 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8702 unsigned long r_symndx;
8703 asection *sym_sec;
8704 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8705 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8706 bfd_vma val;
8707
8708 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8709 switch (r_type)
8710 {
8711 default:
8712 continue;
8713
8714 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8715 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8716 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8717 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8718 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8719 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8720 break;
8721 }
8722
8723 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8724 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8725 r_symndx, ibfd))
8726 goto error_ret;
8727
8728 if (sym_sec != toc)
8729 continue;
8730
8731 if (h != NULL)
8732 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8733 else
8734 val = sym->st_value;
8735 val += rel->r_addend;
8736
8737 if (val >= toc->size)
8738 continue;
8739
8740 /* Anything in the toc ought to be aligned to 8 bytes.
8741 If not, don't mark as unused. */
8742 if (val & 7)
8743 continue;
8744
8745 if (skip == NULL)
8746 {
8747 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8748 if (skip == NULL)
8749 goto error_ret;
8750 }
8751
8752 skip[val >> 3] = ref_from_discarded;
8753 }
8754
8755 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8756 free (relstart);
8757 }
8758
8759 /* For largetoc loads of address constants, we can convert
8760 . addis rx,2,addr@got@ha
8761 . ld ry,addr@got@l(rx)
8762 to
8763 . addis rx,2,addr@toc@ha
8764 . addi ry,rx,addr@toc@l
8765 when addr is within 2G of the toc pointer. This then means
8766 that the word storing "addr" in the toc is no longer needed. */
8767
8768 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_small_toc_reloc
8769 && toc->output_section->rawsize < (bfd_vma) 1 << 31
8770 && toc->reloc_count != 0)
8771 {
8772 /* Read toc relocs. */
8773 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8774 info->keep_memory);
8775 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8776 goto error_ret;
8777
8778 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8779 {
8780 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8781 unsigned long r_symndx;
8782 asection *sym_sec;
8783 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8784 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8785 bfd_vma val, addr;
8786
8787 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8788 if (r_type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
8789 continue;
8790
8791 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8792 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8793 r_symndx, ibfd))
8794 goto error_ret;
8795
8796 if (sym_sec == NULL
8797 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
8798 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
8799 continue;
8800
8801 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8802 continue;
8803
8804 if (h != NULL)
8805 {
8806 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8807 continue;
8808 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8809 }
8810 else
8811 {
8812 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8813 continue;
8814 val = sym->st_value;
8815 }
8816 val += rel->r_addend;
8817 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
8818
8819 /* We don't yet know the exact toc pointer value, but we
8820 know it will be somewhere in the toc section. Don't
8821 optimize if the difference from any possible toc
8822 pointer is outside [ff..f80008000, 7fff7fff]. */
8823 addr = toc->output_section->vma + TOC_BASE_OFF;
8824 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8825 continue;
8826
8827 addr = toc->output_section->vma + toc->output_section->rawsize;
8828 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8829 continue;
8830
8831 if (skip == NULL)
8832 {
8833 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8834 if (skip == NULL)
8835 goto error_ret;
8836 }
8837
8838 skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8839 |= can_optimize | ((rel - toc_relocs) << 2);
8840 }
8841 }
8842
8843 if (skip == NULL)
8844 continue;
8845
8846 used = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*used) * (toc->size + 7) / 8);
8847 if (used == NULL)
8848 {
8849 error_ret:
8850 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8851 free (local_syms);
8852 if (sec != NULL
8853 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8854 free (relstart);
8855 if (elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8856 free (toc_relocs);
8857 free (skip);
8858 return FALSE;
8859 }
8860
8861 /* Now check all kept sections that might reference the toc.
8862 Check the toc itself last. */
8863 for (sec = (ibfd->sections == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8864 : ibfd->sections);
8865 sec != NULL;
8866 sec = (sec == toc ? NULL
8867 : sec->next == NULL ? toc
8868 : sec->next == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8869 : sec->next))
8870 {
8871 int repeat;
8872
8873 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8874 || discarded_section (sec)
8875 || get_opd_info (sec)
8876 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8877 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8878 continue;
8879
8880 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8881 info->keep_memory);
8882 if (relstart == NULL)
8883 {
8884 free (used);
8885 goto error_ret;
8886 }
8887
8888 /* Mark toc entries referenced as used. */
8889 do
8890 {
8891 repeat = 0;
8892 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8893 {
8894 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8895 unsigned long r_symndx;
8896 asection *sym_sec;
8897 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8898 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8899 bfd_vma val;
8900
8901 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8902 switch (r_type)
8903 {
8904 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8905 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8906 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8907 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8908 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8909 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8910 /* In case we're taking addresses of toc entries. */
8911 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8912 break;
8913
8914 default:
8915 continue;
8916 }
8917
8918 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8919 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8920 r_symndx, ibfd))
8921 {
8922 free (used);
8923 goto error_ret;
8924 }
8925
8926 if (sym_sec != toc)
8927 continue;
8928
8929 if (h != NULL)
8930 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8931 else
8932 val = sym->st_value;
8933 val += rel->r_addend;
8934
8935 if (val >= toc->size)
8936 continue;
8937
8938 if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8939 {
8940 bfd_vma off;
8941 unsigned char opc;
8942
8943 switch (r_type)
8944 {
8945 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8946 break;
8947
8948 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8949 off = rel->r_offset;
8950 off += (bfd_big_endian (ibfd) ? -2 : 3);
8951 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, &opc,
8952 off, 1))
8953 {
8954 free (used);
8955 goto error_ret;
8956 }
8957 if ((opc & (0x3f << 2)) == (58u << 2))
8958 break;
8959 /* Fall through. */
8960
8961 default:
8962 /* Wrong sort of reloc, or not a ld. We may
8963 as well clear ref_from_discarded too. */
8964 skip[val >> 3] = 0;
8965 }
8966 }
8967
8968 if (sec != toc)
8969 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8970 /* For the toc section, we only mark as used if this
8971 entry itself isn't unused. */
8972 else if ((used[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8973 || !(skip[rel->r_offset >> 3] & ref_from_discarded))
8974 && !used[val >> 3])
8975 {
8976 /* Do all the relocs again, to catch reference
8977 chains. */
8978 repeat = 1;
8979 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8980 }
8981 }
8982 }
8983 while (repeat);
8984
8985 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8986 free (relstart);
8987 }
8988
8989 /* Merge the used and skip arrays. Assume that TOC
8990 doublewords not appearing as either used or unused belong
8991 to an entry more than one doubleword in size. */
8992 for (drop = skip, keep = used, last = 0, some_unused = 0;
8993 drop < skip + (toc->size + 7) / 8;
8994 ++drop, ++keep)
8995 {
8996 if (*keep)
8997 {
8998 *drop &= ~ref_from_discarded;
8999 if ((*drop & can_optimize) != 0)
9000 some_unused = 1;
9001 last = 0;
9002 }
9003 else if ((*drop & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
9004 {
9005 some_unused = 1;
9006 last = ref_from_discarded;
9007 }
9008 else
9009 *drop = last;
9010 }
9011
9012 free (used);
9013
9014 if (some_unused)
9015 {
9016 bfd_byte *contents, *src;
9017 unsigned long off;
9018 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9019 bfd_boolean local_toc_syms = FALSE;
9020
9021 /* Shuffle the toc contents, and at the same time convert the
9022 skip array from booleans into offsets. */
9023 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, toc, &contents))
9024 goto error_ret;
9025
9026 elf_section_data (toc)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
9027
9028 for (src = contents, off = 0, drop = skip;
9029 src < contents + toc->size;
9030 src += 8, ++drop)
9031 {
9032 if ((*drop & (can_optimize | ref_from_discarded)) != 0)
9033 off += 8;
9034 else if (off != 0)
9035 {
9036 *drop = off;
9037 memcpy (src - off, src, 8);
9038 }
9039 }
9040 *drop = off;
9041 toc->rawsize = toc->size;
9042 toc->size = src - contents - off;
9043
9044 /* Adjust addends for relocs against the toc section sym,
9045 and optimize any accesses we can. */
9046 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9047 {
9048 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9049 || discarded_section (sec))
9050 continue;
9051
9052 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9053 info->keep_memory);
9054 if (relstart == NULL)
9055 goto error_ret;
9056
9057 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9058 {
9059 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9060 unsigned long r_symndx;
9061 asection *sym_sec;
9062 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9063 bfd_vma val;
9064
9065 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9066 switch (r_type)
9067 {
9068 default:
9069 continue;
9070
9071 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
9072 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9073 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
9074 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9075 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
9076 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9077 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
9078 break;
9079 }
9080
9081 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9082 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9083 r_symndx, ibfd))
9084 goto error_ret;
9085
9086 if (sym_sec != toc)
9087 continue;
9088
9089 if (h != NULL)
9090 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9091 else
9092 {
9093 val = sym->st_value;
9094 if (val != 0)
9095 local_toc_syms = TRUE;
9096 }
9097
9098 val += rel->r_addend;
9099
9100 if (val > toc->rawsize)
9101 val = toc->rawsize;
9102 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
9103 continue;
9104 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
9105 {
9106 Elf_Internal_Rela *tocrel
9107 = toc_relocs + (skip[val >> 3] >> 2);
9108 unsigned long tsym = ELF64_R_SYM (tocrel->r_info);
9109
9110 switch (r_type)
9111 {
9112 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9113 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
9114 break;
9115
9116 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9117 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT);
9118 break;
9119
9120 default:
9121 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
9122 ppc_howto_init ();
9123 info->callbacks->einfo
9124 /* xgettext:c-format */
9125 (_("%H: %s references "
9126 "optimized away TOC entry\n"),
9127 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
9128 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
9129 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9130 goto error_ret;
9131 }
9132 rel->r_addend = tocrel->r_addend;
9133 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9134 continue;
9135 }
9136
9137 if (h != NULL || sym->st_value != 0)
9138 continue;
9139
9140 rel->r_addend -= skip[val >> 3];
9141 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9142 }
9143
9144 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9145 free (relstart);
9146 }
9147
9148 /* We shouldn't have local or global symbols defined in the TOC,
9149 but handle them anyway. */
9150 if (local_syms != NULL)
9151 for (sym = local_syms;
9152 sym < local_syms + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9153 ++sym)
9154 if (sym->st_value != 0
9155 && bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx) == toc)
9156 {
9157 unsigned long i;
9158
9159 if (sym->st_value > toc->rawsize)
9160 i = toc->rawsize >> 3;
9161 else
9162 i = sym->st_value >> 3;
9163
9164 if ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
9165 {
9166 if (local_toc_syms)
9167 _bfd_error_handler
9168 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"),
9169 bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym, NULL));
9170 do
9171 ++i;
9172 while ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)));
9173 sym->st_value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
9174 }
9175
9176 sym->st_value -= skip[i];
9177 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9178 }
9179
9180 /* Adjust any global syms defined in this toc input section. */
9181 if (toc_inf.global_toc_syms)
9182 {
9183 toc_inf.toc = toc;
9184 toc_inf.skip = skip;
9185 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = FALSE;
9186 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_toc_syms,
9187 &toc_inf);
9188 }
9189
9190 if (toc->reloc_count != 0)
9191 {
9192 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9193 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
9194 bfd_size_type sz;
9195
9196 /* Remove unused toc relocs, and adjust those we keep. */
9197 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9198 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
9199 info->keep_memory);
9200 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9201 goto error_ret;
9202
9203 wrel = toc_relocs;
9204 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
9205 if ((skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
9206 & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) == 0)
9207 {
9208 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset - skip[rel->r_offset >> 3];
9209 wrel->r_info = rel->r_info;
9210 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
9211 ++wrel;
9212 }
9213 else if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, toc, info,
9214 &local_syms, NULL, NULL))
9215 goto error_ret;
9216
9217 elf_section_data (toc)->relocs = toc_relocs;
9218 toc->reloc_count = wrel - toc_relocs;
9219 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (toc);
9220 sz = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9221 rel_hdr->sh_size = toc->reloc_count * sz;
9222 }
9223 }
9224 else if (elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
9225 free (toc_relocs);
9226
9227 if (local_syms != NULL
9228 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9229 {
9230 if (!info->keep_memory)
9231 free (local_syms);
9232 else
9233 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9234 }
9235 free (skip);
9236 }
9237
9238 /* Look for cases where we can change an indirect GOT access to
9239 a GOT relative or PC relative access, possibly reducing the
9240 number of GOT entries. */
9241 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9242 {
9243 asection *sec;
9244 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9245 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
9246 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
9247 bfd_vma got;
9248
9249 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9250 continue;
9251
9252 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_optrel)
9253 continue;
9254
9255 sec = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9256 got = 0;
9257 if (sec != NULL)
9258 got = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
9259
9260 local_syms = NULL;
9261 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9262
9263 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9264 {
9265 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9266 || !ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel
9267 || discarded_section (sec))
9268 continue;
9269
9270 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9271 info->keep_memory);
9272 if (relstart == NULL)
9273 {
9274 got_error_ret:
9275 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9276 free (local_syms);
9277 if (sec != NULL
9278 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9279 free (relstart);
9280 return FALSE;
9281 }
9282
9283 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9284 {
9285 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9286 unsigned long r_symndx;
9287 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9288 asection *sym_sec;
9289 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9290 struct got_entry *ent;
9291 bfd_vma val, pc;
9292 unsigned char buf[8];
9293 unsigned int insn;
9294 enum {no_check, check_lo, check_ha} insn_check;
9295
9296 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9297 switch (r_type)
9298 {
9299 default:
9300 insn_check = no_check;
9301 break;
9302
9303 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
9304 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
9305 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
9306 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
9307 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
9308 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9309 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9310 insn_check = check_ha;
9311 break;
9312
9313 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
9314 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
9315 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9316 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9317 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
9318 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
9319 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
9320 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9321 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9322 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9323 insn_check = check_lo;
9324 break;
9325 }
9326
9327 if (insn_check != no_check)
9328 {
9329 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
9330
9331 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, off, 4))
9332 goto got_error_ret;
9333
9334 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9335 if (insn_check == check_lo
9336 ? !ok_lo_toc_insn (insn, r_type)
9337 : ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9338 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9339 {
9340 char str[12];
9341
9342 ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->unexpected_toc_insn = 1;
9343 sprintf (str, "%#08x", insn);
9344 info->callbacks->einfo
9345 /* xgettext:c-format */
9346 (_("%H: got/toc optimization is not supported for"
9347 " %s instruction\n"),
9348 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset & ~3, str);
9349 continue;
9350 }
9351 }
9352
9353 switch (r_type)
9354 {
9355 /* Note that we don't delete GOT entries for
9356 R_PPC64_GOT16_DS since we'd need a lot more
9357 analysis. For starters, the preliminary layout is
9358 before the GOT, PLT, dynamic sections and stubs are
9359 laid out. Then we'd need to allow for changes in
9360 distance between sections caused by alignment. */
9361 default:
9362 continue;
9363
9364 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9365 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9366 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9367 break;
9368 }
9369
9370 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9371 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9372 r_symndx, ibfd))
9373 goto got_error_ret;
9374
9375 if (sym_sec == NULL
9376 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
9377 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
9378 continue;
9379
9380 if ((h ? h->type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9381 continue;
9382
9383 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9384 continue;
9385
9386 if (h != NULL)
9387 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9388 else
9389 val = sym->st_value;
9390 val += rel->r_addend;
9391 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
9392
9393 /* Fudge factor to allow for the fact that the preliminary layout
9394 isn't exact. Reduce limits by this factor. */
9395 #define LIMIT_ADJUST(LIMIT) ((LIMIT) - (LIMIT) / 16)
9396
9397 switch (r_type)
9398 {
9399 default:
9400 continue;
9401
9402 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9403 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9404 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9405 continue;
9406
9407 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9408 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9409 goto got_error_ret;
9410 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9411 if (((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9412 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9413 continue;
9414 break;
9415
9416 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9417 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9418 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9419 continue;
9420 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9421 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9422 goto got_error_ret;
9423 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9424 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) != 58u << 26 /* ld */)
9425 continue;
9426 break;
9427
9428 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9429 pc = rel->r_offset;
9430 pc += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9431 if (val - pc + LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 33)
9432 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 34))
9433 continue;
9434 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9435 rel->r_offset & ~3, 8))
9436 goto got_error_ret;
9437 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9438 if ((insn & (-1u << 18)) != ((1u << 26) | (1u << 20)))
9439 continue;
9440 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf + 4);
9441 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 57u << 26)
9442 continue;
9443 break;
9444 }
9445 #undef LIMIT_ADJUST
9446
9447 if (h != NULL)
9448 ent = h->got.glist;
9449 else
9450 {
9451 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9452 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
9453 }
9454 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9455 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9456 && ent->owner == ibfd
9457 && ent->tls_type == 0)
9458 break;
9459 BFD_ASSERT (ent && ent->got.refcount > 0);
9460 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
9461 }
9462
9463 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9464 free (relstart);
9465 }
9466
9467 if (local_syms != NULL
9468 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9469 {
9470 if (!info->keep_memory)
9471 free (local_syms);
9472 else
9473 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9474 }
9475 }
9476
9477 return TRUE;
9478 }
9479
9480 /* Return true iff input section I references the TOC using
9481 instructions limited to +/-32k offsets. */
9482
9483 bfd_boolean
9484 ppc64_elf_has_small_toc_reloc (asection *i)
9485 {
9486 return (is_ppc64_elf (i->owner)
9487 && ppc64_elf_tdata (i->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc);
9488 }
9489
9490 /* Allocate space for one GOT entry. */
9491
9492 static void
9493 allocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9494 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9495 struct got_entry *gent)
9496 {
9497 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9498 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9499 int entsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)
9500 ? 16 : 8);
9501 int rentsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & TLS_GD
9502 ? 2 : 1) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9503 asection *got = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->got;
9504
9505 gent->got.offset = got->size;
9506 got->size += entsize;
9507
9508 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9509 {
9510 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rentsize;
9511 htab->got_reli_size += rentsize;
9512 }
9513 else if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
9514 && !(gent->tls_type != 0
9515 && bfd_link_executable (info)
9516 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9517 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9518 && h->dynindx != -1
9519 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9520 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9521 {
9522 asection *relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->relgot;
9523 relgot->size += rentsize;
9524 }
9525 }
9526
9527 /* This function merges got entries in the same toc group. */
9528
9529 static void
9530 merge_got_entries (struct got_entry **pent)
9531 {
9532 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
9533
9534 for (ent = *pent; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9535 if (!ent->is_indirect)
9536 for (ent2 = ent->next; ent2 != NULL; ent2 = ent2->next)
9537 if (!ent2->is_indirect
9538 && ent2->addend == ent->addend
9539 && ent2->tls_type == ent->tls_type
9540 && elf_gp (ent2->owner) == elf_gp (ent->owner))
9541 {
9542 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
9543 ent2->got.ent = ent;
9544 }
9545 }
9546
9547 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
9548
9549 static bfd_boolean
9550 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9551 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9552 {
9553 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
9554
9555 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
9556 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
9557 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
9558 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9559 && h->dynindx == -1
9560 && !h->forced_local
9561 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
9562 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
9563 return TRUE;
9564 }
9565
9566 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
9567 dynamic relocs. */
9568
9569 static bfd_boolean
9570 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9571 {
9572 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9573 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9574 asection *s;
9575 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
9576 struct got_entry **pgent, *gent;
9577
9578 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9579 return TRUE;
9580
9581 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9582 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9583 if (htab == NULL)
9584 return FALSE;
9585
9586 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9587 /* Run through the TLS GD got entries first if we're changing them
9588 to TPREL. */
9589 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE))
9590 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9591 if (gent->got.refcount > 0
9592 && (gent->tls_type & TLS_GD) != 0)
9593 {
9594 /* This was a GD entry that has been converted to TPREL. If
9595 there happens to be a TPREL entry we can use that one. */
9596 struct got_entry *ent;
9597 for (ent = h->got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9598 if (ent->got.refcount > 0
9599 && (ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9600 && ent->addend == gent->addend
9601 && ent->owner == gent->owner)
9602 {
9603 gent->got.refcount = 0;
9604 break;
9605 }
9606
9607 /* If not, then we'll be using our own TPREL entry. */
9608 if (gent->got.refcount != 0)
9609 gent->tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
9610 }
9611
9612 /* Remove any list entry that won't generate a word in the GOT before
9613 we call merge_got_entries. Otherwise we risk merging to empty
9614 entries. */
9615 pgent = &h->got.glist;
9616 while ((gent = *pgent) != NULL)
9617 if (gent->got.refcount > 0)
9618 {
9619 if ((gent->tls_type & TLS_LD) != 0
9620 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9621 {
9622 ppc64_tlsld_got (gent->owner)->got.refcount += 1;
9623 *pgent = gent->next;
9624 }
9625 else
9626 pgent = &gent->next;
9627 }
9628 else
9629 *pgent = gent->next;
9630
9631 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
9632 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
9633
9634 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9635 if (!gent->is_indirect)
9636 {
9637 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol should
9638 be made dynamic. */
9639 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9640 return FALSE;
9641
9642 if (!is_ppc64_elf (gent->owner))
9643 abort ();
9644
9645 allocate_got (h, info, gent);
9646 }
9647
9648 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
9649 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
9650 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9651 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9652 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9653
9654 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
9655 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
9656 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
9657 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9658
9659 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
9660 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
9661 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9662 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9663
9664 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9665 {
9666 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **pp;
9667
9668 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
9669 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to
9670 be defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case,
9671 discard space for relocs that have become local due to symbol
9672 visibility changes. */
9673 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9674 {
9675 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
9676 insn, or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that
9677 can be generated via assembly. We want calls to
9678 protected symbols to resolve directly to the function
9679 rather than going via the plt. If people want function
9680 pointer comparisons to work as expected then they should
9681 avoid writing weird assembly. */
9682 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
9683 {
9684 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
9685 {
9686 p->count -= p->pc_count;
9687 p->pc_count = 0;
9688 if (p->count == 0)
9689 *pp = p->next;
9690 else
9691 pp = &p->next;
9692 }
9693 }
9694
9695 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9696 {
9697 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9698 should be made dynamic. */
9699 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9700 return FALSE;
9701 }
9702 }
9703
9704 /* For a fixed position executable, discard space for
9705 relocs against symbols which are not dynamic. */
9706 else if (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9707 {
9708 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
9709 && !h->def_regular
9710 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
9711 {
9712 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9713 should be made dynamic. */
9714 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9715 return FALSE;
9716
9717 /* But if that didn't work out, discard dynamic relocs. */
9718 if (h->dynindx == -1)
9719 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9720 }
9721 else
9722 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9723 }
9724
9725 /* Finally, allocate space. */
9726 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9727 {
9728 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9729 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9730 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
9731 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9732 }
9733 }
9734
9735 /* We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
9736 a) is dynamic, or
9737 b) is an ifunc, or
9738 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
9739 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
9740 if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
9741 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
9742 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
9743 || (h->needs_plt
9744 && h->def_regular
9745 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9746 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9747 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
9748 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
9749 {
9750 struct plt_entry *pent;
9751 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
9752 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9753 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0)
9754 {
9755 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9756 || h->dynindx == -1)
9757 {
9758 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9759 {
9760 s = htab->elf.iplt;
9761 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9762 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9763 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
9764 }
9765 else
9766 {
9767 s = htab->pltlocal;
9768 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9769 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9770 s = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9771 }
9772 }
9773 else
9774 {
9775 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
9776 first entry. */
9777 s = htab->elf.splt;
9778 if (s->size == 0)
9779 s->size += PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9780
9781 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9782
9783 /* Make room for this entry. */
9784 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9785
9786 /* Make room for the .glink code. */
9787 s = htab->glink;
9788 if (s->size == 0)
9789 s->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab);
9790 if (htab->opd_abi)
9791 {
9792 /* We need bigger stubs past index 32767. */
9793 if (s->size >= GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + 32768*2*4)
9794 s->size += 4;
9795 s->size += 2*4;
9796 }
9797 else
9798 s->size += 4;
9799
9800 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9801 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9802 }
9803 if (s != NULL)
9804 s->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9805 doneone = TRUE;
9806 }
9807 else
9808 pent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9809 if (!doneone)
9810 {
9811 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9812 h->needs_plt = 0;
9813 }
9814 }
9815 else
9816 {
9817 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9818 h->needs_plt = 0;
9819 }
9820
9821 return TRUE;
9822 }
9823
9824 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
9825 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
9826 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
9827 #define D34(v) \
9828 ((((v) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) << 16) | (v & 0xffff))
9829 #define HA34(v) ((v + (1ULL << 33)) >> 34)
9830
9831 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
9832 to set up space for global entry stubs. These are put in glink,
9833 after the branch table. */
9834
9835 static bfd_boolean
9836 size_global_entry_stubs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9837 {
9838 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9839 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9840 struct plt_entry *pent;
9841 asection *s, *plt;
9842
9843 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9844 return TRUE;
9845
9846 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9847 return TRUE;
9848
9849 if (h->def_regular)
9850 return TRUE;
9851
9852 info = inf;
9853 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9854 if (htab == NULL)
9855 return FALSE;
9856
9857 s = htab->global_entry;
9858 plt = htab->elf.splt;
9859 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9860 if (pent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
9861 && pent->addend == 0)
9862 {
9863 /* For ELFv2, if this symbol is not defined in a regular file
9864 and we are not generating a shared library or pie, then we
9865 need to define the symbol in the executable on a call stub.
9866 This is to avoid text relocations. */
9867 bfd_vma off, stub_align, stub_off, stub_size;
9868 unsigned int align_power;
9869
9870 stub_size = 16;
9871 stub_off = s->size;
9872 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
9873 align_power = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9874 else
9875 align_power = -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9876 /* Setting section alignment is delayed until we know it is
9877 non-empty. Otherwise the .text output section will be
9878 aligned at least to plt_stub_align even when no global
9879 entry stubs are needed. */
9880 if (s->alignment_power < align_power)
9881 s->alignment_power = align_power;
9882 stub_align = (bfd_vma) 1 << align_power;
9883 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0
9884 || ((((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)
9885 - (stub_off & -stub_align))
9886 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)))
9887 stub_off = (stub_off + stub_align - 1) & -stub_align;
9888 off = pent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
9889 off -= stub_off + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
9890 /* Note that for --plt-stub-align negative we have a possible
9891 dependency between stub offset and size. Break that
9892 dependency by assuming the max stub size when calculating
9893 the stub offset. */
9894 if (PPC_HA (off) == 0)
9895 stub_size -= 4;
9896 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
9897 h->root.u.def.section = s;
9898 h->root.u.def.value = stub_off;
9899 s->size = stub_off + stub_size;
9900 break;
9901 }
9902 return TRUE;
9903 }
9904
9905 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9906
9907 static bfd_boolean
9908 ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9909 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9910 {
9911 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9912 bfd *dynobj;
9913 asection *s;
9914 bfd_boolean relocs;
9915 bfd *ibfd;
9916 struct got_entry *first_tlsld;
9917
9918 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9919 if (htab == NULL)
9920 return FALSE;
9921
9922 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9923 if (dynobj == NULL)
9924 abort ();
9925
9926 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9927 {
9928 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9929 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9930 {
9931 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9932 if (s == NULL)
9933 abort ();
9934 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9935 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9936 }
9937 }
9938
9939 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
9940 relocs. */
9941 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9942 {
9943 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
9944 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
9945 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
9946 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
9947 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
9948 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9949 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9950
9951 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9952 continue;
9953
9954 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9955 {
9956 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
9957
9958 for (p = elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9959 {
9960 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
9961 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
9962 {
9963 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
9964 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
9965 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
9966 the relocs too. */
9967 }
9968 else if (p->count != 0)
9969 {
9970 asection *srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9971 if (p->ifunc)
9972 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
9973 srel->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9974 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9975 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9976 }
9977 }
9978 }
9979
9980 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9981 if (!lgot_ents)
9982 continue;
9983
9984 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9985 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9986 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
9987 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
9988 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9989 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9990 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9991 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
9992 {
9993 struct got_entry **pent, *ent;
9994
9995 pent = lgot_ents;
9996 while ((ent = *pent) != NULL)
9997 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
9998 {
9999 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_LD) != 0)
10000 {
10001 ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd)->got.refcount += 1;
10002 *pent = ent->next;
10003 }
10004 else
10005 {
10006 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
10007 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10008
10009 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10010 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
10011 {
10012 ent_size *= 2;
10013 rel_size *= 2;
10014 }
10015 s->size += ent_size;
10016 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10017 {
10018 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
10019 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
10020 }
10021 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
10022 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
10023 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
10024 {
10025 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10026 srel->size += rel_size;
10027 }
10028 pent = &ent->next;
10029 }
10030 }
10031 else
10032 *pent = ent->next;
10033 }
10034
10035 /* Allocate space for plt calls to local syms. */
10036 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
10037 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
10038 {
10039 struct plt_entry *ent;
10040
10041 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10042 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
10043 {
10044 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10045 {
10046 s = htab->elf.iplt;
10047 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10048 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10049 htab->elf.irelplt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10050 }
10051 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
10052 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
10053 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10054 else
10055 {
10056 s = htab->pltlocal;
10057 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10058 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10059 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10060 htab->relpltlocal->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10061 }
10062 }
10063 else
10064 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10065 }
10066 }
10067
10068 /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
10069 sym dynamic relocs. */
10070 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
10071
10072 if (!htab->opd_abi && !bfd_link_pic (info))
10073 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, size_global_entry_stubs, info);
10074
10075 first_tlsld = NULL;
10076 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10077 {
10078 struct got_entry *ent;
10079
10080 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10081 continue;
10082
10083 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
10084 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
10085 {
10086 if (!htab->do_multi_toc && first_tlsld != NULL)
10087 {
10088 ent->is_indirect = TRUE;
10089 ent->got.ent = first_tlsld;
10090 }
10091 else
10092 {
10093 if (first_tlsld == NULL)
10094 first_tlsld = ent;
10095 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10096 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10097 ent->owner = ibfd;
10098 s->size += 16;
10099 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
10100 {
10101 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10102 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10103 }
10104 }
10105 }
10106 else
10107 ent->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10108 }
10109
10110 /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
10111 Allocate memory for them. */
10112 relocs = FALSE;
10113 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10114 {
10115 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
10116 continue;
10117
10118 if (s == htab->brlt || s == htab->relbrlt)
10119 /* These haven't been allocated yet; don't strip. */
10120 continue;
10121 else if (s == htab->elf.sgot
10122 || s == htab->elf.splt
10123 || s == htab->elf.iplt
10124 || s == htab->pltlocal
10125 || s == htab->glink
10126 || s == htab->global_entry
10127 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
10128 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
10129 {
10130 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
10131 comment below. */
10132 }
10133 else if (s == htab->glink_eh_frame)
10134 {
10135 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10136 /* Not sized yet. */
10137 continue;
10138 }
10139 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".rela"))
10140 {
10141 if (s->size != 0)
10142 {
10143 if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
10144 relocs = TRUE;
10145
10146 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
10147 to copy relocs into the output file. */
10148 s->reloc_count = 0;
10149 }
10150 }
10151 else
10152 {
10153 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
10154 continue;
10155 }
10156
10157 if (s->size == 0)
10158 {
10159 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
10160 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
10161 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
10162 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
10163 before the linker maps input sections to output
10164 sections. The linker does that before
10165 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
10166 function which decides whether anything needs to go
10167 into these sections. */
10168 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10169 continue;
10170 }
10171
10172 if (bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10173 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: discarding dynamic section %s"),
10174 s->name);
10175
10176 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
10177 continue;
10178
10179 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. We use bfd_zalloc
10180 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
10181 section's contents are written out. This should not happen,
10182 but this way if it does we get a R_PPC64_NONE reloc in .rela
10183 sections instead of garbage.
10184 We also rely on the section contents being zero when writing
10185 the GOT and .dynrelro. */
10186 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
10187 if (s->contents == NULL)
10188 return FALSE;
10189 }
10190
10191 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10192 {
10193 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10194 continue;
10195
10196 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10197 if (s != NULL && s != htab->elf.sgot)
10198 {
10199 if (s->size == 0)
10200 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10201 else
10202 {
10203 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10204 if (s->contents == NULL)
10205 return FALSE;
10206 }
10207 }
10208 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10209 if (s != NULL)
10210 {
10211 if (s->size == 0)
10212 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10213 else
10214 {
10215 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10216 if (s->contents == NULL)
10217 return FALSE;
10218 relocs = TRUE;
10219 s->reloc_count = 0;
10220 }
10221 }
10222 }
10223
10224 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10225 {
10226 bfd_boolean tls_opt;
10227
10228 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
10229 values later, in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
10230 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
10231 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
10232 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
10233 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
10234 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
10235
10236 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
10237 {
10238 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
10239 return FALSE;
10240 }
10241
10242 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
10243 {
10244 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
10245 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
10246 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
10247 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0)
10248 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_GLINK, 0))
10249 return FALSE;
10250 }
10251
10252 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && abiversion (output_bfd) <= 1)
10253 {
10254 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPD, 0)
10255 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPDSZ, 0))
10256 return FALSE;
10257 }
10258
10259 tls_opt = (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
10260 && ((htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
10261 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
10262 || (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
10263 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)));
10264 if (tls_opt || !htab->opd_abi)
10265 {
10266 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPT, tls_opt ? PPC64_OPT_TLS : 0))
10267 return FALSE;
10268 }
10269
10270 if (relocs)
10271 {
10272 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
10273 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
10274 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)))
10275 return FALSE;
10276
10277 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
10278 then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
10279 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
10280 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf,
10281 _bfd_elf_maybe_set_textrel, info);
10282
10283 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
10284 {
10285 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
10286 return FALSE;
10287 }
10288 }
10289 }
10290 #undef add_dynamic_entry
10291
10292 return TRUE;
10293 }
10294
10295 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
10296
10297 static bfd_boolean
10298 ppc64_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
10299 {
10300 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10301 && !h->def_regular
10302 && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
10303 return FALSE;
10304
10305 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
10306 }
10307
10308 /* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call. */
10309
10310 static inline enum ppc_stub_type
10311 ppc_type_of_stub (asection *input_sec,
10312 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10313 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **hash,
10314 struct plt_entry **plt_ent,
10315 bfd_vma destination,
10316 unsigned long local_off)
10317 {
10318 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h = *hash;
10319 bfd_vma location;
10320 bfd_vma branch_offset;
10321 bfd_vma max_branch_offset;
10322 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
10323
10324 if (h != NULL)
10325 {
10326 struct plt_entry *ent;
10327 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = h;
10328 if (h->oh != NULL
10329 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
10330 {
10331 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10332 *hash = fdh;
10333 }
10334
10335 for (ent = fdh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10336 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10337 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10338 {
10339 *plt_ent = ent;
10340 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10341 }
10342
10343 /* Here, we know we don't have a plt entry. If we don't have a
10344 either a defined function descriptor or a defined entry symbol
10345 in a regular object file, then it is pointless trying to make
10346 any other type of stub. */
10347 if (!is_static_defined (&fdh->elf)
10348 && !is_static_defined (&h->elf))
10349 return ppc_stub_none;
10350 }
10351 else if (elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) != NULL)
10352 {
10353 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_sec->owner);
10354 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
10355 elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10356 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10357
10358 if (local_plt[r_symndx] != NULL)
10359 {
10360 struct plt_entry *ent;
10361
10362 for (ent = local_plt[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10363 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10364 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10365 {
10366 *plt_ent = ent;
10367 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10368 }
10369 }
10370 }
10371
10372 /* Determine where the call point is. */
10373 location = (input_sec->output_offset
10374 + input_sec->output_section->vma
10375 + rel->r_offset);
10376
10377 branch_offset = destination - location;
10378 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10379
10380 /* Determine if a long branch stub is needed. */
10381 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
10382 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
10383 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
10384 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
10385 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
10386
10387 if (branch_offset + max_branch_offset >= 2 * max_branch_offset - local_off)
10388 /* We need a stub. Figure out whether a long_branch or plt_branch
10389 is needed later. */
10390 return ppc_stub_long_branch;
10391
10392 return ppc_stub_none;
10393 }
10394
10395 /* Gets the address of a label (1:) in r11 and builds an offset in r12,
10396 then adds it to r11 (LOAD false) or loads r12 from r11+r12 (LOAD true).
10397 . mflr %r12
10398 . bcl 20,31,1f
10399 .1: mflr %r11
10400 . mtlr %r12
10401 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
10402 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
10403 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
10404 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
10405 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
10406 . add/ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
10407
10408 static bfd_byte *
10409 build_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, bfd_boolean load)
10410 {
10411 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R12, p);
10412 p += 4;
10413 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10414 p += 4;
10415 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R11, p);
10416 p += 4;
10417 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R12, p);
10418 p += 4;
10419 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10420 {
10421 if (load)
10422 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10423 else
10424 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10425 p += 4;
10426 }
10427 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10428 {
10429 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDIS_R12_R11 + PPC_HA (off), p);
10430 p += 4;
10431 if (load)
10432 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10433 else
10434 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10435 p += 4;
10436 }
10437 else
10438 {
10439 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10440 {
10441 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10442 p += 4;
10443 }
10444 else
10445 {
10446 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R12 + ((off >> 48) & 0xffff), p);
10447 p += 4;
10448 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10449 {
10450 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10451 p += 4;
10452 }
10453 }
10454 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10455 {
10456 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R12_R12_32, p);
10457 p += 4;
10458 }
10459 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10460 {
10461 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORIS_R12_R12_0 + PPC_HI (off), p);
10462 p += 4;
10463 }
10464 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10465 {
10466 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10467 p += 4;
10468 }
10469 if (load)
10470 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10471 else
10472 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10473 p += 4;
10474 }
10475 return p;
10476 }
10477
10478 static unsigned int
10479 size_offset (bfd_vma off)
10480 {
10481 unsigned int size;
10482 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10483 size = 4;
10484 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10485 size = 8;
10486 else
10487 {
10488 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10489 size = 4;
10490 else
10491 {
10492 size = 4;
10493 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10494 size += 4;
10495 }
10496 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10497 size += 4;
10498 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10499 size += 4;
10500 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10501 size += 4;
10502 size += 4;
10503 }
10504 return size + 16;
10505 }
10506
10507 static unsigned int
10508 num_relocs_for_offset (bfd_vma off)
10509 {
10510 unsigned int num_rel;
10511 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10512 num_rel = 1;
10513 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10514 num_rel = 2;
10515 else
10516 {
10517 num_rel = 1;
10518 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL >= 0x1000000000000ULL
10519 && ((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10520 num_rel += 1;
10521 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10522 num_rel += 1;
10523 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10524 num_rel += 1;
10525 }
10526 return num_rel;
10527 }
10528
10529 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10530 emit_relocs_for_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info, Elf_Internal_Rela *r,
10531 bfd_vma roff, bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off)
10532 {
10533 bfd_vma relative_targ = targ - (roff - 8);
10534 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10535 roff += 2;
10536 r->r_offset = roff;
10537 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10538 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10539 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16);
10540 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10541 {
10542 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HA);
10543 ++r;
10544 roff += 4;
10545 r->r_offset = roff;
10546 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10547 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10548 }
10549 else
10550 {
10551 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10552 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10553 else
10554 {
10555 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST);
10556 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10557 {
10558 ++r;
10559 roff += 4;
10560 r->r_offset = roff;
10561 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10562 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10563 }
10564 }
10565 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10566 roff += 4;
10567 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10568 {
10569 ++r;
10570 roff += 4;
10571 r->r_offset = roff;
10572 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH);
10573 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10574 }
10575 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10576 {
10577 ++r;
10578 roff += 4;
10579 r->r_offset = roff;
10580 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10581 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10582 }
10583 }
10584 return r;
10585 }
10586
10587 static bfd_byte *
10588 build_power10_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, int odd,
10589 bfd_boolean load)
10590 {
10591 uint64_t insn;
10592 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10593 {
10594 off -= odd;
10595 if (odd)
10596 {
10597 bfd_put_32 (abfd, NOP, p);
10598 p += 4;
10599 }
10600 if (load)
10601 insn = PLD_R12_PC;
10602 else
10603 insn = PADDI_R12_PC;
10604 insn |= D34 (off);
10605 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10606 p += 4;
10607 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10608 }
10609 /* The minimum value for paddi is -0x200000000. The minimum value
10610 for li is -0x8000, which when shifted by 34 and added gives a
10611 minimum value of -0x2000200000000. The maximum value is
10612 0x1ffffffff+0x7fff<<34 which is 0x2000200000000-1. */
10613 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10614 {
10615 off -= 8 - odd;
10616 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10617 p += 4;
10618 if (!odd)
10619 {
10620 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10621 p += 4;
10622 }
10623 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10624 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10625 p += 4;
10626 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10627 p += 4;
10628 if (odd)
10629 {
10630 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10631 p += 4;
10632 }
10633 if (load)
10634 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10635 else
10636 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10637 }
10638 else
10639 {
10640 off -= odd + 8;
10641 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R11 | ((HA34 (off) >> 16) & 0x3fff), p);
10642 p += 4;
10643 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R11_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10644 p += 4;
10645 if (odd)
10646 {
10647 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10648 p += 4;
10649 }
10650 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10651 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10652 p += 4;
10653 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10654 p += 4;
10655 if (!odd)
10656 {
10657 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10658 p += 4;
10659 }
10660 if (load)
10661 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10662 else
10663 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10664 }
10665 p += 4;
10666 return p;
10667 }
10668
10669 static unsigned int
10670 size_power10_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10671 {
10672 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10673 return odd + 8;
10674 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10675 return 20;
10676 else
10677 return 24;
10678 }
10679
10680 static unsigned int
10681 num_relocs_for_power10_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10682 {
10683 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10684 return 1;
10685 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10686 return 2;
10687 else
10688 return 3;
10689 }
10690
10691 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10692 emit_relocs_for_power10_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10693 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, bfd_vma roff,
10694 bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off, int odd)
10695 {
10696 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10697 roff += odd;
10698 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10699 {
10700 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10701 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10702 r->r_addend = targ + 8 - odd - d_offset;
10703 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10704 ++r;
10705 roff += 8 - odd;
10706 }
10707 else
10708 {
10709 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10710 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10711 r->r_addend = targ + 8 + odd - d_offset;
10712 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34);
10713 ++r;
10714 roff += 4;
10715 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10716 r->r_addend = targ + 4 + odd - d_offset;
10717 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10718 ++r;
10719 roff += 4 + odd;
10720 }
10721 r->r_offset = roff;
10722 r->r_addend = targ;
10723 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL34);
10724 return r;
10725 }
10726
10727 /* Emit .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10728
10729 static bfd_byte *
10730 eh_advance (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *eh, unsigned int delta)
10731 {
10732 delta /= 4;
10733 if (delta < 64)
10734 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + delta;
10735 else if (delta < 256)
10736 {
10737 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
10738 *eh++ = delta;
10739 }
10740 else if (delta < 65536)
10741 {
10742 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
10743 bfd_put_16 (abfd, delta, eh);
10744 eh += 2;
10745 }
10746 else
10747 {
10748 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
10749 bfd_put_32 (abfd, delta, eh);
10750 eh += 4;
10751 }
10752 return eh;
10753 }
10754
10755 /* Size of required .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10756
10757 static unsigned int
10758 eh_advance_size (unsigned int delta)
10759 {
10760 if (delta < 64 * 4)
10761 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc+[1..63]. */
10762 return 1;
10763 if (delta < 256 * 4)
10764 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc1, byte. */
10765 return 2;
10766 if (delta < 65536 * 4)
10767 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc2, 2 bytes. */
10768 return 3;
10769 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc4, 4 bytes. */
10770 return 5;
10771 }
10772
10773 /* With power7 weakly ordered memory model, it is possible for ld.so
10774 to update a plt entry in one thread and have another thread see a
10775 stale zero toc entry. To avoid this we need some sort of acquire
10776 barrier in the call stub. One solution is to make the load of the
10777 toc word seem to appear to depend on the load of the function entry
10778 word. Another solution is to test for r2 being zero, and branch to
10779 the appropriate glink entry if so.
10780
10781 . fake dep barrier compare
10782 . ld 12,xxx(2) ld 12,xxx(2)
10783 . mtctr 12 mtctr 12
10784 . xor 11,12,12 ld 2,xxx+8(2)
10785 . add 2,2,11 cmpldi 2,0
10786 . ld 2,xxx+8(2) bnectr+
10787 . bctr b <glink_entry>
10788
10789 The solution involving the compare turns out to be faster, so
10790 that's what we use unless the branch won't reach. */
10791
10792 #define ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP 0
10793 #define ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE 0
10794
10795 static inline unsigned int
10796 plt_stub_size (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10797 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10798 bfd_vma off)
10799 {
10800 unsigned size;
10801
10802 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10803 {
10804 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
10805 {
10806 bfd_vma start = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10807 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10808 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10809 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10810 start += 4;
10811 size = 8 + size_power10_offset (off, start & 4);
10812 }
10813 else
10814 size = 8 + size_offset (off - 8);
10815 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10816 size += 4;
10817 return size;
10818 }
10819
10820 size = 12;
10821 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10822 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10823 size += 4;
10824 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10825 size += 4;
10826 if (htab->opd_abi)
10827 {
10828 size += 4;
10829 if (htab->params->plt_static_chain)
10830 size += 4;
10831 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10832 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10833 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10834 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1)
10835 size += 8;
10836 if (PPC_HA (off + 8 + 8 * htab->params->plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (off))
10837 size += 4;
10838 }
10839 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10840 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
10841 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
10842 {
10843 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
10844 {
10845 size += 7 * 4;
10846 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10847 size += 6 * 4;
10848 }
10849 else
10850 {
10851 size += 30 * 4;
10852 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10853 size += 4;
10854 }
10855 }
10856 return size;
10857 }
10858
10859 /* Depending on the sign of plt_stub_align:
10860 If positive, return the padding to align to a 2**plt_stub_align
10861 boundary.
10862 If negative, if this stub would cross fewer 2**plt_stub_align
10863 boundaries if we align, then return the padding needed to do so. */
10864
10865 static inline unsigned int
10866 plt_stub_pad (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10867 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10868 bfd_vma plt_off)
10869 {
10870 int stub_align;
10871 unsigned stub_size;
10872 bfd_vma stub_off = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10873
10874 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
10875 {
10876 stub_align = 1 << htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10877 if ((stub_off & (stub_align - 1)) != 0)
10878 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10879 return 0;
10880 }
10881
10882 stub_align = 1 << -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10883 stub_size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, plt_off);
10884 if (((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align) - (stub_off & -stub_align)
10885 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align))
10886 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10887 return 0;
10888 }
10889
10890 /* Build a .plt call stub. */
10891
10892 static inline bfd_byte *
10893 build_plt_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10894 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10895 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
10896 {
10897 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
10898 bfd_boolean plt_load_toc = htab->opd_abi;
10899 bfd_boolean plt_static_chain = htab->params->plt_static_chain;
10900 bfd_boolean plt_thread_safe = (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10901 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10902 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10903 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1);
10904 bfd_boolean use_fake_dep = plt_thread_safe;
10905 bfd_vma cmp_branch_off = 0;
10906
10907 if (!ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP
10908 && plt_load_toc
10909 && plt_thread_safe
10910 && !(is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
10911 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt))
10912 {
10913 bfd_vma pltoff = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10914 bfd_vma pltindex = ((pltoff - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
10915 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab));
10916 bfd_vma glinkoff = GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + pltindex * 8;
10917 bfd_vma to, from;
10918
10919 if (pltindex > 32768)
10920 glinkoff += (pltindex - 32768) * 4;
10921 to = (glinkoff
10922 + htab->glink->output_offset
10923 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
10924 from = (p - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents
10925 + 4 * (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10926 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10927 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10928 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain)
10929 != PPC_HA (offset))
10930 + 4 * (plt_static_chain != 0)
10931 + 20
10932 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10933 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10934 cmp_branch_off = to - from;
10935 use_fake_dep = cmp_branch_off + (1 << 25) >= (1 << 26);
10936 }
10937
10938 if (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10939 {
10940 if (r != NULL)
10941 {
10942 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10943 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10944 r[0].r_offset += 4;
10945 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
10946 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
10947 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10948 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10949 if (plt_load_toc)
10950 {
10951 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10952 {
10953 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
10954 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO);
10955 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10956 }
10957 else
10958 {
10959 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
10960 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10961 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
10962 if (plt_static_chain)
10963 {
10964 r[3].r_offset = r[2].r_offset + 4;
10965 r[3].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10966 r[3].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 16;
10967 }
10968 }
10969 }
10970 }
10971 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10972 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10973 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
10974 if (plt_load_toc)
10975 {
10976 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R11_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10977 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10978 }
10979 else
10980 {
10981 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10982 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10983 }
10984 if (plt_load_toc
10985 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10986 {
10987 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R11_R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10988 offset = 0;
10989 }
10990 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
10991 if (plt_load_toc)
10992 {
10993 if (use_fake_dep)
10994 {
10995 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R2_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
10996 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R11_R11_R2, p), p += 4;
10997 }
10998 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
10999 if (plt_static_chain)
11000 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11001 }
11002 }
11003 else
11004 {
11005 if (r != NULL)
11006 {
11007 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11008 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11009 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11010 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11011 if (plt_load_toc)
11012 {
11013 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11014 {
11015 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11016 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16);
11017 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11018 }
11019 else
11020 {
11021 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
11022 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11023 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain;
11024 if (plt_static_chain)
11025 {
11026 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
11027 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11028 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
11029 }
11030 }
11031 }
11032 }
11033 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11034 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11035 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
11036 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11037 if (plt_load_toc
11038 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11039 {
11040 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11041 offset = 0;
11042 }
11043 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
11044 if (plt_load_toc)
11045 {
11046 if (use_fake_dep)
11047 {
11048 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R11_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
11049 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R2_R2_R11, p), p += 4;
11050 }
11051 if (plt_static_chain)
11052 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11053 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
11054 }
11055 }
11056 if (plt_load_toc && plt_thread_safe && !use_fake_dep)
11057 {
11058 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPLDI_R2_0, p), p += 4;
11059 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BNECTR_P4, p), p += 4;
11060 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (cmp_branch_off & 0x3fffffc), p), p += 4;
11061 }
11062 else
11063 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p), p += 4;
11064 return p;
11065 }
11066
11067 /* Build a special .plt call stub for __tls_get_addr. */
11068
11069 #define LD_R0_0R3 0xe8030000
11070 #define LD_R12_0R3 0xe9830000
11071 #define MR_R0_R3 0x7c601b78
11072 #define CMPDI_R0_0 0x2c200000
11073 #define ADD_R3_R12_R13 0x7c6c6a14
11074 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
11075 #define MR_R3_R0 0x7c030378
11076 #define BCTRL 0x4e800421
11077
11078 static inline bfd_byte *
11079 build_tls_get_addr_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11080 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11081 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
11082 {
11083 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11084 bfd_byte *loc = p;
11085 unsigned int i;
11086
11087 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R3 + 0, p), p += 4;
11088 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R3 + 8, p), p += 4;
11089 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPDI_R0_0, p), p += 4;
11090 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R0_R3, p), p += 4;
11091 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R3_R12_R13, p), p += 4;
11092 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BEQLR, p), p += 4;
11093 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R3_R0, p), p += 4;
11094 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11095 {
11096 if (r != NULL)
11097 r[0].r_offset += 7 * 4;
11098 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11099 return build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11100
11101 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
11102 p += 4;
11103 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11104 p += 4;
11105
11106 if (r != NULL)
11107 r[0].r_offset += 2 * 4;
11108 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11109 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11110
11111 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11112 p += 4;
11113 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11114 p += 4;
11115 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
11116 p += 4;
11117 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
11118 p += 4;
11119 }
11120 else
11121 {
11122 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (obfd, p, htab);
11123
11124 if (r != NULL)
11125 r[0].r_offset += 18 * 4;
11126
11127 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11128 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11129
11130 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11131 {
11132 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11133 p += 4;
11134 }
11135
11136 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (obfd, p, htab);
11137 }
11138
11139 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11140 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11141 {
11142 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11143
11144 base = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17;
11145 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11146 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11147 {
11148 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11149 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - 20 - loc);
11150 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11151 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 16;
11152 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11153 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11154 *eh++ = 65;
11155 *eh++ = -(STK_LINKER (htab) / 8) & 0x7f;
11156 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
11157 }
11158 else
11159 {
11160 unsigned int cfa_updt, delta;
11161 /* After the bctrl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
11162 .eh_frame info saying the return address is on the stack. In
11163 fact we must put the EH info at or before the call rather
11164 than after it, because the EH info for a call needs to be
11165 specified by that point.
11166 See libgcc/unwind-dw2.c execute_cfa_program.
11167 Any stack pointer update must be described immediately after
11168 the instruction making the change, and since the stdu occurs
11169 after saving regs we put all the reg saves and the cfa
11170 change there. */
11171 cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
11172 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11173 stub_entry->group->lr_restore
11174 = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc) - 4;
11175 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11176 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11177 if (htab->opd_abi)
11178 {
11179 *eh++ = 128;
11180 *eh++ = 1;
11181 }
11182 else
11183 *eh++ = 96;
11184 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11185 *eh++ = 65;
11186 *eh++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
11187 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11188 {
11189 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
11190 *eh++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
11191 }
11192 *eh++ = (DW_CFA_advance_loc
11193 + (stub_entry->group->lr_restore - 8 - cfa_updt) / 4);
11194 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11195 *eh++ = 0;
11196 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11197 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
11198 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11199 }
11200 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11201 *eh++ = 65;
11202 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11203 }
11204 return p;
11205 }
11206
11207 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
11208 get_relocs (asection *sec, int count)
11209 {
11210 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
11211 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elfsec_data;
11212
11213 elfsec_data = elf_section_data (sec);
11214 relocs = elfsec_data->relocs;
11215 if (relocs == NULL)
11216 {
11217 bfd_size_type relsize;
11218 relsize = sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*relocs);
11219 relocs = bfd_alloc (sec->owner, relsize);
11220 if (relocs == NULL)
11221 return NULL;
11222 elfsec_data->relocs = relocs;
11223 elfsec_data->rela.hdr = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner,
11224 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
11225 if (elfsec_data->rela.hdr == NULL)
11226 return NULL;
11227 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_size = (sec->reloc_count
11228 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11229 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11230 sec->reloc_count = 0;
11231 }
11232 relocs += sec->reloc_count;
11233 sec->reloc_count += count;
11234 return relocs;
11235 }
11236
11237 /* Convert the relocs R[0] thru R[-NUM_REL+1], which are all no-symbol
11238 forms, to the equivalent relocs against the global symbol given by
11239 STUB_ENTRY->H. */
11240
11241 static bfd_boolean
11242 use_global_in_relocs (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11243 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11244 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, unsigned int num_rel)
11245 {
11246 struct elf_link_hash_entry **hashes;
11247 unsigned long symndx;
11248 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
11249 bfd_vma symval;
11250
11251 /* Relocs are always against symbols in their own object file. Fake
11252 up global sym hashes for the stub bfd (which has no symbols). */
11253 hashes = elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd);
11254 if (hashes == NULL)
11255 {
11256 bfd_size_type hsize;
11257
11258 /* When called the first time, stub_globals will contain the
11259 total number of symbols seen during stub sizing. After
11260 allocating, stub_globals is used as an index to fill the
11261 hashes array. */
11262 hsize = (htab->stub_globals + 1) * sizeof (*hashes);
11263 hashes = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, hsize);
11264 if (hashes == NULL)
11265 return FALSE;
11266 elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd) = hashes;
11267 htab->stub_globals = 1;
11268 }
11269 symndx = htab->stub_globals++;
11270 h = stub_entry->h;
11271 hashes[symndx] = &h->elf;
11272 if (h->oh != NULL && h->oh->is_func)
11273 h = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
11274 BFD_ASSERT (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11275 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
11276 symval = defined_sym_val (&h->elf);
11277 while (num_rel-- != 0)
11278 {
11279 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (symndx, ELF64_R_TYPE (r->r_info));
11280 if (h->elf.root.u.def.section != stub_entry->target_section)
11281 {
11282 /* H is an opd symbol. The addend must be zero, and the
11283 branch reloc is the only one we can convert. */
11284 r->r_addend = 0;
11285 break;
11286 }
11287 else
11288 r->r_addend -= symval;
11289 --r;
11290 }
11291 return TRUE;
11292 }
11293
11294 static bfd_vma
11295 get_r2off (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11296 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry)
11297 {
11298 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11299 bfd_vma r2off = htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off;
11300
11301 if (r2off == 0)
11302 {
11303 /* Support linking -R objects. Get the toc pointer from the
11304 opd entry. */
11305 char buf[8];
11306 if (!htab->opd_abi)
11307 return r2off;
11308 asection *opd = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section;
11309 bfd_vma opd_off = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.value;
11310
11311 if (strcmp (opd->name, ".opd") != 0
11312 || opd->reloc_count != 0)
11313 {
11314 info->callbacks->einfo
11315 (_("%P: cannot find opd entry toc for `%pT'\n"),
11316 stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string);
11317 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11318 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11319 }
11320 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (opd->owner, opd, buf, opd_off + 8, 8))
11321 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11322 r2off = bfd_get_64 (opd->owner, buf);
11323 r2off -= elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11324 }
11325 r2off -= htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off;
11326 return r2off;
11327 }
11328
11329 static bfd_boolean
11330 ppc_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11331 {
11332 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11333 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11334 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11335 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11336 bfd_byte *loc;
11337 bfd_byte *p, *relp;
11338 bfd_vma targ, off;
11339 Elf_Internal_Rela *r;
11340 asection *plt;
11341 int num_rel;
11342 int odd;
11343
11344 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11345 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11346 info = in_arg;
11347
11348 /* Fail if the target section could not be assigned to an output
11349 section. The user should fix his linker script. */
11350 if (stub_entry->target_section != NULL
11351 && stub_entry->target_section->output_section == NULL
11352 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11353 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign '%pA' to an output section. "
11354 "Retry without --enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11355 stub_entry->target_section);
11356
11357 /* Same for the group. */
11358 if (stub_entry->group->stub_sec != NULL
11359 && stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section == NULL
11360 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11361 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign group %pA target %pA to an "
11362 "output section. Retry without "
11363 "--enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11364 stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11365 stub_entry->target_section);
11366
11367 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11368 if (htab == NULL)
11369 return FALSE;
11370
11371 BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->stub_offset >= stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size);
11372 loc = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
11373
11374 htab->stub_count[stub_entry->stub_type - 1] += 1;
11375 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11376 {
11377 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11378 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11379 /* Branches are relative. This is where we are going to. */
11380 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11381 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11382 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11383 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11384
11385 /* And this is where we are coming from. */
11386 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11387 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11388 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11389 off = targ - off;
11390
11391 p = loc;
11392 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11393 {
11394 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11395
11396 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11397 {
11398 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11399 return FALSE;
11400 }
11401 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11402 p += 4;
11403 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11404 {
11405 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11406 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11407 p += 4;
11408 }
11409 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11410 {
11411 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11412 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11413 p += 4;
11414 }
11415 off -= p - loc;
11416 }
11417 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, B_DOT | (off & 0x3fffffc), p);
11418 p += 4;
11419
11420 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11421 {
11422 _bfd_error_handler
11423 (_("long branch stub `%s' offset overflow"),
11424 stub_entry->root.string);
11425 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11426 return FALSE;
11427 }
11428
11429 if (info->emitrelocations)
11430 {
11431 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1);
11432 if (r == NULL)
11433 return FALSE;
11434 r->r_offset = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11435 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11436 r->r_addend = targ;
11437 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11438 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, 1))
11439 return FALSE;
11440 }
11441 break;
11442
11443 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11444 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11445 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11446 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11447 FALSE, FALSE);
11448 if (br_entry == NULL)
11449 {
11450 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't find branch stub `%s'"),
11451 stub_entry->root.string);
11452 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11453 return FALSE;
11454 }
11455
11456 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11457 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11458 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11459 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11460 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11461
11462 bfd_put_64 (htab->brlt->owner, targ,
11463 htab->brlt->contents + br_entry->offset);
11464
11465 if (br_entry->iter == htab->stub_iteration)
11466 {
11467 br_entry->iter = 0;
11468
11469 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11470 {
11471 /* Create a reloc for the branch lookup table entry. */
11472 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11473 bfd_byte *rl;
11474
11475 rela.r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11476 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11477 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11478 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11479 rela.r_addend = targ;
11480
11481 rl = htab->relbrlt->contents;
11482 rl += (htab->relbrlt->reloc_count++
11483 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11484 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (htab->relbrlt->owner, &rela, rl);
11485 }
11486 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11487 {
11488 r = get_relocs (htab->brlt, 1);
11489 if (r == NULL)
11490 return FALSE;
11491 /* brlt, being SEC_LINKER_CREATED does not go through the
11492 normal reloc processing. Symbols and offsets are not
11493 translated from input file to output file form, so
11494 set up the offset per the output file. */
11495 r->r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11496 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11497 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11498 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11499 r->r_addend = targ;
11500 }
11501 }
11502
11503 targ = (br_entry->offset
11504 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11505 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11506
11507 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11508 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11509 off = targ - off;
11510
11511 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11512 {
11513 info->callbacks->einfo
11514 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11515 stub_entry->root.string);
11516 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11517 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11518 return FALSE;
11519 }
11520
11521 if (info->emitrelocations)
11522 {
11523 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0));
11524 if (r == NULL)
11525 return FALSE;
11526 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11527 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11528 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11529 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11530 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11531 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11532 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11533 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11534 {
11535 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
11536 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11537 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11538 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11539 }
11540 }
11541
11542 p = loc;
11543 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11544 {
11545 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11546 {
11547 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11548 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11549 p += 4;
11550 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11551 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11552 }
11553 else
11554 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11555 LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11556 }
11557 else
11558 {
11559 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11560
11561 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11562 {
11563 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11564 return FALSE;
11565 }
11566
11567 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11568 p += 4;
11569 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11570 {
11571 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11572 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11573 p += 4;
11574 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11575 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11576 }
11577 else
11578 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11579
11580 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11581 {
11582 p += 4;
11583 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11584 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11585 }
11586 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11587 {
11588 p += 4;
11589 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11590 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11591 }
11592 }
11593 p += 4;
11594 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11595 p += 4;
11596 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11597 p += 4;
11598 break;
11599
11600 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
11601 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
11602 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
11603 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
11604 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
11605 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
11606 p = loc;
11607 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11608 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11609 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11610 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11611 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11612 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11613 {
11614 off += 4;
11615 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11616 p += 4;
11617 }
11618 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
11619 {
11620 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11621 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11622 abort ();
11623
11624 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11625 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11626 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11627 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11628 {
11629 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11630 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11631 else
11632 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11633 }
11634 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11635 }
11636 else
11637 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11638 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11639 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11640 odd = off & 4;
11641 off = targ - off;
11642
11643 relp = p;
11644 num_rel = 0;
11645 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11646 {
11647 bfd_boolean load = stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
11648 p = build_power10_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off, odd, load);
11649 }
11650 else
11651 {
11652 /* The notoc stubs calculate their target (either a PLT entry or
11653 the global entry point of a function) relative to the PC
11654 returned by the "bcl" two instructions past the start of the
11655 sequence emitted by build_offset. The offset is therefore 8
11656 less than calculated from the start of the sequence. */
11657 off -= 8;
11658 p = build_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off,
11659 stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc);
11660 }
11661
11662 if (stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11663 {
11664 bfd_vma from;
11665 num_rel = 1;
11666 from = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11667 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11668 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
11669 + (p - loc));
11670 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11671 B_DOT | ((targ - from) & 0x3fffffc), p);
11672 }
11673 else
11674 {
11675 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11676 p += 4;
11677 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11678 }
11679 p += 4;
11680
11681 if (info->emitrelocations)
11682 {
11683 bfd_vma roff = relp - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11684 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11685 num_rel += num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
11686 else
11687 {
11688 num_rel += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
11689 roff += 16;
11690 }
11691 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, num_rel);
11692 if (r == NULL)
11693 return FALSE;
11694 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
11695 r = emit_relocs_for_power10_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off, odd);
11696 else
11697 r = emit_relocs_for_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off);
11698 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
11699 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11700 {
11701 ++r;
11702 roff = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11703 r->r_offset = roff;
11704 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11705 r->r_addend = targ;
11706 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11707 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, num_rel))
11708 return FALSE;
11709 }
11710 }
11711
11712 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == 0
11713 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11714 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11715 {
11716 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11717 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11718
11719 base = (htab->glink_eh_frame->contents
11720 + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17);
11721 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11722 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
11723 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11724 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11725 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11726 lr_used += 4;
11727 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11728 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11729 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11730 *eh++ = DW_CFA_register;
11731 *eh++ = 65;
11732 *eh++ = 12;
11733 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11734 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11735 *eh++ = 65;
11736 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11737 }
11738 break;
11739
11740 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
11741 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
11742 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11743 && stub_entry->h->is_func_descriptor
11744 && stub_entry->h->oh != NULL)
11745 {
11746 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (stub_entry->h->oh);
11747
11748 /* If the old-ABI "dot-symbol" is undefined make it weak so
11749 we don't get a link error from RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL. */
11750 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
11751 && (stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11752 || stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
11753 fh->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak;
11754 }
11755
11756 /* Now build the stub. */
11757 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11758 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11759 abort ();
11760
11761 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11762 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11763 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11764 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11765 {
11766 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11767 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11768 else
11769 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11770 }
11771 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11772
11773 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11774 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11775 off = targ - off;
11776
11777 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11778 {
11779 info->callbacks->einfo
11780 /* xgettext:c-format */
11781 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11782 stub_entry->h != NULL
11783 ? stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string
11784 : "<local sym>");
11785 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11786 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11787 return FALSE;
11788 }
11789
11790 r = NULL;
11791 if (info->emitrelocations)
11792 {
11793 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11794 ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11795 + (htab->opd_abi
11796 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11797 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11798 : 1)));
11799 if (r == NULL)
11800 return FALSE;
11801 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11802 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11803 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11804 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11805 }
11806 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11807 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
11808 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
11809 p = build_tls_get_addr_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11810 else
11811 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11812 break;
11813
11814 case ppc_stub_save_res:
11815 return TRUE;
11816
11817 default:
11818 BFD_FAIL ();
11819 return FALSE;
11820 }
11821
11822 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc);
11823
11824 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
11825 {
11826 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11827 size_t len1, len2;
11828 char *name;
11829 const char *const stub_str[] = { "long_branch",
11830 "long_branch",
11831 "long_branch",
11832 "long_branch",
11833 "plt_branch",
11834 "plt_branch",
11835 "plt_branch",
11836 "plt_branch",
11837 "plt_call",
11838 "plt_call",
11839 "plt_call",
11840 "plt_call" };
11841
11842 len1 = strlen (stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1]);
11843 len2 = strlen (stub_entry->root.string);
11844 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + 2);
11845 if (name == NULL)
11846 return FALSE;
11847 memcpy (name, stub_entry->root.string, 9);
11848 memcpy (name + 9, stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1], len1);
11849 memcpy (name + len1 + 9, stub_entry->root.string + 8, len2 - 8 + 1);
11850 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
11851 if (h == NULL)
11852 return FALSE;
11853 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
11854 {
11855 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
11856 h->root.u.def.section = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
11857 h->root.u.def.value = stub_entry->stub_offset;
11858 h->ref_regular = 1;
11859 h->def_regular = 1;
11860 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
11861 h->forced_local = 1;
11862 h->non_elf = 0;
11863 h->root.linker_def = 1;
11864 }
11865 }
11866
11867 return TRUE;
11868 }
11869
11870 /* As above, but don't actually build the stub. Just bump offset so
11871 we know stub section sizes, and select plt_branch stubs where
11872 long_branch stubs won't do. */
11873
11874 static bfd_boolean
11875 ppc_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11876 {
11877 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11878 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11879 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11880 asection *plt;
11881 bfd_vma targ, off, r2off;
11882 unsigned int size, extra, lr_used, delta, odd;
11883
11884 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11885 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11886 info = in_arg;
11887
11888 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11889 if (htab == NULL)
11890 return FALSE;
11891
11892 /* Fail if the target section could not be assigned to an output
11893 section. The user should fix his linker script. */
11894 if (stub_entry->target_section != NULL
11895 && stub_entry->target_section->output_section == NULL
11896 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11897 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign %pA to an output section. "
11898 "Retry without --enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11899 stub_entry->target_section);
11900
11901 /* Same for the group. */
11902 if (stub_entry->group->stub_sec != NULL
11903 && stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section == NULL
11904 && info->non_contiguous_regions)
11905 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%F%P: Could not assign group %pA target %pA to an "
11906 "output section. Retry without "
11907 "--enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n"),
11908 stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11909 stub_entry->target_section);
11910
11911 /* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry. */
11912 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11913
11914 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11915 && stub_entry->h->save_res
11916 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11917 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
11918 {
11919 /* Don't make stubs to out-of-line register save/restore
11920 functions. Instead, emit copies of the functions. */
11921 stub_entry->group->needs_save_res = 1;
11922 stub_entry->stub_type = ppc_stub_save_res;
11923 return TRUE;
11924 }
11925
11926 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11927 {
11928 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11929 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11930 /* Reset the stub type from the plt branch variant in case we now
11931 can reach with a shorter stub. */
11932 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
11933 /* Fall through. */
11934 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11935 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11936 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11937 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11938 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11939 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11940 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11941 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11942 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11943
11944 size = 4;
11945 r2off = 0;
11946 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11947 {
11948 r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11949 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11950 {
11951 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11952 return FALSE;
11953 }
11954 size = 8;
11955 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11956 size += 4;
11957 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11958 size += 4;
11959 off += size - 4;
11960 }
11961 off = targ - off;
11962
11963 /* If the branch offset is too big, use a ppc_stub_plt_branch.
11964 Do the same for -R objects without function descriptors. */
11965 if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
11966 && r2off == 0
11967 && htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off == 0)
11968 || off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11969 {
11970 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11971
11972 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11973 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11974 TRUE, FALSE);
11975 if (br_entry == NULL)
11976 {
11977 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't build branch stub `%s'"),
11978 stub_entry->root.string);
11979 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11980 return FALSE;
11981 }
11982
11983 if (br_entry->iter != htab->stub_iteration)
11984 {
11985 br_entry->iter = htab->stub_iteration;
11986 br_entry->offset = htab->brlt->size;
11987 htab->brlt->size += 8;
11988
11989 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11990 htab->relbrlt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11991 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11992 {
11993 htab->brlt->reloc_count += 1;
11994 htab->brlt->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11995 }
11996 }
11997
11998 targ = (br_entry->offset
11999 + htab->brlt->output_offset
12000 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
12001 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
12002 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
12003 off = targ - off;
12004
12005 if (info->emitrelocations)
12006 {
12007 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
12008 += 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0);
12009 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12010 }
12011
12012 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_plt_branch - ppc_stub_long_branch;
12013 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
12014 {
12015 size = 12;
12016 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12017 size = 16;
12018 }
12019 else
12020 {
12021 size = 16;
12022 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12023 size += 4;
12024
12025 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
12026 size += 4;
12027 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
12028 size += 4;
12029 }
12030 }
12031 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12032 {
12033 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += 1;
12034 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12035 }
12036 break;
12037
12038 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
12039 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
12040 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
12041 /* Fall through. */
12042 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
12043 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
12044 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12045 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12046 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12047 size = 0;
12048 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12049 size = 4;
12050 off += size;
12051 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
12052 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
12053 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
12054 odd = off & 4;
12055 off = targ - off;
12056
12057 if (info->emitrelocations)
12058 {
12059 unsigned int num_rel;
12060 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12061 num_rel = num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
12062 else
12063 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12064 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12065 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12066 }
12067
12068 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12069 extra = size_power10_offset (off, odd);
12070 else
12071 extra = size_offset (off - 8);
12072 /* Include branch insn plus those in the offset sequence. */
12073 size += 4 + extra;
12074 /* The branch insn is at the end, or "extra" bytes along. So
12075 its offset will be "extra" bytes less that that already
12076 calculated. */
12077 off -= extra;
12078
12079 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == 0)
12080 {
12081 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12082 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12083 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12084 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12085 lr_used += 4;
12086 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12087 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12088 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12089 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12090 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12091 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12092 }
12093
12094 /* If the branch can't reach, use a plt_branch. */
12095 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
12096 {
12097 stub_entry->stub_type += (ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
12098 - ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
12099 size += 4;
12100 }
12101 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12102 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count +=1;
12103 break;
12104
12105 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
12106 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
12107 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12108 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12109 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12110 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12111 off += 4;
12112 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
12113 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12114 abort ();
12115
12116 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12117 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12118 || stub_entry->h == NULL
12119 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
12120 {
12121 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12122 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12123 else
12124 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12125 }
12126 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12127 odd = off & 4;
12128 off = targ - off;
12129
12130 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12131 {
12132 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
12133
12134 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12135 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12136 off -= pad;
12137 }
12138
12139 if (info->emitrelocations)
12140 {
12141 unsigned int num_rel;
12142 if (htab->params->power10_stubs != 0)
12143 num_rel = num_relocs_for_power10_offset (off, odd);
12144 else
12145 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12146 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12147 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12148 }
12149
12150 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
12151
12152 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == 0)
12153 {
12154 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12155 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12156 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12157 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12158 lr_used += 4;
12159 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12160 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12161 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12162 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12163 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12164 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12165 }
12166 break;
12167
12168 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
12169 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
12170 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~(bfd_vma) 1;
12171 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12172 abort ();
12173 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12174 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12175 || stub_entry->h == NULL
12176 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
12177 {
12178 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12179 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12180 else
12181 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12182 }
12183 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12184
12185 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
12186 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
12187 off = targ - off;
12188
12189 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12190 {
12191 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
12192
12193 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12194 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12195 }
12196
12197 if (info->emitrelocations)
12198 {
12199 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
12200 += ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12201 + (htab->opd_abi
12202 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
12203 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
12204 : 1));
12205 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12206 }
12207
12208 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
12209
12210 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
12211 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
12212 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
12213 && stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
12214 {
12215 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
12216 {
12217 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
12218 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc
12219 or variant, DW_CFA_offset_externed_sf, 65, -stackoff,
12220 DW_CFA_advance_loc+4, DW_CFA_restore_extended, 65. */
12221 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12222 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12223 }
12224 else
12225 {
12226 /* Adjustments to r1 need to be described. */
12227 unsigned int cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
12228 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12229 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta);
12230 stub_entry->group->eh_size += htab->opd_abi ? 36 : 35;
12231 }
12232 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = size - 4;
12233 }
12234 break;
12235
12236 default:
12237 BFD_FAIL ();
12238 return FALSE;
12239 }
12240
12241 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += size;
12242 return TRUE;
12243 }
12244
12245 /* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
12246 for each output section included in the link. Returns -1 on error,
12247 0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success. */
12248
12249 int
12250 ppc64_elf_setup_section_lists (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12251 {
12252 unsigned int id;
12253 size_t amt;
12254 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12255
12256 if (htab == NULL)
12257 return -1;
12258
12259 htab->sec_info_arr_size = _bfd_section_id;
12260 amt = sizeof (*htab->sec_info) * (htab->sec_info_arr_size);
12261 htab->sec_info = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
12262 if (htab->sec_info == NULL)
12263 return -1;
12264
12265 /* Set toc_off for com, und, abs and ind sections. */
12266 for (id = 0; id < 3; id++)
12267 htab->sec_info[id].toc_off = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12268
12269 return 1;
12270 }
12271
12272 /* Set up for first pass at multitoc partitioning. */
12273
12274 void
12275 ppc64_elf_start_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12276 {
12277 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12278
12279 htab->toc_curr = ppc64_elf_set_toc (info, info->output_bfd);
12280 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12281 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12282 }
12283
12284 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each TOC input section
12285 and linker generated GOT section. Group input bfds such that the toc
12286 within a group is less than 64k in size. */
12287
12288 bfd_boolean
12289 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12290 {
12291 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12292 bfd_vma addr, off, limit;
12293
12294 if (htab == NULL)
12295 return FALSE;
12296
12297 if (!htab->second_toc_pass)
12298 {
12299 /* Keep track of the first .toc or .got section for this input bfd. */
12300 bfd_boolean new_bfd = htab->toc_bfd != isec->owner;
12301
12302 if (new_bfd)
12303 {
12304 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12305 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12306 }
12307
12308 addr = isec->output_offset + isec->output_section->vma;
12309 off = addr - htab->toc_curr;
12310 limit = 0x80008000;
12311 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (isec->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc)
12312 limit = 0x10000;
12313 if (off + isec->size > limit)
12314 {
12315 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12316 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12317 htab->toc_curr = addr;
12318 htab->toc_curr &= -TOC_BASE_ALIGN;
12319 }
12320
12321 /* toc_curr is the base address of this toc group. Set elf_gp
12322 for the input section to be the offset relative to the
12323 output toc base plus 0x8000. Making the input elf_gp an
12324 offset allows us to move the toc as a whole without
12325 recalculating input elf_gp. */
12326 off = htab->toc_curr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12327 off += TOC_BASE_OFF;
12328
12329 /* Die if someone uses a linker script that doesn't keep input
12330 file .toc and .got together. */
12331 if (new_bfd
12332 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0
12333 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != off)
12334 return FALSE;
12335
12336 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12337 return TRUE;
12338 }
12339
12340 /* During the second pass toc_first_sec points to the start of
12341 a toc group, and toc_curr is used to track the old elf_gp.
12342 We use toc_bfd to ensure we only look at each bfd once. */
12343 if (htab->toc_bfd == isec->owner)
12344 return TRUE;
12345 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12346
12347 if (htab->toc_first_sec == NULL
12348 || htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (isec->owner))
12349 {
12350 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12351 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12352 }
12353 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12354 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12355 off = addr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF;
12356 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12357
12358 return TRUE;
12359 }
12360
12361 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to merge GOT entries for global
12362 symbol H. */
12363
12364 static bfd_boolean
12365 merge_global_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12366 {
12367 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12368 return TRUE;
12369
12370 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
12371
12372 return TRUE;
12373 }
12374
12375 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to allocate GOT entries for global
12376 symbol H. */
12377
12378 static bfd_boolean
12379 reallocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
12380 {
12381 struct got_entry *gent;
12382
12383 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12384 return TRUE;
12385
12386 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
12387 if (!gent->is_indirect)
12388 allocate_got (h, (struct bfd_link_info *) inf, gent);
12389 return TRUE;
12390 }
12391
12392 /* Called on the first multitoc pass after the last call to
12393 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section. This function removes duplicate GOT
12394 entries. */
12395
12396 bfd_boolean
12397 ppc64_elf_layout_multitoc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12398 {
12399 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12400 struct bfd *ibfd, *ibfd2;
12401 bfd_boolean done_something;
12402
12403 htab->multi_toc_needed = htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12404
12405 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
12406 return FALSE;
12407
12408 /* Merge global sym got entries within a toc group. */
12409 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, merge_global_got, info);
12410
12411 /* And tlsld_got. */
12412 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12413 {
12414 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
12415
12416 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12417 continue;
12418
12419 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12420 if (!ent->is_indirect
12421 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12422 {
12423 for (ibfd2 = ibfd->link.next; ibfd2 != NULL; ibfd2 = ibfd2->link.next)
12424 {
12425 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd2))
12426 continue;
12427
12428 ent2 = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd2);
12429 if (!ent2->is_indirect
12430 && ent2->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
12431 && elf_gp (ibfd2) == elf_gp (ibfd))
12432 {
12433 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
12434 ent2->got.ent = ent;
12435 }
12436 }
12437 }
12438 }
12439
12440 /* Zap sizes of got sections. */
12441 htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize = htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12442 htab->elf.irelplt->size -= htab->got_reli_size;
12443 htab->got_reli_size = 0;
12444
12445 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12446 {
12447 asection *got, *relgot;
12448
12449 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12450 continue;
12451
12452 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12453 if (got != NULL)
12454 {
12455 got->rawsize = got->size;
12456 got->size = 0;
12457 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12458 relgot->rawsize = relgot->size;
12459 relgot->size = 0;
12460 }
12461 }
12462
12463 /* Now reallocate the got, local syms first. We don't need to
12464 allocate section contents again since we never increase size. */
12465 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12466 {
12467 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
12468 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
12469 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
12470 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
12471 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
12472 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
12473 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12474 asection *s;
12475
12476 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12477 continue;
12478
12479 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
12480 if (!lgot_ents)
12481 continue;
12482
12483 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
12484 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12485 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
12486 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
12487 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
12488 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
12489 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12490 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
12491 {
12492 struct got_entry *ent;
12493
12494 for (ent = *lgot_ents; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12495 {
12496 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
12497 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12498
12499 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12500 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
12501 {
12502 ent_size *= 2;
12503 rel_size *= 2;
12504 }
12505 s->size += ent_size;
12506 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
12507 {
12508 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
12509 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
12510 }
12511 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
12512 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
12513 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
12514 {
12515 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12516 srel->size += rel_size;
12517 }
12518 }
12519 }
12520 }
12521
12522 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, reallocate_got, info);
12523
12524 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12525 {
12526 struct got_entry *ent;
12527
12528 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12529 continue;
12530
12531 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12532 if (!ent->is_indirect
12533 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12534 {
12535 asection *s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12536 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12537 s->size += 16;
12538 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
12539 {
12540 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12541 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12542 }
12543 }
12544 }
12545
12546 done_something = htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize != htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12547 if (!done_something)
12548 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12549 {
12550 asection *got;
12551
12552 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12553 continue;
12554
12555 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12556 if (got != NULL)
12557 {
12558 done_something = got->rawsize != got->size;
12559 if (done_something)
12560 break;
12561 }
12562 }
12563
12564 if (done_something)
12565 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
12566
12567 /* Set up for second pass over toc sections to recalculate elf_gp
12568 on input sections. */
12569 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12570 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12571 htab->second_toc_pass = TRUE;
12572 return done_something;
12573 }
12574
12575 /* Called after second pass of multitoc partitioning. */
12576
12577 void
12578 ppc64_elf_finish_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12579 {
12580 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12581
12582 /* After the second pass, toc_curr tracks the TOC offset used
12583 for code sections below in ppc64_elf_next_input_section. */
12584 htab->toc_curr = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12585 }
12586
12587 /* No toc references were found in ISEC. If the code in ISEC makes no
12588 calls, then there's no need to use toc adjusting stubs when branching
12589 into ISEC. Actually, indirect calls from ISEC are OK as they will
12590 load r2. Returns -1 on error, 0 for no stub needed, 1 for stub
12591 needed, and 2 if a cyclical call-graph was found but no other reason
12592 for a stub was detected. If called from the top level, a return of
12593 2 means the same as a return of 0. */
12594
12595 static int
12596 toc_adjusting_stub_needed (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12597 {
12598 int ret;
12599
12600 /* Mark this section as checked. */
12601 isec->call_check_done = 1;
12602
12603 /* We know none of our code bearing sections will need toc stubs. */
12604 if ((isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
12605 return 0;
12606
12607 if (isec->size == 0)
12608 return 0;
12609
12610 if (isec->output_section == NULL)
12611 return 0;
12612
12613 ret = 0;
12614 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
12615 {
12616 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
12617 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
12618 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12619
12620 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (isec->owner, isec, NULL, NULL,
12621 info->keep_memory);
12622 if (relstart == NULL)
12623 return -1;
12624
12625 /* Look for branches to outside of this section. */
12626 local_syms = NULL;
12627 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12628 if (htab == NULL)
12629 return -1;
12630
12631 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + isec->reloc_count; ++rel)
12632 {
12633 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12634 unsigned long r_symndx;
12635 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12636 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
12637 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12638 asection *sym_sec;
12639 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12640 bfd_vma sym_value;
12641 bfd_vma dest;
12642
12643 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
12644 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12645 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12646 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12647 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12648 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
12649 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
12650 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
12651 continue;
12652
12653 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
12654 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, r_symndx,
12655 isec->owner))
12656 {
12657 ret = -1;
12658 break;
12659 }
12660
12661 /* Calls to dynamic lib functions go through a plt call stub
12662 that uses r2. */
12663 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
12664 if (eh != NULL
12665 && (eh->elf.plt.plist != NULL
12666 || (eh->oh != NULL
12667 && ppc_follow_link (eh->oh)->elf.plt.plist != NULL)))
12668 {
12669 ret = 1;
12670 break;
12671 }
12672
12673 if (sym_sec == NULL)
12674 /* Ignore other undefined symbols. */
12675 continue;
12676
12677 /* Assume branches to other sections not included in the
12678 link need stubs too, to cover -R and absolute syms. */
12679 if (sym_sec->output_section == NULL)
12680 {
12681 ret = 1;
12682 break;
12683 }
12684
12685 if (h == NULL)
12686 sym_value = sym->st_value;
12687 else
12688 {
12689 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
12690 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12691 abort ();
12692 sym_value = h->root.u.def.value;
12693 }
12694 sym_value += rel->r_addend;
12695
12696 /* If this branch reloc uses an opd sym, find the code section. */
12697 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12698 if (opd != NULL)
12699 {
12700 if (h == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12701 {
12702 long adjust;
12703
12704 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12705 if (adjust == -1)
12706 /* Assume deleted functions won't ever be called. */
12707 continue;
12708 sym_value += adjust;
12709 }
12710
12711 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12712 &sym_sec, NULL, FALSE);
12713 if (dest == (bfd_vma) -1)
12714 continue;
12715 }
12716 else
12717 dest = (sym_value
12718 + sym_sec->output_offset
12719 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12720
12721 /* Ignore branch to self. */
12722 if (sym_sec == isec)
12723 continue;
12724
12725 /* If the called function uses the toc, we need a stub. */
12726 if (sym_sec->has_toc_reloc
12727 || sym_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
12728 {
12729 ret = 1;
12730 break;
12731 }
12732
12733 /* Assume any branch that needs a long branch stub might in fact
12734 need a plt_branch stub. A plt_branch stub uses r2. */
12735 else if (dest - (isec->output_offset
12736 + isec->output_section->vma
12737 + rel->r_offset) + (1 << 25)
12738 >= (2u << 25) - PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h
12739 ? h->other
12740 : sym->st_other))
12741 {
12742 ret = 1;
12743 break;
12744 }
12745
12746 /* If calling back to a section in the process of being
12747 tested, we can't say for sure that no toc adjusting stubs
12748 are needed, so don't return zero. */
12749 else if (sym_sec->call_check_in_progress)
12750 ret = 2;
12751
12752 /* Branches to another section that itself doesn't have any TOC
12753 references are OK. Recursively call ourselves to check. */
12754 else if (!sym_sec->call_check_done)
12755 {
12756 int recur;
12757
12758 /* Mark current section as indeterminate, so that other
12759 sections that call back to current won't be marked as
12760 known. */
12761 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12762 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, sym_sec);
12763 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12764
12765 if (recur != 0)
12766 {
12767 ret = recur;
12768 if (recur != 2)
12769 break;
12770 }
12771 }
12772 }
12773
12774 if (elf_symtab_hdr (isec->owner).contents
12775 != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
12776 free (local_syms);
12777 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != relstart)
12778 free (relstart);
12779 }
12780
12781 if ((ret & 1) == 0
12782 && isec->map_head.s != NULL
12783 && (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
12784 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
12785 {
12786 if (isec->map_head.s->has_toc_reloc
12787 || isec->map_head.s->makes_toc_func_call)
12788 ret = 1;
12789 else if (!isec->map_head.s->call_check_done)
12790 {
12791 int recur;
12792 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12793 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec->map_head.s);
12794 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12795 if (recur != 0)
12796 ret = recur;
12797 }
12798 }
12799
12800 if (ret == 1)
12801 isec->makes_toc_func_call = 1;
12802
12803 return ret;
12804 }
12805
12806 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
12807 in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
12808 Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
12809 we may insert linker stubs. */
12810
12811 bfd_boolean
12812 ppc64_elf_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12813 {
12814 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12815
12816 if (htab == NULL)
12817 return FALSE;
12818
12819 if ((isec->output_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
12820 && isec->output_section->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12821 {
12822 /* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
12823 which is what we want. */
12824 htab->sec_info[isec->id].u.list
12825 = htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list;
12826 htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list = isec;
12827 }
12828
12829 if (htab->multi_toc_needed)
12830 {
12831 /* Analyse sections that aren't already flagged as needing a
12832 valid toc pointer. Exclude .fixup for the linux kernel.
12833 .fixup contains branches, but only back to the function that
12834 hit an exception. */
12835 if (!(isec->has_toc_reloc
12836 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
12837 || strcmp (isec->name, ".fixup") == 0
12838 || isec->call_check_done))
12839 {
12840 if (toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec) < 0)
12841 return FALSE;
12842 }
12843 /* Make all sections use the TOC assigned for this object file.
12844 This will be wrong for pasted sections; We fix that in
12845 check_pasted_section(). */
12846 if (elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0)
12847 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12848 }
12849
12850 htab->sec_info[isec->id].toc_off = htab->toc_curr;
12851 return TRUE;
12852 }
12853
12854 /* Check that all .init and .fini sections use the same toc, if they
12855 have toc relocs. */
12856
12857 static bfd_boolean
12858 check_pasted_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, const char *name)
12859 {
12860 asection *o = bfd_get_section_by_name (info->output_bfd, name);
12861
12862 if (o != NULL)
12863 {
12864 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12865 bfd_vma toc_off = 0;
12866 asection *i;
12867
12868 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12869 if (i->has_toc_reloc)
12870 {
12871 if (toc_off == 0)
12872 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12873 else if (toc_off != htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off)
12874 return FALSE;
12875 }
12876
12877 if (toc_off == 0)
12878 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12879 if (i->makes_toc_func_call)
12880 {
12881 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12882 break;
12883 }
12884
12885 /* Make sure the whole pasted function uses the same toc offset. */
12886 if (toc_off != 0)
12887 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12888 htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off = toc_off;
12889 }
12890 return TRUE;
12891 }
12892
12893 bfd_boolean
12894 ppc64_elf_check_init_fini (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12895 {
12896 return (check_pasted_section (info, ".init")
12897 & check_pasted_section (info, ".fini"));
12898 }
12899
12900 /* See whether we can group stub sections together. Grouping stub
12901 sections may result in fewer stubs. More importantly, we need to
12902 put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the beginning of the .init or
12903 .fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
12904 _init and _fini functions into multiple parts. Putting a stub in
12905 the middle of a function is not a good idea. */
12906
12907 static bfd_boolean
12908 group_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12909 bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
12910 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch)
12911 {
12912 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12913 asection *osec;
12914 bfd_boolean suppress_size_errors;
12915
12916 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12917 if (htab == NULL)
12918 return FALSE;
12919
12920 suppress_size_errors = FALSE;
12921 if (stub_group_size == 1)
12922 {
12923 /* Default values. */
12924 if (stubs_always_before_branch)
12925 stub_group_size = 0x1e00000;
12926 else
12927 stub_group_size = 0x1c00000;
12928 suppress_size_errors = TRUE;
12929 }
12930
12931 for (osec = info->output_bfd->sections; osec != NULL; osec = osec->next)
12932 {
12933 asection *tail;
12934
12935 if (osec->id >= htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12936 continue;
12937
12938 tail = htab->sec_info[osec->id].u.list;
12939 while (tail != NULL)
12940 {
12941 asection *curr;
12942 asection *prev;
12943 bfd_size_type total;
12944 bfd_boolean big_sec;
12945 bfd_vma curr_toc;
12946 struct map_stub *group;
12947 bfd_size_type group_size;
12948
12949 curr = tail;
12950 total = tail->size;
12951 group_size = (ppc64_elf_section_data (tail) != NULL
12952 && ppc64_elf_section_data (tail)->has_14bit_branch
12953 ? stub_group_size >> 10 : stub_group_size);
12954
12955 big_sec = total > group_size;
12956 if (big_sec && !suppress_size_errors)
12957 /* xgettext:c-format */
12958 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB section %pA exceeds stub group size"),
12959 tail->owner, tail);
12960 curr_toc = htab->sec_info[tail->id].toc_off;
12961
12962 while ((prev = htab->sec_info[curr->id].u.list) != NULL
12963 && ((total += curr->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
12964 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
12965 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
12966 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10) : group_size))
12967 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
12968 curr = prev;
12969
12970 /* OK, the size from the start of CURR to the end is less
12971 than group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
12972 section. (or the tail section is itself larger than
12973 group_size, in which case we may be toast.) We should
12974 really be keeping track of the total size of stubs added
12975 here, as stubs contribute to the final output section
12976 size. That's a little tricky, and this way will only
12977 break if stubs added make the total size more than 2^25,
12978 ie. for the default stub_group_size, if stubs total more
12979 than 2097152 bytes, or nearly 75000 plt call stubs. */
12980 group = bfd_alloc (curr->owner, sizeof (*group));
12981 if (group == NULL)
12982 return FALSE;
12983 group->link_sec = curr;
12984 group->stub_sec = NULL;
12985 group->needs_save_res = 0;
12986 group->lr_restore = 0;
12987 group->eh_size = 0;
12988 group->eh_base = 0;
12989 group->next = htab->group;
12990 htab->group = group;
12991 do
12992 {
12993 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
12994 /* Set up this stub group. */
12995 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
12996 }
12997 while (tail != curr && (tail = prev) != NULL);
12998
12999 /* But wait, there's more! Input sections up to group_size
13000 bytes before the stub section can be handled by it too.
13001 Don't do this if we have a really large section after the
13002 stubs, as adding more stubs increases the chance that
13003 branches may not reach into the stub section. */
13004 if (!stubs_always_before_branch && !big_sec)
13005 {
13006 total = 0;
13007 while (prev != NULL
13008 && ((total += tail->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
13009 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
13010 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
13011 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10)
13012 : group_size))
13013 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
13014 {
13015 tail = prev;
13016 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
13017 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
13018 }
13019 }
13020 tail = prev;
13021 }
13022 }
13023 return TRUE;
13024 }
13025
13026 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
13027 {
13028 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
13029 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
13030 1, /* CIE version. */
13031 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
13032 4, /* Code alignment. */
13033 0x78, /* Data alignment. */
13034 65, /* RA reg. */
13035 1, /* Augmentation size. */
13036 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
13037 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
13038 };
13039
13040 /* Stripping output sections is normally done before dynamic section
13041 symbols have been allocated. This function is called later, and
13042 handles cases like htab->brlt which is mapped to its own output
13043 section. */
13044
13045 static void
13046 maybe_strip_output (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
13047 {
13048 if (isec->size == 0
13049 && isec->output_section->size == 0
13050 && !(isec->output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP)
13051 && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (info->output_bfd,
13052 isec->output_section)
13053 && elf_section_data (isec->output_section)->dynindx == 0)
13054 {
13055 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
13056 bfd_section_list_remove (info->output_bfd, isec->output_section);
13057 info->output_bfd->section_count--;
13058 }
13059 }
13060
13061 /* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
13062
13063 The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
13064 PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
13065 instruction. */
13066
13067 bfd_boolean
13068 ppc64_elf_size_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13069 {
13070 bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
13071 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch;
13072 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13073
13074 if (htab == NULL)
13075 return FALSE;
13076
13077 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == -1 && !htab->has_power10_relocs)
13078 htab->params->power10_stubs = 0;
13079
13080 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1 && !bfd_link_executable (info))
13081 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 1;
13082 if (!htab->opd_abi)
13083 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 0;
13084 else if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1)
13085 {
13086 static const char *const thread_starter[] =
13087 {
13088 "pthread_create",
13089 /* libstdc++ */
13090 "_ZNSt6thread15_M_start_threadESt10shared_ptrINS_10_Impl_baseEE",
13091 /* librt */
13092 "aio_init", "aio_read", "aio_write", "aio_fsync", "lio_listio",
13093 "mq_notify", "create_timer",
13094 /* libanl */
13095 "getaddrinfo_a",
13096 /* libgomp */
13097 "GOMP_parallel",
13098 "GOMP_parallel_start",
13099 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static",
13100 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static_start",
13101 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic",
13102 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic_start",
13103 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided",
13104 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided_start",
13105 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime",
13106 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime_start",
13107 "GOMP_parallel_sections",
13108 "GOMP_parallel_sections_start",
13109 /* libgo */
13110 "__go_go",
13111 };
13112 unsigned i;
13113
13114 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (thread_starter); i++)
13115 {
13116 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13117 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, thread_starter[i],
13118 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13119 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = h != NULL && h->ref_regular;
13120 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe)
13121 break;
13122 }
13123 }
13124 stubs_always_before_branch = htab->params->group_size < 0;
13125 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
13126 stub_group_size = -htab->params->group_size;
13127 else
13128 stub_group_size = htab->params->group_size;
13129
13130 if (!group_sections (info, stub_group_size, stubs_always_before_branch))
13131 return FALSE;
13132
13133 htab->tga_group = NULL;
13134 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave
13135 && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
13136 && (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
13137 || htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
13138 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
13139 && is_static_defined (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf))
13140 {
13141 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec, *stub_sec;
13142 bfd_vma sym_value;
13143 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13144
13145 sym_sec = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.root.u.def.section;
13146 sym_value = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
13147 code_sec = sym_sec;
13148 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13149 if (opd != NULL)
13150 opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
13151 htab->tga_group = htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].u.group;
13152 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (".tga_desc.stub",
13153 htab->tga_group->link_sec);
13154 if (stub_sec == NULL)
13155 return FALSE;
13156 htab->tga_group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
13157
13158 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13159 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
13160 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
13161 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
13162 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.def_regular = 1;
13163 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.non_elf = 0;
13164 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &htab->tga_desc_fd->elf, TRUE);
13165 }
13166
13167 #define STUB_SHRINK_ITER 20
13168 /* Loop until no stubs added. After iteration 20 of this loop we may
13169 exit on a stub section shrinking. This is to break out of a
13170 pathological case where adding stubs on one iteration decreases
13171 section gaps (perhaps due to alignment), which then requires
13172 fewer or smaller stubs on the next iteration. */
13173
13174 while (1)
13175 {
13176 bfd *input_bfd;
13177 unsigned int bfd_indx;
13178 struct map_stub *group;
13179
13180 htab->stub_iteration += 1;
13181
13182 for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
13183 input_bfd != NULL;
13184 input_bfd = input_bfd->link.next, bfd_indx++)
13185 {
13186 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13187 asection *section;
13188 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
13189
13190 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
13191 continue;
13192
13193 /* We'll need the symbol table in a second. */
13194 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
13195 if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
13196 continue;
13197
13198 /* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd. */
13199 for (section = input_bfd->sections;
13200 section != NULL;
13201 section = section->next)
13202 {
13203 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
13204
13205 /* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
13206 to do. */
13207 if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
13208 || (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
13209 || (section->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
13210 || (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
13211 || section->reloc_count == 0)
13212 continue;
13213
13214 /* If this section is a link-once section that will be
13215 discarded, then don't create any stubs. */
13216 if (section->output_section == NULL
13217 || section->output_section->owner != info->output_bfd)
13218 continue;
13219
13220 /* Get the relocs. */
13221 internal_relocs
13222 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL, NULL,
13223 info->keep_memory);
13224 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
13225 goto error_ret_free_local;
13226
13227 /* Now examine each relocation. */
13228 irela = internal_relocs;
13229 irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
13230 for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
13231 {
13232 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
13233 unsigned int r_indx;
13234 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
13235 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
13236 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec;
13237 bfd_vma sym_value, code_value;
13238 bfd_vma destination;
13239 unsigned long local_off;
13240 bfd_boolean ok_dest;
13241 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash;
13242 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
13243 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13244 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
13245 char *stub_name;
13246 const asection *id_sec;
13247 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13248 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
13249
13250 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
13251 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
13252
13253 if (r_type >= R_PPC64_max)
13254 {
13255 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13256 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13257 }
13258
13259 /* Only look for stubs on branch instructions. */
13260 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
13261 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
13262 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
13263 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
13264 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
13265 continue;
13266
13267 /* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
13268 section. */
13269 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
13270 r_indx, input_bfd))
13271 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13272 hash = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
13273
13274 ok_dest = FALSE;
13275 fdh = NULL;
13276 sym_value = 0;
13277 if (hash == NULL)
13278 {
13279 sym_value = sym->st_value;
13280 if (sym_sec != NULL
13281 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13282 ok_dest = TRUE;
13283 }
13284 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13285 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13286 {
13287 sym_value = hash->elf.root.u.def.value;
13288 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13289 ok_dest = TRUE;
13290 }
13291 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
13292 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
13293 {
13294 /* Recognise an old ABI func code entry sym, and
13295 use the func descriptor sym instead if it is
13296 defined. */
13297 if (hash->elf.root.root.string[0] == '.'
13298 && hash->oh != NULL)
13299 {
13300 fdh = ppc_follow_link (hash->oh);
13301 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13302 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13303 {
13304 sym_sec = fdh->elf.root.u.def.section;
13305 sym_value = fdh->elf.root.u.def.value;
13306 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13307 ok_dest = TRUE;
13308 }
13309 else
13310 fdh = NULL;
13311 }
13312 }
13313 else
13314 {
13315 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13316 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13317 }
13318
13319 destination = 0;
13320 local_off = 0;
13321 if (ok_dest)
13322 {
13323 sym_value += irela->r_addend;
13324 destination = (sym_value
13325 + sym_sec->output_offset
13326 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
13327 local_off = PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (hash
13328 ? hash->elf.other
13329 : sym->st_other);
13330 }
13331
13332 code_sec = sym_sec;
13333 code_value = sym_value;
13334 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13335 if (opd != NULL)
13336 {
13337 bfd_vma dest;
13338
13339 if (hash == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
13340 {
13341 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
13342 if (adjust == -1)
13343 continue;
13344 code_value += adjust;
13345 sym_value += adjust;
13346 }
13347 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
13348 &code_sec, &code_value, FALSE);
13349 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
13350 {
13351 destination = dest;
13352 if (fdh != NULL)
13353 {
13354 /* Fixup old ABI sym to point at code
13355 entry. */
13356 hash->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defweak;
13357 hash->elf.root.u.def.section = code_sec;
13358 hash->elf.root.u.def.value = code_value;
13359 }
13360 }
13361 }
13362
13363 /* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed. */
13364 plt_ent = NULL;
13365 stub_type = ppc_type_of_stub (section, irela, &hash,
13366 &plt_ent, destination,
13367 local_off);
13368
13369 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
13370 {
13371 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13372 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
13373 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
13374 || (code_sec != NULL
13375 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13376 && (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13377 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13378 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
13379 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc;
13380 }
13381 else if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call)
13382 {
13383 /* Check whether we need a TOC adjusting stub.
13384 Since the linker pastes together pieces from
13385 different object files when creating the
13386 _init and _fini functions, it may be that a
13387 call to what looks like a local sym is in
13388 fact a call needing a TOC adjustment. */
13389 if ((code_sec != NULL
13390 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13391 && (htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].toc_off
13392 != htab->sec_info[section->id].toc_off)
13393 && (code_sec->has_toc_reloc
13394 || code_sec->makes_toc_func_call))
13395 || (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13396 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13397 == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT))
13398 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off;
13399 }
13400
13401 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_none)
13402 continue;
13403
13404 /* __tls_get_addr calls might be eliminated. */
13405 if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call
13406 && stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
13407 && hash != NULL
13408 && is_tls_get_addr (&hash->elf, htab)
13409 && section->has_tls_reloc
13410 && irela != internal_relocs)
13411 {
13412 /* Get tls info. */
13413 unsigned char *tls_mask;
13414
13415 if (!get_tls_mask (&tls_mask, NULL, NULL, &local_syms,
13416 irela - 1, input_bfd))
13417 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13418 if ((*tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13419 && (*tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) == 0)
13420 continue;
13421 }
13422
13423 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13424 {
13425 if (!htab->opd_abi
13426 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
13427 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&hash->elf))
13428 htab->has_plt_localentry0 = 1;
13429 else if (irela + 1 < irelaend
13430 && irela[1].r_offset == irela->r_offset + 4
13431 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (irela[1].r_info)
13432 == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE))
13433 {
13434 if (!tocsave_find (htab, INSERT,
13435 &local_syms, irela + 1, input_bfd))
13436 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13437 }
13438 else
13439 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save;
13440 }
13441
13442 /* Support for grouping stub sections. */
13443 id_sec = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group->link_sec;
13444
13445 /* Get the name of this stub. */
13446 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash, irela);
13447 if (!stub_name)
13448 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13449
13450 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
13451 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
13452 if (stub_entry != NULL)
13453 {
13454 enum ppc_stub_type old_type;
13455
13456 /* A stub has already been created, but it may
13457 not be the required type. We shouldn't be
13458 transitioning from plt_call to long_branch
13459 stubs or vice versa, but we might be
13460 upgrading from plt_call to plt_call_r2save or
13461 from long_branch to long_branch_r2off. */
13462 free (stub_name);
13463 if (htab->params->power10_stubs == -1)
13464 {
13465 /* For --power10-stubs=auto, don't merge _notoc
13466 and other varieties of stubs. (The _both
13467 variety won't be created.) */
13468 bfd_boolean notoc = r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
13469 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *alt_stub
13470 = select_alt_stub (stub_entry, notoc);
13471
13472 if (alt_stub == NULL)
13473 {
13474 alt_stub = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *)
13475 stub_hash_newfunc (NULL,
13476 &htab->stub_hash_table,
13477 stub_entry->root.string);
13478 if (alt_stub == NULL)
13479 {
13480 /* xgettext:c-format */
13481 _bfd_error_handler
13482 (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
13483 section->owner, stub_entry->root.string);
13484 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13485 }
13486 *alt_stub = *stub_entry;
13487 stub_entry->root.next = &alt_stub->root;
13488 if (notoc)
13489 /* Sort notoc stubs first, for no good
13490 reason. */
13491 alt_stub = stub_entry;
13492 alt_stub->stub_type = stub_type;
13493 }
13494 stub_entry = alt_stub;
13495 }
13496 old_type = stub_entry->stub_type;
13497 switch (old_type)
13498 {
13499 default:
13500 abort ();
13501
13502 case ppc_stub_save_res:
13503 continue;
13504
13505 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
13506 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
13507 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
13508 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
13509 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13510 continue;
13511 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13512 {
13513 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13514 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13515 }
13516 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13517 {
13518 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13519 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13520 }
13521 else
13522 abort ();
13523 break;
13524
13525 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
13526 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
13527 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
13528 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
13529 old_type += (ppc_stub_long_branch
13530 - ppc_stub_plt_branch);
13531 /* Fall through. */
13532 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
13533 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
13534 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
13535 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
13536 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch)
13537 continue;
13538 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13539 {
13540 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13541 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13542 }
13543 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13544 {
13545 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13546 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13547 }
13548 else
13549 abort ();
13550 break;
13551 }
13552 if (old_type < stub_type)
13553 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13554 continue;
13555 }
13556
13557 stub_entry = ppc_add_stub (stub_name, section, info);
13558 if (stub_entry == NULL)
13559 {
13560 free (stub_name);
13561 error_ret_free_internal:
13562 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
13563 free (internal_relocs);
13564 error_ret_free_local:
13565 if (symtab_hdr->contents
13566 != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13567 free (local_syms);
13568 return FALSE;
13569 }
13570
13571 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13572 if (stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
13573 && stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
13574 {
13575 stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
13576 stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
13577 }
13578 else
13579 {
13580 stub_entry->target_value = code_value;
13581 stub_entry->target_section = code_sec;
13582 }
13583 stub_entry->h = hash;
13584 stub_entry->plt_ent = plt_ent;
13585 stub_entry->symtype
13586 = hash ? hash->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
13587 stub_entry->other = hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other;
13588
13589 if (hash != NULL
13590 && (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13591 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
13592 htab->stub_globals += 1;
13593 }
13594
13595 /* We're done with the internal relocs, free them. */
13596 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13597 free (internal_relocs);
13598 }
13599
13600 if (local_syms != NULL
13601 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13602 {
13603 if (!info->keep_memory)
13604 free (local_syms);
13605 else
13606 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
13607 }
13608 }
13609
13610 /* We may have added some stubs. Find out the new size of the
13611 stub sections. */
13612 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13613 {
13614 group->lr_restore = 0;
13615 group->eh_size = 0;
13616 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13617 {
13618 asection *stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
13619
13620 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13621 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size)
13622 /* Past STUB_SHRINK_ITER, rawsize is the max size seen. */
13623 stub_sec->rawsize = stub_sec->size;
13624 stub_sec->size = 0;
13625 stub_sec->reloc_count = 0;
13626 stub_sec->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13627 }
13628 }
13629 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
13630 {
13631 /* See emit_tga_desc and emit_tga_desc_eh_frame. */
13632 htab->tga_group->eh_size
13633 = 1 + 2 + (htab->opd_abi != 0) + 3 + 8 * 2 + 3 + 8 + 3;
13634 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
13635 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
13636 }
13637
13638 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13639 || htab->brlt->rawsize < htab->brlt->size)
13640 htab->brlt->rawsize = htab->brlt->size;
13641 htab->brlt->size = 0;
13642 htab->brlt->reloc_count = 0;
13643 htab->brlt->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13644 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13645 htab->relbrlt->size = 0;
13646
13647 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_size_one_stub, info);
13648
13649 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13650 if (group->needs_save_res)
13651 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13652
13653 if (info->emitrelocations
13654 && htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13655 {
13656 htab->glink->reloc_count = 1;
13657 htab->glink->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
13658 }
13659
13660 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13661 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
13662 && htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->size > 8)
13663 {
13664 size_t size = 0, align = 4;
13665
13666 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13667 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13668 size += (group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align;
13669 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13670 size += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
13671 if (size != 0)
13672 size += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
13673 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13674 size = (size + align - 1) & -align;
13675 htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize = htab->glink_eh_frame->size;
13676 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size;
13677 }
13678
13679 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
13680 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13681 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13682 {
13683 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
13684 group->stub_sec->size
13685 = (group->stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
13686 }
13687
13688 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13689 if (group->stub_sec != NULL
13690 && group->stub_sec->rawsize != group->stub_sec->size
13691 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13692 || group->stub_sec->rawsize < group->stub_sec->size))
13693 break;
13694
13695 if (group == NULL
13696 && (htab->brlt->rawsize == htab->brlt->size
13697 || (htab->stub_iteration > STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13698 && htab->brlt->rawsize > htab->brlt->size))
13699 && (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
13700 || htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize == htab->glink_eh_frame->size)
13701 && (htab->tga_group == NULL
13702 || htab->stub_iteration > 1))
13703 break;
13704
13705 /* Ask the linker to do its stuff. */
13706 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
13707 }
13708
13709 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13710 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
13711 {
13712 bfd_vma val;
13713 bfd_byte *p, *last_fde;
13714 size_t last_fde_len, size, align, pad;
13715 struct map_stub *group;
13716
13717 /* It is necessary to at least have a rough outline of the
13718 linker generated CIEs and FDEs written before
13719 bfd_elf_discard_info is run, in order for these FDEs to be
13720 indexed in .eh_frame_hdr. */
13721 p = bfd_zalloc (htab->glink_eh_frame->owner, htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
13722 if (p == NULL)
13723 return FALSE;
13724 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents = p;
13725 last_fde = p;
13726 align = 4;
13727
13728 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
13729 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
13730 last_fde_len = ((sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13731 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13732 p += last_fde_len + 4;
13733
13734 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13735 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13736 {
13737 group->eh_base = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13738 last_fde = p;
13739 last_fde_len = ((group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13740 /* FDE length. */
13741 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13742 p += 4;
13743 /* CIE pointer. */
13744 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13745 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13746 p += 4;
13747 /* Offset to stub section, written later. */
13748 p += 4;
13749 /* stub section size. */
13750 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, group->stub_sec->size, p);
13751 p += 4;
13752 /* Augmentation. */
13753 p += 1;
13754 /* Make sure we don't have all nops. This is enough for
13755 elf-eh-frame.c to detect the last non-nop opcode. */
13756 p[group->eh_size - 1] = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13757 p = last_fde + last_fde_len + 4;
13758 }
13759 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13760 {
13761 last_fde = p;
13762 last_fde_len = ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13763 /* FDE length. */
13764 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13765 p += 4;
13766 /* CIE pointer. */
13767 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13768 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13769 p += 4;
13770 /* Offset to .glink, written later. */
13771 p += 4;
13772 /* .glink size. */
13773 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size - 8, p);
13774 p += 4;
13775 /* Augmentation. */
13776 p += 1;
13777
13778 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13779 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
13780 *p++ = 65;
13781 *p++ = htab->opd_abi ? 12 : 0;
13782 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->opd_abi ? 5 : 7);
13783 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
13784 *p++ = 65;
13785 p += ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 24;
13786 }
13787 /* Subsume any padding into the last FDE if user .eh_frame
13788 sections are aligned more than glink_eh_frame. Otherwise any
13789 zero padding will be seen as a terminator. */
13790 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13791 size = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13792 pad = ((size + align - 1) & -align) - size;
13793 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size + pad;
13794 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len + pad, last_fde);
13795 }
13796
13797 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->brlt);
13798 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13799 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->relbrlt);
13800 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL)
13801 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->glink_eh_frame);
13802
13803 return TRUE;
13804 }
13805
13806 /* Called after we have determined section placement. If sections
13807 move, we'll be called again. Provide a value for TOCstart. */
13808
13809 bfd_vma
13810 ppc64_elf_set_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd)
13811 {
13812 asection *s;
13813 bfd_vma TOCstart, adjust;
13814
13815 if (info != NULL)
13816 {
13817 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13818 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
13819
13820 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13821 && htab->hgot != NULL)
13822 h = htab->hgot;
13823 else
13824 {
13825 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, ".TOC.", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13826 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab))
13827 htab->hgot = h;
13828 }
13829 if (h != NULL
13830 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13831 && !h->root.linker_def
13832 && (!is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13833 || h->def_regular))
13834 {
13835 TOCstart = defined_sym_val (h) - TOC_BASE_OFF;
13836 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13837 return TOCstart;
13838 }
13839 }
13840
13841 /* The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, .plt in that
13842 order. The TOC starts where the first of these sections starts. */
13843 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".got");
13844 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13845 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".toc");
13846 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13847 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".tocbss");
13848 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13849 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".plt");
13850 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13851 {
13852 /* This may happen for
13853 o references to TOC base (SYM@toc / TOC[tc0]) without a
13854 .toc directive
13855 o bad linker script
13856 o --gc-sections and empty TOC sections
13857
13858 FIXME: Warn user? */
13859
13860 /* Look for a likely section. We probably won't even be
13861 using TOCstart. */
13862 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13863 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_READONLY
13864 | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13865 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13866 break;
13867 if (s == NULL)
13868 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13869 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13870 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13871 break;
13872 if (s == NULL)
13873 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13874 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13875 == SEC_ALLOC)
13876 break;
13877 if (s == NULL)
13878 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13879 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_ALLOC)
13880 break;
13881 }
13882
13883 TOCstart = 0;
13884 if (s != NULL)
13885 TOCstart = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
13886
13887 /* Force alignment. */
13888 adjust = TOCstart & (TOC_BASE_ALIGN - 1);
13889 TOCstart -= adjust;
13890 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13891
13892 if (info != NULL && s != NULL)
13893 {
13894 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13895
13896 if (htab != NULL)
13897 {
13898 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
13899 {
13900 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust;
13901 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = s;
13902 }
13903 }
13904 else
13905 {
13906 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
13907 _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, obfd, ".TOC.", BSF_GLOBAL,
13908 s, TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust,
13909 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh);
13910 }
13911 }
13912 return TOCstart;
13913 }
13914
13915 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_build_stubs to
13916 write out any global entry stubs, and PLT relocations. */
13917
13918 static bfd_boolean
13919 build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
13920 {
13921 struct bfd_link_info *info;
13922 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
13923 struct plt_entry *ent;
13924 asection *s;
13925
13926 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
13927 return TRUE;
13928
13929 info = inf;
13930 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13931 if (htab == NULL)
13932 return FALSE;
13933
13934 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13935 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13936 {
13937 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage
13938 table. Set it up. */
13939 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
13940 asection *plt, *relplt;
13941 bfd_byte *loc;
13942
13943 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
13944 || h->dynindx == -1)
13945 {
13946 if (!(h->def_regular
13947 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13948 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)))
13949 continue;
13950 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13951 {
13952 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13953 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
13954 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = TRUE;
13955 if (htab->opd_abi)
13956 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
13957 else
13958 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
13959 }
13960 else
13961 {
13962 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13963 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
13964 {
13965 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
13966 if (htab->opd_abi)
13967 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13968 else
13969 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
13970 }
13971 else
13972 relplt = NULL;
13973 }
13974 rela.r_addend = defined_sym_val (h) + ent->addend;
13975
13976 if (relplt == NULL)
13977 {
13978 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
13979 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
13980 if (htab->opd_abi)
13981 {
13982 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
13983 toc += htab->sec_info[h->root.u.def.section->id].toc_off;
13984 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
13985 }
13986 }
13987 else
13988 {
13989 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
13990 + plt->output_offset
13991 + ent->plt.offset);
13992 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
13993 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
13994 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13995 }
13996 }
13997 else
13998 {
13999 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
14000 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
14001 + ent->plt.offset);
14002 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14003 rela.r_addend = ent->addend;
14004 loc = (htab->elf.srelplt->contents
14005 + ((ent->plt.offset - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
14006 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)));
14007 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
14008 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = TRUE;
14009 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14010 }
14011 }
14012
14013 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
14014 return TRUE;
14015
14016 if (h->def_regular)
14017 return TRUE;
14018
14019 s = htab->global_entry;
14020 if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
14021 return TRUE;
14022
14023 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14024 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
14025 && ent->addend == 0)
14026 {
14027 bfd_byte *p;
14028 asection *plt;
14029 bfd_vma off;
14030
14031 p = s->contents + h->root.u.def.value;
14032 plt = htab->elf.splt;
14033 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
14034 || h->dynindx == -1)
14035 {
14036 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14037 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14038 else
14039 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14040 }
14041 off = ent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
14042 off -= h->root.u.def.value + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
14043
14044 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 3) != 0)
14045 {
14046 info->callbacks->einfo
14047 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
14048 h->root.root.string);
14049 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14050 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14051 }
14052
14053 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1] += 1;
14054 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14055 {
14056 size_t len = strlen (h->root.root.string);
14057 char *name = bfd_malloc (sizeof "12345678.global_entry." + len);
14058
14059 if (name == NULL)
14060 return FALSE;
14061
14062 sprintf (name, "%08x.global_entry.%s", s->id, h->root.root.string);
14063 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
14064 if (h == NULL)
14065 return FALSE;
14066 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
14067 {
14068 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
14069 h->root.u.def.section = s;
14070 h->root.u.def.value = p - s->contents;
14071 h->ref_regular = 1;
14072 h->def_regular = 1;
14073 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14074 h->forced_local = 1;
14075 h->non_elf = 0;
14076 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14077 }
14078 }
14079
14080 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
14081 {
14082 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, ADDIS_R12_R12 | PPC_HA (off), p);
14083 p += 4;
14084 }
14085 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
14086 p += 4;
14087 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14088 p += 4;
14089 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, BCTR, p);
14090 break;
14091 }
14092 return TRUE;
14093 }
14094
14095 /* Write PLT relocs for locals. */
14096
14097 static bfd_boolean
14098 write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
14099 {
14100 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14101 bfd *ibfd;
14102
14103 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
14104 {
14105 struct got_entry **lgot_ents, **end_lgot_ents;
14106 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
14107 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14108 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
14109 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
14110 struct plt_entry *ent;
14111
14112 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
14113 continue;
14114
14115 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
14116 if (!lgot_ents)
14117 continue;
14118
14119 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
14120 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
14121 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
14122 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
14123 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
14124 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
14125 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14126 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14127 {
14128 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14129 asection *sym_sec;
14130 asection *plt, *relplt;
14131 bfd_byte *loc;
14132 bfd_vma val;
14133
14134 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
14135 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
14136 {
14137 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14138 free (local_syms);
14139 return FALSE;
14140 }
14141
14142 val = sym->st_value + ent->addend;
14143 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14144 val += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (sym->st_other);
14145 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
14146 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
14147
14148 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14149 {
14150 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = TRUE;
14151 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14152 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
14153 }
14154 else
14155 {
14156 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14157 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
14158 }
14159
14160 if (relplt == NULL)
14161 {
14162 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
14163 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
14164 if (htab->opd_abi)
14165 {
14166 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (ibfd);
14167 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
14168 }
14169 }
14170 else
14171 {
14172 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
14173 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
14174 + plt->output_offset
14175 + plt->output_section->vma);
14176 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14177 {
14178 if (htab->opd_abi)
14179 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
14180 else
14181 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14182 }
14183 else
14184 {
14185 if (htab->opd_abi)
14186 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14187 else
14188 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14189 }
14190 rela.r_addend = val;
14191 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
14192 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14193 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14194 }
14195 }
14196
14197 if (local_syms != NULL
14198 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14199 {
14200 if (!info->keep_memory)
14201 free (local_syms);
14202 else
14203 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
14204 }
14205 }
14206 return TRUE;
14207 }
14208
14209 /* Emit the static wrapper function preserving registers around a
14210 __tls_get_addr_opt call. */
14211
14212 static bfd_boolean
14213 emit_tga_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
14214 {
14215 asection *stub_sec = htab->tga_group->stub_sec;
14216 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14217 bfd_byte *p;
14218 bfd_vma to, from, delta;
14219
14220 BFD_ASSERT (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14221 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section == stub_sec
14222 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value == 0);
14223 to = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
14224 from = defined_sym_val (&htab->tga_desc_fd->elf) + cfa_updt;
14225 delta = to - from;
14226 if (delta + (1 << 25) >= 1 << 26)
14227 {
14228 _bfd_error_handler (_("__tls_get_addr call offset overflow"));
14229 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14230 return FALSE;
14231 }
14232
14233 p = stub_sec->contents;
14234 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14235 bfd_put_32 (stub_sec->owner, B_DOT | 1 | (delta & 0x3fffffc), p);
14236 p += 4;
14237 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14238 return stub_sec->size == (bfd_size_type) (p - stub_sec->contents);
14239 }
14240
14241 /* Emit eh_frame describing the static wrapper function. */
14242
14243 static bfd_byte *
14244 emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab, bfd_byte *p)
14245 {
14246 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14247 unsigned int i;
14248
14249 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + cfa_updt / 4;
14250 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14251 if (htab->opd_abi)
14252 {
14253 *p++ = 128;
14254 *p++ = 1;
14255 }
14256 else
14257 *p++ = 96;
14258 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
14259 *p++ = 65;
14260 *p++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
14261 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14262 {
14263 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
14264 *p++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
14265 }
14266 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 10;
14267 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14268 *p++ = 0;
14269 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14270 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
14271 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
14272 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
14273 *p++ = 65;
14274 return p;
14275 }
14276
14277 /* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file.
14278 The stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker
14279 hash table. This function is called via gldelf64ppc_finish. */
14280
14281 bfd_boolean
14282 ppc64_elf_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
14283 char **stats)
14284 {
14285 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14286 struct map_stub *group;
14287 asection *stub_sec;
14288 bfd_byte *p;
14289 int stub_sec_count = 0;
14290
14291 if (htab == NULL)
14292 return FALSE;
14293
14294 /* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs. */
14295 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14296 {
14297 group->eh_size = 0;
14298 group->lr_restore = 0;
14299 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL
14300 && stub_sec->size != 0)
14301 {
14302 stub_sec->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd,
14303 stub_sec->size);
14304 if (stub_sec->contents == NULL)
14305 return FALSE;
14306 stub_sec->size = 0;
14307 }
14308 }
14309
14310 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14311 {
14312 unsigned int indx;
14313 bfd_vma plt0;
14314
14315 /* Build the .glink plt call stub. */
14316 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14317 {
14318 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
14319 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
14320 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
14321 if (h == NULL)
14322 return FALSE;
14323 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
14324 {
14325 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
14326 h->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
14327 h->root.u.def.value = 8;
14328 h->ref_regular = 1;
14329 h->def_regular = 1;
14330 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14331 h->forced_local = 1;
14332 h->non_elf = 0;
14333 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14334 }
14335 }
14336 plt0 = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
14337 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
14338 - 16);
14339 if (info->emitrelocations)
14340 {
14341 Elf_Internal_Rela *r = get_relocs (htab->glink, 1);
14342 if (r == NULL)
14343 return FALSE;
14344 r->r_offset = (htab->glink->output_offset
14345 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
14346 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL64);
14347 r->r_addend = plt0;
14348 }
14349 p = htab->glink->contents;
14350 plt0 -= htab->glink->output_section->vma + htab->glink->output_offset;
14351 bfd_put_64 (htab->glink->owner, plt0, p);
14352 p += 8;
14353 if (htab->opd_abi)
14354 {
14355 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R12, p);
14356 p += 4;
14357 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14358 p += 4;
14359 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14360 p += 4;
14361 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
14362 p += 4;
14363 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R12, p);
14364 p += 4;
14365 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
14366 p += 4;
14367 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14368 p += 4;
14369 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | 8, p);
14370 p += 4;
14371 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14372 p += 4;
14373 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 16, p);
14374 p += 4;
14375 }
14376 else
14377 {
14378 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R0, p);
14379 p += 4;
14380 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14381 p += 4;
14382 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14383 p += 4;
14384 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, STD_R2_0R1 + 24, p);
14385 p += 4;
14386 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
14387 p += 4;
14388 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R0, p);
14389 p += 4;
14390 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SUB_R12_R12_R11, p);
14391 p += 4;
14392 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
14393 p += 4;
14394 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADDI_R0_R12 | (-48 & 0xffff), p);
14395 p += 4;
14396 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14397 p += 4;
14398 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SRDI_R0_R0_2, p);
14399 p += 4;
14400 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14401 p += 4;
14402 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 8, p);
14403 p += 4;
14404 }
14405 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCTR, p);
14406 p += 4;
14407 BFD_ASSERT (p == htab->glink->contents + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab));
14408
14409 /* Build the .glink lazy link call stubs. */
14410 indx = 0;
14411 while (p < htab->glink->contents + htab->glink->size)
14412 {
14413 if (htab->opd_abi)
14414 {
14415 if (indx < 0x8000)
14416 {
14417 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LI_R0_0 | indx, p);
14418 p += 4;
14419 }
14420 else
14421 {
14422 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LIS_R0_0 | PPC_HI (indx), p);
14423 p += 4;
14424 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ORI_R0_R0_0 | PPC_LO (indx),
14425 p);
14426 p += 4;
14427 }
14428 }
14429 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner,
14430 B_DOT | ((htab->glink->contents - p + 8) & 0x3fffffc), p);
14431 indx++;
14432 p += 4;
14433 }
14434 }
14435
14436 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
14437 {
14438 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
14439 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
14440 if (!emit_tga_desc (htab))
14441 return FALSE;
14442 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14443 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14444 {
14445 size_t align = 4;
14446
14447 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14448 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14449 p += 17;
14450 htab->tga_group->eh_size = emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (htab, p) - p;
14451 }
14452 }
14453
14454 /* Build .glink global entry stubs, and PLT relocs for globals. */
14455 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt, info);
14456
14457 if (!write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (info))
14458 return FALSE;
14459
14460 if (htab->brlt != NULL && htab->brlt->size != 0)
14461 {
14462 htab->brlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->brlt->owner,
14463 htab->brlt->size);
14464 if (htab->brlt->contents == NULL)
14465 return FALSE;
14466 }
14467 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL && htab->relbrlt->size != 0)
14468 {
14469 htab->relbrlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->relbrlt->owner,
14470 htab->relbrlt->size);
14471 if (htab->relbrlt->contents == NULL)
14472 return FALSE;
14473 }
14474
14475 /* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table. */
14476 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_build_one_stub, info);
14477
14478 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14479 if (group->needs_save_res)
14480 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
14481
14482 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
14483 htab->relbrlt->reloc_count = 0;
14484
14485 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
14486 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14487 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14488 {
14489 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
14490 stub_sec->size = (stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
14491 }
14492
14493 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14494 if (group->needs_save_res)
14495 {
14496 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
14497 memcpy (stub_sec->contents + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size,
14498 htab->sfpr->contents, htab->sfpr->size);
14499 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14500 {
14501 unsigned int i;
14502
14503 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
14504 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], stub_sec))
14505 return FALSE;
14506 }
14507 }
14508
14509 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14510 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14511 {
14512 bfd_vma val;
14513 size_t align = 4;
14514
14515 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14516 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14517
14518 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14519 if (group->eh_size != 0)
14520 {
14521 /* Offset to stub section. */
14522 val = (group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
14523 + group->stub_sec->output_offset);
14524 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14525 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14526 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14527 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14528 {
14529 _bfd_error_handler
14530 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14531 group->stub_sec->name);
14532 return FALSE;
14533 }
14534 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14535 p += (group->eh_size + 17 + 3) & -4;
14536 }
14537 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14538 {
14539 /* Offset to .glink. */
14540 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
14541 + htab->glink->output_offset
14542 + 8);
14543 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14544 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14545 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14546 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14547 {
14548 _bfd_error_handler
14549 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14550 htab->glink->name);
14551 return FALSE;
14552 }
14553 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14554 p += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
14555 }
14556 }
14557
14558 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14559 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14560 {
14561 stub_sec_count += 1;
14562 if (stub_sec->rawsize != stub_sec->size
14563 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
14564 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size))
14565 break;
14566 }
14567
14568 if (group != NULL)
14569 {
14570 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14571 _bfd_error_handler (_("stubs don't match calculated size"));
14572 }
14573
14574 if (htab->stub_error)
14575 return FALSE;
14576
14577 if (stats != NULL)
14578 {
14579 char *groupmsg;
14580 if (asprintf (&groupmsg,
14581 ngettext ("linker stubs in %u group\n",
14582 "linker stubs in %u groups\n",
14583 stub_sec_count),
14584 stub_sec_count) < 0)
14585 *stats = NULL;
14586 else
14587 {
14588 if (asprintf (stats, _("%s"
14589 " branch %lu\n"
14590 " branch toc adj %lu\n"
14591 " branch notoc %lu\n"
14592 " branch both %lu\n"
14593 " long branch %lu\n"
14594 " long toc adj %lu\n"
14595 " long notoc %lu\n"
14596 " long both %lu\n"
14597 " plt call %lu\n"
14598 " plt call save %lu\n"
14599 " plt call notoc %lu\n"
14600 " plt call both %lu\n"
14601 " global entry %lu"),
14602 groupmsg,
14603 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch - 1],
14604 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off - 1],
14605 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc - 1],
14606 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_both - 1],
14607 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch - 1],
14608 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off - 1],
14609 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc - 1],
14610 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_both - 1],
14611 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call - 1],
14612 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save - 1],
14613 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc - 1],
14614 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_both - 1],
14615 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1]) < 0)
14616 *stats = NULL;
14617 free (groupmsg);
14618 }
14619 }
14620 return TRUE;
14621 }
14622
14623 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
14624 discarded sections. */
14625
14626 static unsigned int
14627 ppc64_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
14628 {
14629 if (strcmp (".opd", sec->name) == 0)
14630 return 0;
14631
14632 if (strcmp (".toc", sec->name) == 0)
14633 return 0;
14634
14635 if (strcmp (".toc1", sec->name) == 0)
14636 return 0;
14637
14638 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
14639 }
14640
14641 /* These are the dynamic relocations supported by glibc. */
14642
14643 static bfd_boolean
14644 ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
14645 {
14646 switch (r_type)
14647 {
14648 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
14649 case R_PPC64_NONE:
14650 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
14651 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
14652 case R_PPC64_IRELATIVE:
14653 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
14654 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
14655 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14656 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
14657 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14658 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14659 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
14660 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
14661 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
14662 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
14663 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
14664 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
14665 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
14666 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
14667 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
14668 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
14669 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14670 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
14671 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
14672 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
14673 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
14674 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
14675 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
14676 case R_PPC64_REL30:
14677 case R_PPC64_COPY:
14678 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
14679 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
14680 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
14681 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
14682 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
14683 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
14684 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
14685 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
14686 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
14687 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
14688 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
14689 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
14690 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14691 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14692 case R_PPC64_REL32:
14693 case R_PPC64_REL64:
14694 return TRUE;
14695
14696 default:
14697 return FALSE;
14698 }
14699 }
14700
14701 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
14702 to handle the relocations for a section.
14703
14704 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
14705 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
14706 zero.
14707
14708 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
14709 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
14710 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
14711 necessary.
14712
14713 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
14714 address or the reloc symbol index.
14715
14716 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
14717
14718 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
14719 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
14720
14721 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
14722 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
14723
14724 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
14725 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
14726 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
14727 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
14728 accordingly. */
14729
14730 static bfd_boolean
14731 ppc64_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
14732 struct bfd_link_info *info,
14733 bfd *input_bfd,
14734 asection *input_section,
14735 bfd_byte *contents,
14736 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
14737 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
14738 asection **local_sections)
14739 {
14740 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
14741 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14742 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
14743 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
14744 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
14745 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
14746 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
14747 bfd_byte *loc;
14748 struct got_entry **local_got_ents;
14749 bfd_vma TOCstart;
14750 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
14751 bfd_boolean is_opd;
14752 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
14753 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
14754 bfd_boolean warned_dynamic = FALSE;
14755 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
14756
14757 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
14758 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
14759 ppc_howto_init ();
14760
14761 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14762 if (htab == NULL)
14763 return FALSE;
14764
14765 /* Don't relocate stub sections. */
14766 if (input_section->owner == htab->params->stub_bfd)
14767 return TRUE;
14768
14769 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
14770 {
14771 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
14772 return FALSE;
14773 }
14774
14775 local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (input_bfd);
14776 TOCstart = elf_gp (output_bfd);
14777 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
14778 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
14779 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_type == sec_opd;
14780
14781 rel = wrel = relocs;
14782 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
14783 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
14784 {
14785 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
14786 bfd_vma addend;
14787 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
14788 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14789 asection *sec;
14790 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h_elf;
14791 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
14792 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
14793 const char *sym_name;
14794 unsigned long r_symndx, toc_symndx;
14795 bfd_vma toc_addend;
14796 unsigned char tls_mask, tls_gd, tls_type;
14797 unsigned char sym_type;
14798 bfd_vma relocation;
14799 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
14800 bfd_boolean warned;
14801 enum { DEST_NORMAL, DEST_OPD, DEST_STUB } reloc_dest;
14802 unsigned int insn;
14803 unsigned int mask;
14804 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
14805 bfd_vma max_br_offset;
14806 bfd_vma from;
14807 Elf_Internal_Rela orig_rel;
14808 reloc_howto_type *howto;
14809 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
14810 uint64_t pinsn;
14811 bfd_vma offset;
14812
14813 again:
14814 orig_rel = *rel;
14815
14816 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
14817 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
14818
14819 /* For old style R_PPC64_TOC relocs with a zero symbol, use the
14820 symbol of the previous ADDR64 reloc. The symbol gives us the
14821 proper TOC base to use. */
14822 if (rel->r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC)
14823 && wrel != relocs
14824 && ELF64_R_TYPE (wrel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
14825 && is_opd)
14826 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (wrel[-1].r_info);
14827
14828 sym = NULL;
14829 sec = NULL;
14830 h_elf = NULL;
14831 sym_name = NULL;
14832 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14833 warned = FALSE;
14834
14835 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
14836 {
14837 /* It's a local symbol. */
14838 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
14839
14840 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
14841 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
14842 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
14843 sym_type = ELF64_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
14844 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
14845 opd = get_opd_info (sec);
14846 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
14847 {
14848 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value
14849 + rel->r_addend)];
14850 if (adjust == -1)
14851 relocation = 0;
14852 else
14853 {
14854 /* If this is a relocation against the opd section sym
14855 and we have edited .opd, adjust the reloc addend so
14856 that ld -r and ld --emit-relocs output is correct.
14857 If it is a reloc against some other .opd symbol,
14858 then the symbol value will be adjusted later. */
14859 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
14860 rel->r_addend += adjust;
14861 else
14862 relocation += adjust;
14863 }
14864 }
14865 }
14866 else
14867 {
14868 bfd_boolean ignored;
14869
14870 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
14871 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
14872 h_elf, sec, relocation,
14873 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
14874 sym_name = h_elf->root.root.string;
14875 sym_type = h_elf->type;
14876 if (sec != NULL
14877 && sec->owner == output_bfd
14878 && strcmp (sec->name, ".opd") == 0)
14879 {
14880 /* This is a symbol defined in a linker script. All
14881 such are defined in output sections, even those
14882 defined by simple assignment from a symbol defined in
14883 an input section. Transfer the symbol to an
14884 appropriate input .opd section, so that a branch to
14885 this symbol will be mapped to the location specified
14886 by the opd entry. */
14887 struct bfd_link_order *lo;
14888 for (lo = sec->map_head.link_order; lo != NULL; lo = lo->next)
14889 if (lo->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
14890 {
14891 asection *isec = lo->u.indirect.section;
14892 if (h_elf->root.u.def.value >= isec->output_offset
14893 && h_elf->root.u.def.value < (isec->output_offset
14894 + isec->size))
14895 {
14896 h_elf->root.u.def.value -= isec->output_offset;
14897 h_elf->root.u.def.section = isec;
14898 sec = isec;
14899 break;
14900 }
14901 }
14902 }
14903 }
14904 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h_elf);
14905
14906 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
14907 {
14908 _bfd_clear_contents (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type],
14909 input_bfd, input_section,
14910 contents, rel->r_offset);
14911 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
14912 wrel->r_info = 0;
14913 wrel->r_addend = 0;
14914
14915 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
14916 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
14917 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
14918 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
14919 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
14920 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
14921 wrel--;
14922
14923 continue;
14924 }
14925
14926 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14927 goto copy_reloc;
14928
14929 if (h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
14930 {
14931 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14932 sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
14933 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14934 }
14935
14936 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
14937 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
14938 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
14939 for the final instruction stream. */
14940 tls_mask = 0;
14941 tls_gd = 0;
14942 toc_symndx = 0;
14943 if (h != NULL)
14944 tls_mask = h->tls_mask;
14945 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
14946 {
14947 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
14948 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14949 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
14950 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14951 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
14952 }
14953 if (((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0 || tls_mask == (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
14954 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14955 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14956 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14957 {
14958 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
14959 unsigned char *toc_tls;
14960
14961 if (!get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
14962 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
14963 return FALSE;
14964
14965 if (toc_tls)
14966 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
14967 }
14968
14969 /* Check that tls relocs are used with tls syms, and non-tls
14970 relocs are used with non-tls syms. */
14971 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
14972 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE
14973 && (h == NULL
14974 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14975 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
14976 && IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
14977 {
14978 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14979 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14980 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14981 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14982 /* R_PPC64_TLS is OK against a symbol in the TOC. */
14983 ;
14984 else
14985 info->callbacks->einfo
14986 (!IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
14987 /* xgettext:c-format */
14988 ? _("%H: %s used with TLS symbol `%pT'\n")
14989 /* xgettext:c-format */
14990 : _("%H: %s used with non-TLS symbol `%pT'\n"),
14991 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
14992 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
14993 sym_name);
14994 }
14995
14996 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
14997 if (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS != R_PPC64_TOC16_DS + 1
14998 || R_PPC64_TOC16_LO != R_PPC64_TOC16 + 1
14999 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
15000 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
15001 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
15002 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
15003 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS & 3)
15004 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS & 3)
15005 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
15006 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
15007 abort ();
15008
15009 switch (r_type)
15010 {
15011 default:
15012 break;
15013
15014 case R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT:
15015 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15016 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 58u << 26)
15017 abort ();
15018 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15019 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15020 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
15021 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15022 break;
15023
15024 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
15025 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
15026 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
15027 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
15028 {
15029 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
15030 unsigned char *toc_tls;
15031 int retval;
15032
15033 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
15034 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd);
15035 if (retval == 0)
15036 return FALSE;
15037
15038 if (toc_tls)
15039 {
15040 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
15041 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_DS
15042 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS)
15043 {
15044 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15045 && (tls_mask & (TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) == 0)
15046 goto toctprel;
15047 }
15048 else
15049 {
15050 /* If we found a GD reloc pair, then we might be
15051 doing a GD->IE transition. */
15052 if (retval == 2)
15053 {
15054 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15055 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15056 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15057 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15058 }
15059 else if (retval == 3)
15060 {
15061 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15062 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15063 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15064 }
15065 }
15066 }
15067 }
15068 break;
15069
15070 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
15071 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15072 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15073 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15074 {
15075 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15076 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15077 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15078 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15079 }
15080 break;
15081
15082 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15083 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15084 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15085 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15086 {
15087 toctprel:
15088 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15089 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15090 insn &= 31 << 21;
15091 insn |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis 0,13,0 */
15092 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
15093 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15094 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15095 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15096 {
15097 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15098 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15099 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15100 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15101 goto again;
15102 }
15103 else
15104 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15105 }
15106 break;
15107
15108 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
15109 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15110 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15111 {
15112 /* pld ra,sym@got@tprel@pcrel -> paddi ra,r13,sym@tprel */
15113 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15114 pinsn <<= 32;
15115 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15116 pinsn += ((2ULL << 56) + (-1ULL << 52)
15117 + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26) + (13ULL << 16));
15118 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15119 contents + rel->r_offset);
15120 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15121 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15122 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15123 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15124 }
15125 break;
15126
15127 case R_PPC64_TLS:
15128 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15129 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15130 {
15131 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15132 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 13);
15133 if (insn == 0)
15134 break;
15135 if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 0)
15136 {
15137 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15138 /* Was PPC64_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
15139 PPC64_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
15140 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
15141 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15142 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15143 {
15144 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15145 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15146 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15147 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15148 goto again;
15149 }
15150 else
15151 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15152 }
15153 else if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 1)
15154 {
15155 /* For pcrel IE to LE we already have the full
15156 offset and thus don't need an addi here. A nop
15157 or mr will do. */
15158 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14 << 26)
15159 {
15160 /* Extract regs from addi rt,ra,si. */
15161 unsigned int rt = (insn >> 21) & 0x1f;
15162 unsigned int ra = (insn >> 16) & 0x1f;
15163 if (rt == ra)
15164 insn = NOP;
15165 else
15166 {
15167 /* Build or ra,rs,rb with rb==rs, ie. mr ra,rs. */
15168 insn = (rt << 16) | (ra << 21) | (ra << 11);
15169 insn |= (31u << 26) | (444u << 1);
15170 }
15171 }
15172 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - 1);
15173 }
15174 }
15175 break;
15176
15177 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15178 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15179 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15180 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15181 goto tls_gdld_hi;
15182 break;
15183
15184 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15185 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15186 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15187 {
15188 tls_gdld_hi:
15189 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15190 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
15191 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15192 else
15193 {
15194 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15195 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15196 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15197 }
15198 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15199 }
15200 break;
15201
15202 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
15203 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15204 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15205 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15206 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15207 break;
15208
15209 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
15210 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15211 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15212 {
15213 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15214
15215 tls_ldgd_opt:
15216 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
15217 /* If not using the newer R_PPC64_TLSGD/LD to mark
15218 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
15219 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
15220 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
15221 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
15222 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
15223 && rel + 1 < relend
15224 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
15225 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
15226 htab->tga_desc_fd,
15227 htab->tls_get_addr,
15228 htab->tga_desc))
15229 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
15230 /* We read the low GOT_TLS (or TOC16) insn because we
15231 need to keep the destination reg. It may be
15232 something other than the usual r3, and moved to r3
15233 before the call by intervening code. */
15234 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15235 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15236 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15237 {
15238 /* IE */
15239 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
15240 insn1 |= 58u << 26; /* ld */
15241 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15242 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15243 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15244 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16
15245 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO)
15246 r_type += R_PPC64_TOC16_DS - R_PPC64_TOC16;
15247 else
15248 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 1)) & 1)
15249 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15250 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15251 }
15252 else
15253 {
15254 /* LE */
15255 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
15256 insn1 |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis r,13,0 */
15257 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15258 if (tls_gd == 0)
15259 {
15260 /* Was an LD reloc. */
15261 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15262 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15263 }
15264 else if (toc_symndx != 0)
15265 {
15266 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15267 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15268 }
15269 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15270 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15271 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15272 {
15273 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx,
15274 R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO);
15275 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15276 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
15277 }
15278 }
15279 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
15280 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15281 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15282 {
15283 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15284 if (offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15285 {
15286 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15287 if (insn2 == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15289 }
15290 }
15291 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) == 0
15292 && (tls_gd == 0 || toc_symndx != 0))
15293 {
15294 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order
15295 to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15296 goto again;
15297 }
15298 }
15299 break;
15300
15301 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
15302 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15303 {
15304 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15305 pinsn <<= 32;
15306 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15307 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15308 {
15309 /* IE, pla -> pld */
15310 pinsn += (-2ULL << 56) + (57ULL << 26) - (14ULL << 26);
15311 r_type = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34;
15312 }
15313 else
15314 {
15315 /* LE, pla pcrel -> paddi r13 */
15316 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15317 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15318 }
15319 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15320 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15321 contents + rel->r_offset);
15322 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15323 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15324 }
15325 break;
15326
15327 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
15328 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15329 {
15330 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15331 pinsn <<= 32;
15332 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15333 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15334 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15335 contents + rel->r_offset);
15336 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15337 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15338 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15339 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15340 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15341 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15342 goto again;
15343 }
15344 break;
15345
15346 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
15347 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
15348 && rel + 1 < relend)
15349 {
15350 unsigned int insn2;
15351 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15352
15353 offset = rel->r_offset;
15354 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15355 {
15356 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15357 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15358 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15359 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15360 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15361 break;
15362 }
15363
15364 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15365 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15366
15367 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15368 {
15369 /* IE */
15370 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15371 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15372 }
15373 else
15374 {
15375 /* LE */
15376 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15377 {
15378 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15379 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15380 }
15381 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15382 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15383 {
15384 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15385 insn2 = NOP;
15386 }
15387 else
15388 {
15389 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15390 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15391 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15392 }
15393 }
15394 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15395 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15396 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15397 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15398 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15399 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) == 0
15400 && toc_symndx != 0
15401 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15402 goto again;
15403 }
15404 break;
15405
15406 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
15407 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
15408 && rel + 1 < relend)
15409 {
15410 unsigned int insn2;
15411 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15412
15413 offset = rel->r_offset;
15414 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15415 {
15416 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15417 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15418 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15419 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15420 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15421 break;
15422 }
15423
15424 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15425 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15426
15427 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15428 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15429 {
15430 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15431 insn2 = NOP;
15432 }
15433 else
15434 {
15435 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15436 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15437 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15438 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15439 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15440 }
15441 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15442 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15443 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15444 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15445 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15446 if (r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15447 goto again;
15448 }
15449 break;
15450
15451 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
15452 if (rel + 1 < relend
15453 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
15454 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
15455 {
15456 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15457 {
15458 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_NONE);
15459 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15460 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
15461 else
15462 {
15463 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15464 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15465 }
15466 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15467 }
15468 }
15469 else
15470 {
15471 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15472 {
15473 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15474 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15475 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15476 }
15477 }
15478 break;
15479
15480 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
15481 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15482 {
15483 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15484 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15485 }
15486 break;
15487
15488 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
15489 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15490 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15491 && !info->traditional_format
15492 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15493 {
15494 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15495
15496 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15497 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15498 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15499 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15500 {
15501 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15502 LIS_R2 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15503 contents + rel->r_offset);
15504 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15505 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15506 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15507 }
15508 }
15509 else
15510 {
15511 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
15512 + input_section->output_offset
15513 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15514 if (relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15515 {
15516 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15517
15518 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15519 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15520 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15521 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15522 {
15523 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15524 ADDIS_R2_R12 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15525 contents + rel->r_offset);
15526 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15527 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15528 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15529 }
15530 }
15531 }
15532 break;
15533
15534 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15535 /* If we are generating a non-PIC executable, edit
15536 . 0: addis 2,12,.TOC.-0b@ha
15537 . addi 2,2,.TOC.-0b@l
15538 used by ELFv2 global entry points to set up r2, to
15539 . lis 2,.TOC.@ha
15540 . addi 2,2,.TOC.@l
15541 if .TOC. is in range. */
15542 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15543 && !info->traditional_format
15544 && !htab->opd_abi
15545 && rel->r_addend == d_offset
15546 && h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot
15547 && rel + 1 < relend
15548 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_REL16_LO)
15549 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15550 && rel[1].r_addend == rel->r_addend + 4
15551 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15552 {
15553 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15554 offset = rel->r_offset - d_offset;
15555 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15556 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15557 if ((insn1 & 0xffff0000) == ADDIS_R2_R12
15558 && (insn2 & 0xffff0000) == ADDI_R2_R2)
15559 {
15560 r_type = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
15561 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15562 rel->r_addend -= d_offset;
15563 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO);
15564 rel[1].r_addend -= d_offset + 4;
15565 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, LIS_R2, contents + offset);
15566 }
15567 }
15568 break;
15569 }
15570
15571 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
15572 insn = 0;
15573 max_br_offset = 1 << 25;
15574 addend = rel->r_addend;
15575 reloc_dest = DEST_NORMAL;
15576 switch (r_type)
15577 {
15578 default:
15579 break;
15580
15581 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15582 if (relocation + addend == (rel->r_offset
15583 + input_section->output_offset
15584 + input_section->output_section->vma)
15585 && tocsave_find (htab, NO_INSERT,
15586 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
15587 {
15588 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15589 if (insn == NOP
15590 || insn == CROR_151515 || insn == CROR_313131)
15591 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15592 STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15593 contents + rel->r_offset);
15594 }
15595 break;
15596
15597 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
15598 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
15599 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
15600 insn = 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
15601 /* Fall through. */
15602
15603 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
15604 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
15605 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
15606 insn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15607 contents + rel->r_offset) & ~(0x01 << 21);
15608 /* Fall through. */
15609
15610 case R_PPC64_REL14:
15611 max_br_offset = 1 << 15;
15612 /* Fall through. */
15613
15614 case R_PPC64_REL24:
15615 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
15616 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15617 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
15618 /* Calls to functions with a different TOC, such as calls to
15619 shared objects, need to alter the TOC pointer. This is
15620 done using a linkage stub. A REL24 branching to these
15621 linkage stubs needs to be followed by a nop, as the nop
15622 will be replaced with an instruction to restore the TOC
15623 base pointer. */
15624 fdh = h;
15625 if (h != NULL
15626 && h->oh != NULL
15627 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
15628 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
15629 stub_entry = ppc_get_stub_entry (input_section, sec, fdh, &orig_rel,
15630 htab);
15631 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
15632 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15633 && stub_entry != NULL
15634 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15635 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15636 stub_entry = NULL;
15637
15638 if (stub_entry != NULL
15639 && ((stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15640 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15641 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15642 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15643 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15644 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both))
15645 {
15646 bfd_boolean can_plt_call = FALSE;
15647
15648 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15649 && !htab->opd_abi
15650 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
15651 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&h->elf))
15652 {
15653 /* The function doesn't use or change r2. */
15654 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15655 }
15656 else if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15657 {
15658 /* NOTOC calls don't need to restore r2. */
15659 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15660 }
15661
15662 /* All of these stubs may modify r2, so there must be a
15663 branch and link followed by a nop. The nop is
15664 replaced by an insn to restore r2. */
15665 else if (rel->r_offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15666 {
15667 unsigned long br;
15668
15669 br = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15670 contents + rel->r_offset);
15671 if ((br & 1) != 0)
15672 {
15673 unsigned long nop;
15674
15675 nop = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15676 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15677 if (nop == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15678 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15679 else if (nop == NOP
15680 || nop == CROR_151515
15681 || nop == CROR_313131)
15682 {
15683 if (h != NULL
15684 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)
15685 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15686 {
15687 /* Special stub used, leave nop alone. */
15688 }
15689 else
15690 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15691 LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15692 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15693 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15694 }
15695 }
15696 }
15697
15698 if (!can_plt_call && h != NULL)
15699 {
15700 const char *name = h->elf.root.root.string;
15701
15702 if (*name == '.')
15703 ++name;
15704
15705 if (strncmp (name, "__libc_start_main", 17) == 0
15706 && (name[17] == 0 || name[17] == '@'))
15707 {
15708 /* Allow crt1 branch to go via a toc adjusting
15709 stub. Other calls that never return could do
15710 the same, if we could detect such. */
15711 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15712 }
15713 }
15714
15715 if (!can_plt_call)
15716 {
15717 /* g++ as of 20130507 emits self-calls without a
15718 following nop. This is arguably wrong since we
15719 have conflicting information. On the one hand a
15720 global symbol and on the other a local call
15721 sequence, but don't error for this special case.
15722 It isn't possible to cheaply verify we have
15723 exactly such a call. Allow all calls to the same
15724 section. */
15725 asection *code_sec = sec;
15726
15727 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15728 {
15729 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15730 - sec->output_section->vma
15731 - sec->output_offset);
15732
15733 opd_entry_value (sec, off, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
15734 }
15735 if (code_sec == input_section)
15736 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15737 }
15738
15739 if (!can_plt_call)
15740 {
15741 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15742 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15743 info->callbacks->einfo
15744 /* xgettext:c-format */
15745 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15746 "(plt call stub)\n"),
15747 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15748 else
15749 info->callbacks->einfo
15750 /* xgettext:c-format */
15751 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15752 "(toc save/adjust stub)\n"),
15753 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15754
15755 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15756 ret = FALSE;
15757 }
15758
15759 if (can_plt_call
15760 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15761 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15762 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15763 }
15764
15765 if ((stub_entry == NULL
15766 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15767 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15768 && get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15769 {
15770 /* The branch destination is the value of the opd entry. */
15771 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15772 - sec->output_section->vma
15773 - sec->output_offset);
15774 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (sec, off, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
15775 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
15776 {
15777 relocation = dest;
15778 addend = 0;
15779 reloc_dest = DEST_OPD;
15780 }
15781 }
15782
15783 /* If the branch is out of reach we ought to have a long
15784 branch stub. */
15785 from = (rel->r_offset
15786 + input_section->output_offset
15787 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15788
15789 relocation += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (fdh
15790 ? fdh->elf.other
15791 : sym->st_other);
15792
15793 if (stub_entry != NULL
15794 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15795 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15796 && (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
15797 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
15798 || (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15799 < 2 * max_br_offset)))
15800 /* Don't use the stub if this branch is in range. */
15801 stub_entry = NULL;
15802
15803 if (stub_entry != NULL
15804 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
15805 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15806 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
15807 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15808 && (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15809 || ((fdh ? fdh->elf.other : sym->st_other)
15810 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK) <= 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)
15811 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15812 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15813 stub_entry = NULL;
15814
15815 if (stub_entry != NULL
15816 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15817 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15818 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15819 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15820 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15821 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15822 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15823 stub_entry = NULL;
15824
15825 if (stub_entry != NULL)
15826 {
15827 /* Munge up the value and addend so that we call the stub
15828 rather than the procedure directly. */
15829 asection *stub_sec = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
15830
15831 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_save_res)
15832 relocation += (stub_sec->output_offset
15833 + stub_sec->output_section->vma
15834 + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
15835 - htab->sfpr->output_offset
15836 - htab->sfpr->output_section->vma);
15837 else
15838 relocation = (stub_entry->stub_offset
15839 + stub_sec->output_offset
15840 + stub_sec->output_section->vma);
15841 addend = 0;
15842 reloc_dest = DEST_STUB;
15843
15844 if (((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15845 && ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE)
15846 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
15847 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15848 && !(h != NULL
15849 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)
15850 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15851 && rel + 1 < relend
15852 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15853 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE)
15854 relocation += 4;
15855 else if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15856 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15857 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15858 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15859 relocation += 4;
15860
15861 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15862 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
15863 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both))
15864 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
15865 }
15866
15867 if (insn != 0)
15868 {
15869 if (is_isa_v2)
15870 {
15871 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
15872 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
15873 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
15874 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
15875 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
15876 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
15877 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
15878 else
15879 break;
15880 }
15881 else
15882 {
15883 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
15884 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + addend - from) < 0)
15885 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
15886 }
15887
15888 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15889 }
15890
15891 /* NOP out calls to undefined weak functions.
15892 We can thus call a weak function without first
15893 checking whether the function is defined. */
15894 else if (h != NULL
15895 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
15896 && h->elf.dynindx == -1
15897 && (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
15898 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15899 && relocation == 0
15900 && addend == 0)
15901 {
15902 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15903 goto copy_reloc;
15904 }
15905 break;
15906
15907 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
15908 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
15909 break;
15910 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15911 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x8000 < 0x10000
15912 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15913 {
15914 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15915 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15916 {
15917 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15918 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15919 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16;
15920 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15921 }
15922 }
15923 break;
15924
15925 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15926 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15927 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
15928 break;
15929 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15930 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL
15931 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15932 {
15933 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15934 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15935 {
15936 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15937 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15938 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
15939 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15940 }
15941 else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */)
15942 {
15943 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
15944 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15945 }
15946 }
15947 break;
15948
15949 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
15950 if ((h ? h->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info)) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
15951 break;
15952 from = (rel->r_offset
15953 + input_section->output_section->vma
15954 + input_section->output_offset);
15955 if (relocation - from + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34
15956 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15957 {
15958 offset = rel->r_offset;
15959 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15960 pinsn <<= 32;
15961 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15962 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15963 == ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52) | (57ULL << 26) /* pld */))
15964 {
15965 /* Replace with paddi. */
15966 pinsn += (2ULL << 56) + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26);
15967 r_type = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
15968 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15969 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + offset);
15970 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + offset + 4);
15971 goto pcrelopt;
15972 }
15973 }
15974 break;
15975
15976 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
15977 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15978 {
15979 offset = rel->r_offset;
15980 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15981 pinsn <<= 32;
15982 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15983 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15984 == ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
15985 | (14ULL << 26) /* paddi */))
15986 {
15987 pcrelopt:
15988 if (rel + 1 < relend
15989 && rel[1].r_offset == offset
15990 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT))
15991 {
15992 bfd_vma off2 = rel[1].r_addend;
15993 if (off2 == 0)
15994 /* zero means next insn. */
15995 off2 = 8;
15996 off2 += offset;
15997 if (off2 + 4 <= input_section->size)
15998 {
15999 uint64_t pinsn2;
16000 bfd_signed_vma addend_off;
16001 pinsn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + off2);
16002 pinsn2 <<= 32;
16003 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
16004 {
16005 if (off2 + 8 > input_section->size)
16006 break;
16007 pinsn2 |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
16008 contents + off2 + 4);
16009 }
16010 if (xlate_pcrel_opt (&pinsn, &pinsn2, &addend_off))
16011 {
16012 addend += addend_off;
16013 rel->r_addend = addend;
16014 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
16015 contents + offset);
16016 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn,
16017 contents + offset + 4);
16018 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2 >> 32,
16019 contents + off2);
16020 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
16021 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2,
16022 contents + off2 + 4);
16023 }
16024 }
16025 }
16026 }
16027 }
16028 break;
16029 }
16030
16031 tls_type = 0;
16032 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
16033 switch (r_type)
16034 {
16035 default:
16036 /* xgettext:c-format */
16037 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
16038 input_bfd, ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
16039
16040 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16041 ret = FALSE;
16042 goto copy_reloc;
16043
16044 case R_PPC64_NONE:
16045 case R_PPC64_TLS:
16046 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
16047 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
16048 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
16049 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
16050 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
16051 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
16052 case R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT:
16053 goto copy_reloc;
16054
16055 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
16056 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
16057 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
16058 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
16059 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
16060 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
16061 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
16062 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16063 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
16064 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
16065 goto dogot;
16066
16067 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
16068 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
16069 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16070 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16071 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
16072 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
16073 goto dogot;
16074
16075 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
16076 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16077 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
16078 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16079 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
16080 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
16081 goto dogot;
16082
16083 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
16084 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16085 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16086 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16087 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
16088 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
16089 goto dogot;
16090
16091 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
16092 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16093 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16094 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16095 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16096 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16097 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
16098 dogot:
16099 {
16100 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
16101 offset table. */
16102 asection *got;
16103 bfd_vma *offp;
16104 bfd_vma off;
16105 unsigned long indx = 0;
16106 struct got_entry *ent;
16107
16108 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
16109 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
16110 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (input_bfd);
16111 else
16112 {
16113 if (h != NULL)
16114 {
16115 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
16116 || h->elf.dynindx == -1
16117 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16118 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16119 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
16120 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
16121 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
16122 because of a version file. */
16123 ;
16124 else
16125 {
16126 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16127 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16128 }
16129 ent = h->elf.got.glist;
16130 }
16131 else
16132 {
16133 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
16134 abort ();
16135 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
16136 }
16137
16138 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16139 if (ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend
16140 && ent->owner == input_bfd
16141 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
16142 break;
16143 }
16144
16145 if (ent == NULL)
16146 abort ();
16147 if (ent->is_indirect)
16148 ent = ent->got.ent;
16149 offp = &ent->got.offset;
16150 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->got;
16151 if (got == NULL)
16152 abort ();
16153
16154 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8. We use the
16155 least significant bit to record whether we have already
16156 processed this entry. */
16157 off = *offp;
16158 if ((off & 1) != 0)
16159 off &= ~1;
16160 else
16161 {
16162 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker, except in
16163 the case of TLSLD where we'll use one entry per
16164 module. */
16165 asection *relgot;
16166 bfd_boolean ifunc;
16167
16168 *offp = off | 1;
16169 relgot = NULL;
16170 ifunc = (h != NULL
16171 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16172 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
16173 if (ifunc)
16174 {
16175 relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
16176 if (indx == 0 || is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16177 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = TRUE;
16178 }
16179 else if (indx != 0
16180 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
16181 && (h == NULL
16182 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16183 && !(tls_type != 0
16184 && bfd_link_executable (info)
16185 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))))
16186 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->relgot;
16187 if (relgot != NULL)
16188 {
16189 outrel.r_offset = (got->output_section->vma
16190 + got->output_offset
16191 + off);
16192 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16193 if (tls_type & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
16194 {
16195 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16196 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64);
16197 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
16198 {
16199 loc = relgot->contents;
16200 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16201 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16202 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
16203 &outrel, loc);
16204 outrel.r_offset += 8;
16205 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16206 outrel.r_info
16207 = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16208 }
16209 }
16210 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
16211 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16212 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
16213 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_TPREL64);
16214 else if (indx != 0)
16215 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT);
16216 else
16217 {
16218 if (ifunc)
16219 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16220 else
16221 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16222
16223 /* Write the .got section contents for the sake
16224 of prelink. */
16225 loc = got->contents + off;
16226 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend + relocation,
16227 loc);
16228 }
16229
16230 if (indx == 0 && tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
16231 {
16232 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16233 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
16234 {
16235 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16236 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16237 else
16238 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
16239 }
16240 }
16241 loc = relgot->contents;
16242 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16243 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16244 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16245 }
16246
16247 /* Init the .got section contents here if we're not
16248 emitting a reloc. */
16249 else
16250 {
16251 relocation += orig_rel.r_addend;
16252 if (tls_type != 0)
16253 {
16254 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16255 relocation = 0;
16256 else
16257 {
16258 if (tls_type & TLS_LD)
16259 relocation = 0;
16260 else
16261 relocation -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16262 if (tls_type & TLS_TPREL)
16263 relocation += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
16264 }
16265
16266 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD))
16267 {
16268 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16269 got->contents + off + 8);
16270 relocation = 1;
16271 }
16272 }
16273 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16274 got->contents + off);
16275 }
16276 }
16277
16278 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
16279 abort ();
16280
16281 relocation = got->output_section->vma + got->output_offset + off;
16282 addend = 0;
16283 if (!(r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34
16284 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34
16285 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34
16286 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34
16287 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34))
16288 addend = -(TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16289 }
16290 break;
16291
16292 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16293 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
16294 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16295 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16296 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16297 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16298 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
16299 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
16300 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16301 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16302 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16303 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16304 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
16305 procedure linkage table. */
16306 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
16307 {
16308 struct plt_entry **plt_list = NULL;
16309 if (h != NULL)
16310 plt_list = &h->elf.plt.plist;
16311 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
16312 {
16313 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
16314 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
16315 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
16316 }
16317 if (plt_list)
16318 {
16319 struct plt_entry *ent;
16320
16321 for (ent = *plt_list; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16322 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
16323 && ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend)
16324 {
16325 asection *plt;
16326 bfd_vma got;
16327
16328 plt = htab->elf.splt;
16329 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
16330 || h == NULL
16331 || h->elf.dynindx == -1)
16332 {
16333 if (h != NULL
16334 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16335 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16336 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
16337 else
16338 plt = htab->pltlocal;
16339 }
16340 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
16341 + plt->output_offset
16342 + ent->plt.offset);
16343 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
16344 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
16345 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
16346 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS)
16347 {
16348 got = (elf_gp (output_bfd)
16349 + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16350 relocation -= got;
16351 }
16352 addend = 0;
16353 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16354 break;
16355 }
16356 }
16357 }
16358 break;
16359
16360 case R_PPC64_TOC:
16361 /* Relocation value is TOC base. */
16362 relocation = TOCstart;
16363 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
16364 relocation += htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16365 else if (unresolved_reloc)
16366 ;
16367 else if (sec != NULL && sec->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
16368 relocation += htab->sec_info[sec->id].toc_off;
16369 else
16370 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
16371 goto dodyn;
16372
16373 /* TOC16 relocs. We want the offset relative to the TOC base,
16374 which is the address of the start of the TOC plus 0x8000.
16375 The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, and .plt,
16376 in this order. */
16377 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
16378 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16379 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16380 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
16381 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16382 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16383 addend -= TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16384 if (h != NULL)
16385 goto dodyn;
16386 break;
16387
16388 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
16389 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
16390 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
16391 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
16392 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
16393 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
16394 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16395 if (sec != NULL)
16396 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
16397 break;
16398
16399 case R_PPC64_REL16:
16400 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
16401 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
16402 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16403 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
16404 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16405 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
16406 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16407 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
16408 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16409 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
16410 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16411 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
16412 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16413 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16414 case R_PPC64_REL14:
16415 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
16416 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
16417 case R_PPC64_REL24:
16418 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
16419 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
16420 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
16421 break;
16422
16423 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
16424 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16425 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
16426 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16427 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
16428 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16429 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
16430 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16431 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
16432 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16433 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
16434 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16435 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
16436 if (h != NULL
16437 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
16438 && h->elf.dynindx == -1)
16439 {
16440 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
16441 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
16442 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
16443 defined before using them. */
16444 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
16445
16446 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16447 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 13);
16448 if (insn != 0)
16449 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16450 break;
16451 }
16452 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16453 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16454 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
16455 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
16456 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
16457 goto dodyn;
16458
16459 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
16460 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
16461 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
16462 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16463 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
16464 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16465 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
16466 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16467 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
16468 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16469 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
16470 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16471 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
16472 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16473 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16474 break;
16475
16476 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
16477 addend += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h != NULL
16478 ? h->elf.other
16479 : sym->st_other);
16480 break;
16481
16482 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
16483 relocation = 1;
16484 addend = 0;
16485 goto dodyn;
16486
16487 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
16488 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16489 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16490 goto dodyn;
16491
16492 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
16493 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16494 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16495 /* Fall through. */
16496
16497 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a
16498 dynamic object. */
16499 case R_PPC64_REL30:
16500 case R_PPC64_REL32:
16501 case R_PPC64_REL64:
16502 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
16503 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
16504 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
16505 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
16506 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16507 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16508 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
16509 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
16510 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16511 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
16512 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16513 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
16514 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16515 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
16516 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16517 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
16518 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16519 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
16520 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16521 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
16522 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
16523 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
16524 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
16525 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
16526 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
16527 case R_PPC64_D34:
16528 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
16529 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
16530 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16531 case R_PPC64_D28:
16532 dodyn:
16533 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
16534 break;
16535
16536 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
16537 break;
16538
16539 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
16540 ? ((h == NULL
16541 || h->elf.dyn_relocs != NULL)
16542 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
16543 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
16544 : (h != NULL
16545 ? h->elf.dyn_relocs != NULL
16546 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16547 {
16548 bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
16549 asection *sreloc;
16550 bfd_vma out_off;
16551 long indx = 0;
16552
16553 /* When generating a dynamic object, these relocations
16554 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
16555 time. */
16556
16557 skip = FALSE;
16558 relocate = FALSE;
16559
16560 out_off = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
16561 input_section, rel->r_offset);
16562 if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -1)
16563 skip = TRUE;
16564 else if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -2)
16565 skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
16566 out_off += (input_section->output_section->vma
16567 + input_section->output_offset);
16568 outrel.r_offset = out_off;
16569 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
16570
16571 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
16572 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 && (out_off & 7) != 0)
16573 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR64 && (out_off & 7) == 0))
16574 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR64 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR64;
16575 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR32 && (out_off & 3) != 0)
16576 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR32 && (out_off & 3) == 0))
16577 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR32;
16578 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16 && (out_off & 1) != 0)
16579 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR16 && (out_off & 1) == 0))
16580 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR16;
16581
16582 if (skip)
16583 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
16584 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16585 && !is_opd
16586 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC)
16587 {
16588 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16589 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
16590 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16591 }
16592 else
16593 {
16594 /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local,
16595 or this is an opd section reloc which must point
16596 at a local function. */
16597 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16598 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC)
16599 {
16600 if (is_opd && h != NULL)
16601 {
16602 /* Lie about opd entries. This case occurs
16603 when building shared libraries and we
16604 reference a function in another shared
16605 lib. The same thing happens for a weak
16606 definition in an application that's
16607 overridden by a strong definition in a
16608 shared lib. (I believe this is a generic
16609 bug in binutils handling of weak syms.)
16610 In these cases we won't use the opd
16611 entry in this lib. */
16612 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16613 }
16614 if (!is_opd
16615 && r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
16616 && (h != NULL
16617 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16618 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16619 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16620 else
16621 {
16622 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16623
16624 /* We need to relocate .opd contents for ld.so.
16625 Prelink also wants simple and consistent rules
16626 for relocs. This make all RELATIVE relocs have
16627 *r_offset equal to r_addend. */
16628 relocate = TRUE;
16629 }
16630 }
16631 else
16632 {
16633 if (h != NULL
16634 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16635 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16636 {
16637 info->callbacks->einfo
16638 /* xgettext:c-format */
16639 (_("%H: %s for indirect "
16640 "function `%pT' unsupported\n"),
16641 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16642 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16643 sym_name);
16644 ret = FALSE;
16645 }
16646 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
16647 ;
16648 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
16649 {
16650 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16651 return FALSE;
16652 }
16653 else
16654 {
16655 asection *osec = sec->output_section;
16656
16657 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
16658 {
16659 /* TLS symbol values are relative to the
16660 TLS segment. Dynamic relocations for
16661 local TLS symbols therefore can't be
16662 reduced to a relocation against their
16663 section symbol because it holds the
16664 address of the section, not a value
16665 relative to the TLS segment. We could
16666 change the .tdata dynamic section symbol
16667 to be zero value but STN_UNDEF works
16668 and is used elsewhere, eg. for TPREL64
16669 GOT relocs against local TLS symbols. */
16670 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
16671 indx = 0;
16672 }
16673 else
16674 {
16675 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16676 if (indx == 0)
16677 {
16678 if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
16679 && htab->elf.data_index_section != NULL)
16680 osec = htab->elf.data_index_section;
16681 else
16682 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
16683 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16684 }
16685 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
16686 }
16687
16688 /* We are turning this relocation into one
16689 against a section symbol, so subtract out
16690 the output section's address but not the
16691 offset of the input section in the output
16692 section. */
16693 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
16694 }
16695
16696 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16697 }
16698 }
16699
16700 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
16701 if (h != NULL
16702 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16703 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16704 {
16705 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
16706 if (indx == 0 || is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16707 htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers = TRUE;
16708 }
16709 if (sreloc == NULL)
16710 abort ();
16711
16712 if (sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)
16713 >= sreloc->size)
16714 abort ();
16715 loc = sreloc->contents;
16716 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
16717 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16718
16719 if (!warned_dynamic
16720 && !ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)))
16721 {
16722 info->callbacks->einfo
16723 /* xgettext:c-format */
16724 (_("%X%P: %pB: %s against %pT "
16725 "is not supported by glibc as a dynamic relocation\n"),
16726 input_bfd,
16727 ppc64_elf_howto_table[ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)]->name,
16728 sym_name);
16729 warned_dynamic = TRUE;
16730 }
16731
16732 /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, it will
16733 be computed at runtime, so there's no need to do
16734 anything now. However, for the sake of prelink ensure
16735 that the section contents are a known value. */
16736 if (!relocate)
16737 {
16738 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16739 /* The value chosen here is quite arbitrary as ld.so
16740 ignores section contents except for the special
16741 case of .opd where the contents might be accessed
16742 before relocation. Choose zero, as that won't
16743 cause reloc overflow. */
16744 relocation = 0;
16745 addend = 0;
16746 /* Use *r_offset == r_addend for R_PPC64_ADDR64 relocs
16747 to improve backward compatibility with older
16748 versions of ld. */
16749 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64)
16750 addend = outrel.r_addend;
16751 /* Adjust pc_relative relocs to have zero in *r_offset. */
16752 else if (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->pc_relative)
16753 addend = outrel.r_offset;
16754 }
16755 }
16756 break;
16757
16758 case R_PPC64_COPY:
16759 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
16760 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
16761 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
16762 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
16763 /* We shouldn't ever see these dynamic relocs in relocatable
16764 files. */
16765 /* Fall through. */
16766
16767 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16:
16768 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16769 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16770 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:
16771 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:
16772 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16773 case R_PPC64_PLTREL32:
16774 case R_PPC64_PLTREL64:
16775 /* These ones haven't been implemented yet. */
16776
16777 info->callbacks->einfo
16778 /* xgettext:c-format */
16779 (_("%P: %pB: %s is not supported for `%pT'\n"),
16780 input_bfd,
16781 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, sym_name);
16782
16783 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
16784 ret = FALSE;
16785 goto copy_reloc;
16786 }
16787
16788 /* Multi-instruction sequences that access the TOC can be
16789 optimized, eg. addis ra,r2,0; addi rb,ra,x;
16790 to nop; addi rb,r2,x; */
16791 switch (r_type)
16792 {
16793 default:
16794 break;
16795
16796 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16797 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
16798 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
16799 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16800 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16801 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16802 /* These relocs would only be useful if building up an
16803 offset to later add to r2, perhaps in an indexed
16804 addressing mode instruction. Don't try to optimize.
16805 Unfortunately, the possibility of someone building up an
16806 offset like this or even with the HA relocs, means that
16807 we need to check the high insn when optimizing the low
16808 insn. */
16809 break;
16810
16811 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16812 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16813 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16814 /* Fall through. */
16815 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16816 if (unresolved_reloc)
16817 {
16818 /* No plt entry. Make this into a direct call. */
16819 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16820 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16821 insn &= 1;
16822 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B_DOT | insn, p);
16823 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
16824 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p + 4);
16825 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
16826 r_type = R_PPC64_REL24;
16827 }
16828 break;
16829
16830 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16831 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16832 if (unresolved_reloc)
16833 {
16834 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16835 goto nop_it;
16836 }
16837 break;
16838
16839 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16840 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16841 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16842 /* Fall through. */
16843 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16844 if (unresolved_reloc)
16845 {
16846 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16847 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP >> 32, p);
16848 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP, p + 4);
16849 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16850 goto copy_reloc;
16851 }
16852 break;
16853
16854 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16855 if (unresolved_reloc)
16856 {
16857 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16858 goto nop_it;
16859 }
16860 /* Fall through. */
16861 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16862 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16863 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16864 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16865 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16866 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16867 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16868 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16869 {
16870 bfd_byte *p;
16871 nop_it:
16872 p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16873 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16874 goto copy_reloc;
16875 }
16876 break;
16877
16878 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16879 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16880 if (unresolved_reloc)
16881 {
16882 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16883 goto nop_it;
16884 }
16885 /* Fall through. */
16886 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
16887 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
16888 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16889 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16890 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16891 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16892 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16893 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16894 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16895 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16896 {
16897 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16898 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16899 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */)
16900 {
16901 /* Transform addic to addi when we change reg. */
16902 insn &= ~((0x3fu << 26) | (0x1f << 16));
16903 insn |= (14u << 26) | (2 << 16);
16904 }
16905 else
16906 {
16907 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16908 insn |= 2 << 16;
16909 }
16910 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16911 }
16912 break;
16913
16914 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16915 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16916 {
16917 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16918 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16919 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
16920 != ((15u << 26) | (13 << 16)) /* addis rt,13,imm */)
16921 /* xgettext:c-format */
16922 info->callbacks->minfo
16923 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
16924 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16925 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, insn);
16926 else
16927 {
16928 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16929 goto copy_reloc;
16930 }
16931 }
16932 break;
16933
16934 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16935 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16936 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16937 {
16938 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16939 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16940 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16941 insn |= 13 << 16;
16942 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16943 }
16944 break;
16945 }
16946
16947 /* Do any further special processing. */
16948 switch (r_type)
16949 {
16950 default:
16951 break;
16952
16953 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16954 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16955 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16956 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16957 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16958 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16959 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16960 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16961 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16962 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16963 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16964 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16965 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16966 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16967 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16968 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16969 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16970 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16971 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16972 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
16973 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
16974 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
16975 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
16976 if (sec == NULL)
16977 break;
16978 /* Fall through. */
16979
16980 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16981 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16982 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16983 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16984 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16985 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16986 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16987 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
16988 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
16989 addend += 0x8000;
16990 break;
16991
16992 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16993 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16994 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16995 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16996 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16997 if (sec != NULL)
16998 addend += 1ULL << 33;
16999 break;
17000
17001 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
17002 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
17003 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
17004 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
17005 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
17006 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
17007 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
17008 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
17009 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
17010 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
17011 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
17012 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
17013 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17014 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
17015 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
17016 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
17017 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
17018 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
17019 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
17020 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
17021 mask = 3;
17022 /* If this reloc is against an lq, lxv, or stxv insn, then
17023 the value must be a multiple of 16. This is somewhat of
17024 a hack, but the "correct" way to do this by defining _DQ
17025 forms of all the _DS relocs bloats all reloc switches in
17026 this file. It doesn't make much sense to use these
17027 relocs in data, so testing the insn should be safe. */
17028 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (56u << 26)
17029 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) && (insn & 3) == 1))
17030 mask = 15;
17031 relocation += addend;
17032 addend = insn & (mask ^ 3);
17033 if ((relocation & mask) != 0)
17034 {
17035 relocation ^= relocation & mask;
17036 info->callbacks->einfo
17037 /* xgettext:c-format */
17038 (_("%H: error: %s not a multiple of %u\n"),
17039 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17040 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
17041 mask + 1);
17042 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
17043 ret = FALSE;
17044 goto copy_reloc;
17045 }
17046 break;
17047 }
17048
17049 /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
17050 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
17051 not process them. */
17052 howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) r_type];
17053 if (unresolved_reloc
17054 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
17055 && h->elf.def_dynamic)
17056 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
17057 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
17058 {
17059 info->callbacks->einfo
17060 /* xgettext:c-format */
17061 (_("%H: unresolvable %s against `%pT'\n"),
17062 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17063 howto->name,
17064 h->elf.root.root.string);
17065 ret = FALSE;
17066 }
17067
17068 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
17069 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
17070 have different reloc types. */
17071 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
17072 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
17073 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
17074 {
17075 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
17076
17077 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
17078 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
17079 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
17080 else if (howto->rightshift == 0
17081 ? ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
17082 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
17083 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
17084 : ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 29u << 26 /* andis */
17085 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 25u << 26 /* oris */
17086 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 27u << 26 /* xoris */))
17087 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
17088 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
17089 {
17090 alt_howto = *howto;
17091 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
17092 howto = &alt_howto;
17093 }
17094 }
17095
17096 switch (r_type)
17097 {
17098 /* Split field relocs aren't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
17099 case R_PPC64_D34:
17100 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
17101 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
17102 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
17103 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
17104 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
17105 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
17106 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
17107 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD_PCREL34:
17108 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD_PCREL34:
17109 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL_PCREL34:
17110 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL_PCREL34:
17111 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
17112 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
17113 case R_PPC64_D28:
17114 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
17115 if (rel->r_offset + 8 > input_section->size)
17116 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17117 else
17118 {
17119 relocation += addend;
17120 if (howto->pc_relative)
17121 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17122 + input_section->output_offset
17123 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17124 relocation >>= howto->rightshift;
17125
17126 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17127 pinsn <<= 32;
17128 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17129
17130 pinsn &= ~howto->dst_mask;
17131 pinsn |= (((relocation << 16) | (relocation & 0xffff))
17132 & howto->dst_mask);
17133 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + rel->r_offset);
17134 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17135 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17136 if (howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
17137 && (relocation + (1ULL << (howto->bitsize - 1))
17138 >= 1ULL << howto->bitsize))
17139 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17140 }
17141 break;
17142
17143 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
17144 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
17145 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17146 else
17147 {
17148 relocation += addend;
17149 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17150 + input_section->output_offset
17151 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17152 relocation = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation >> 16;
17153 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17154 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
17155 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
17156 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
17157 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17158 if (relocation + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
17159 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17160 }
17161 break;
17162
17163 default:
17164 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
17165 contents, rel->r_offset,
17166 relocation, addend);
17167 }
17168
17169 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
17170 {
17171 char *more_info = NULL;
17172 const char *reloc_name = howto->name;
17173
17174 if (reloc_dest != DEST_NORMAL)
17175 {
17176 more_info = bfd_malloc (strlen (reloc_name) + 8);
17177 if (more_info != NULL)
17178 {
17179 strcpy (more_info, reloc_name);
17180 strcat (more_info, (reloc_dest == DEST_OPD
17181 ? " (OPD)" : " (stub)"));
17182 reloc_name = more_info;
17183 }
17184 }
17185
17186 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
17187 {
17188 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
17189 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
17190 if (!warned
17191 && (reloc_dest == DEST_STUB
17192 || !(h != NULL
17193 && (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
17194 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
17195 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))))
17196 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow (info, &h->elf.root,
17197 sym_name, reloc_name,
17198 orig_rel.r_addend,
17199 input_bfd, input_section,
17200 rel->r_offset);
17201 }
17202 else
17203 {
17204 info->callbacks->einfo
17205 /* xgettext:c-format */
17206 (_("%H: %s against `%pT': error %d\n"),
17207 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17208 reloc_name, sym_name, (int) r);
17209 ret = FALSE;
17210 }
17211 free (more_info);
17212 }
17213 copy_reloc:
17214 if (wrel != rel)
17215 *wrel = *rel;
17216 }
17217
17218 if (wrel != rel)
17219 {
17220 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
17221 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
17222
17223 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
17224 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17225 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
17226 {
17227 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
17228 one NONE reloc.
17229 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
17230 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
17231 deleted -= 1;
17232 }
17233 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
17234 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17235 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
17236 }
17237
17238 /* If we're emitting relocations, then shortly after this function
17239 returns, reloc offsets and addends for this section will be
17240 adjusted. Worse, reloc symbol indices will be for the output
17241 file rather than the input. Save a copy of the relocs for
17242 opd_entry_value. */
17243 if (is_opd && (info->emitrelocations || bfd_link_relocatable (info)))
17244 {
17245 bfd_size_type amt;
17246 amt = input_section->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela);
17247 rel = bfd_alloc (input_bfd, amt);
17248 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs == NULL);
17249 ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs = rel;
17250 if (rel == NULL)
17251 return FALSE;
17252 memcpy (rel, relocs, amt);
17253 }
17254 return ret;
17255 }
17256
17257 /* Adjust the value of any local symbols in opd sections. */
17258
17259 static int
17260 ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook (struct bfd_link_info *info,
17261 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
17262 Elf_Internal_Sym *elfsym,
17263 asection *input_sec,
17264 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
17265 {
17266 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
17267 long adjust;
17268 bfd_vma value;
17269
17270 if (h != NULL)
17271 return 1;
17272
17273 opd = get_opd_info (input_sec);
17274 if (opd == NULL || opd->adjust == NULL)
17275 return 1;
17276
17277 value = elfsym->st_value - input_sec->output_offset;
17278 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
17279 value -= input_sec->output_section->vma;
17280
17281 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (value)];
17282 if (adjust == -1)
17283 return 2;
17284
17285 elfsym->st_value += adjust;
17286 return 1;
17287 }
17288
17289 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
17290 dynamic sections here. */
17291
17292 static bfd_boolean
17293 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
17294 struct bfd_link_info *info,
17295 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
17296 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
17297 {
17298 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17299 struct plt_entry *ent;
17300
17301 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17302 if (htab == NULL)
17303 return FALSE;
17304
17305 if (!htab->opd_abi && !h->def_regular)
17306 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
17307 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
17308 {
17309 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
17310 defined in glink. Leave the value if there were
17311 any relocations where pointer equality matters
17312 (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to make
17313 function pointer comparisons work between an
17314 application and shared library), otherwise set it
17315 to zero. */
17316 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
17317 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
17318 sym->st_value = 0;
17319 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
17320 {
17321 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
17322 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
17323 function pointer. */
17324 sym->st_value = 0;
17325 }
17326 break;
17327 }
17328
17329 if (h->needs_copy
17330 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
17331 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
17332 && (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
17333 || h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro))
17334 {
17335 /* This symbol needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
17336 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
17337 asection *srel;
17338 bfd_byte *loc;
17339
17340 if (h->dynindx == -1)
17341 abort ();
17342
17343 rela.r_offset = defined_sym_val (h);
17344 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_COPY);
17345 rela.r_addend = 0;
17346 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
17347 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
17348 else
17349 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
17350 loc = srel->contents;
17351 loc += srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
17352 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
17353 }
17354
17355 return TRUE;
17356 }
17357
17358 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
17359 dynamic linker, before writing them out. */
17360
17361 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
17362 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
17363 const asection *rel_sec,
17364 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
17365 {
17366 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
17367 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17368
17369 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
17370 return reloc_class_ifunc;
17371
17372 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rela->r_info);
17373 switch (r_type)
17374 {
17375 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
17376 return reloc_class_relative;
17377 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
17378 return reloc_class_plt;
17379 case R_PPC64_COPY:
17380 return reloc_class_copy;
17381 default:
17382 return reloc_class_normal;
17383 }
17384 }
17385
17386 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
17387
17388 static bfd_boolean
17389 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
17390 struct bfd_link_info *info)
17391 {
17392 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17393 bfd *dynobj;
17394 asection *sdyn;
17395
17396 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17397 if (htab == NULL)
17398 return FALSE;
17399
17400 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
17401 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
17402
17403 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
17404 {
17405 Elf64_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
17406
17407 if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
17408 abort ();
17409
17410 dyncon = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
17411 dynconend = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
17412 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
17413 {
17414 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
17415 asection *s;
17416
17417 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
17418
17419 switch (dyn.d_tag)
17420 {
17421 default:
17422 continue;
17423
17424 case DT_PPC64_GLINK:
17425 s = htab->glink;
17426 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17427 /* We stupidly defined DT_PPC64_GLINK to be the start
17428 of glink rather than the first entry point, which is
17429 what ld.so needs, and now have a bigger stub to
17430 support automatic multiple TOCs. */
17431 dyn.d_un.d_ptr += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) - 8 * 4;
17432 break;
17433
17434 case DT_PPC64_OPD:
17435 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17436 if (s == NULL)
17437 continue;
17438 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
17439 break;
17440
17441 case DT_PPC64_OPT:
17442 if ((htab->do_multi_toc && htab->multi_toc_needed)
17443 || htab->notoc_plt)
17444 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_MULTI_TOC;
17445 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
17446 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_LOCALENTRY;
17447 break;
17448
17449 case DT_PPC64_OPDSZ:
17450 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17451 if (s == NULL)
17452 continue;
17453 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
17454 break;
17455
17456 case DT_PLTGOT:
17457 s = htab->elf.splt;
17458 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17459 break;
17460
17461 case DT_JMPREL:
17462 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
17463 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17464 break;
17465
17466 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
17467 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
17468 break;
17469
17470 case DT_TEXTREL:
17471 if (htab->elf.ifunc_resolvers)
17472 info->callbacks->einfo
17473 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
17474 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
17475 continue;
17476 }
17477
17478 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
17479 }
17480 }
17481
17482 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->elf.sgot->size != 0
17483 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17484 {
17485 /* Fill in the first entry in the global offset table.
17486 We use it to hold the link-time TOCbase. */
17487 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
17488 elf_gp (output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF,
17489 htab->elf.sgot->contents);
17490
17491 /* Set .got entry size. */
17492 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17493 = 8;
17494 }
17495
17496 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
17497 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17498 {
17499 /* Set .plt entry size. */
17500 elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17501 = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
17502 }
17503
17504 /* brlt is SEC_LINKER_CREATED, so we need to write out relocs for
17505 brlt ourselves if emitrelocations. */
17506 if (htab->brlt != NULL
17507 && htab->brlt->reloc_count != 0
17508 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17509 htab->brlt,
17510 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->rela.hdr,
17511 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->relocs,
17512 NULL))
17513 return FALSE;
17514
17515 if (htab->glink != NULL
17516 && htab->glink->reloc_count != 0
17517 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17518 htab->glink,
17519 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->rela.hdr,
17520 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->relocs,
17521 NULL))
17522 return FALSE;
17523
17524
17525 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
17526 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0
17527 && htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
17528 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
17529 htab->glink_eh_frame,
17530 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
17531 return FALSE;
17532
17533 /* We need to handle writing out multiple GOT sections ourselves,
17534 since we didn't add them to DYNOBJ. We know dynobj is the first
17535 bfd. */
17536 while ((dynobj = dynobj->link.next) != NULL)
17537 {
17538 asection *s;
17539
17540 if (!is_ppc64_elf (dynobj))
17541 continue;
17542
17543 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->got;
17544 if (s != NULL
17545 && s->size != 0
17546 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17547 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17548 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17549 s->size))
17550 return FALSE;
17551 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->relgot;
17552 if (s != NULL
17553 && s->size != 0
17554 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17555 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17556 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17557 s->size))
17558 return FALSE;
17559 }
17560
17561 return TRUE;
17562 }
17563
17564 #include "elf64-target.h"
17565
17566 /* FreeBSD support */
17567
17568 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
17569 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
17570
17571 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
17572 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_fbsd_vec
17573 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
17574 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc-freebsd"
17575
17576 #undef ELF_OSABI
17577 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
17578
17579 #undef elf64_bed
17580 #define elf64_bed elf64_powerpc_fbsd_bed
17581
17582 #include "elf64-target.h"